c17520a103f8fd0b7ea2af91e806eaa40bf27105
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
148 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
151 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
163 how you can copy and share GDB
164 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
165 * Index:: Index
166 @end menu
167
168 @end ifnottex
169
170 @contents
171
172 @node Summary
173 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
174
175 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
176 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
177 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
178
179 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
180 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
181
182 @itemize @bullet
183 @item
184 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
185
186 @item
187 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
188
189 @item
190 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
191
192 @item
193 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
194 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
195 @end itemize
196
197 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
198 For more information, see @ref{Supported languages,,Supported languages}.
199 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
200
201 @cindex Modula-2
202 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
203 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
204
205 @cindex Pascal
206 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
207 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
208 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
209 syntax.
210
211 @cindex Fortran
212 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
213 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
214 underscore.
215
216 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
217 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
218
219 @menu
220 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
221 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
222 @end menu
223
224 @node Free Software
225 @unnumberedsec Free software
226
227 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
228 General Public License
229 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
230 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
231 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
232 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
233 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
234 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
235
236 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
237 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
238 from anyone else.
239
240 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
241
242 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
243 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
244 include with the free software. Many of our most important
245 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
246 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
247 when an important free software package does not come with a free
248 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
249 gaps today.
250
251 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
252 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
253 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
254 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
255 them from the free software world.
256
257 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
258 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
259 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
260 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
261 contract to make it non-free.
262
263 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
264 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
265 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
266 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
267 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
268 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
269 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
270
271 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
272 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
273 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
274 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
275
276 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
277 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
278 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
279 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
280 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
281 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
282 community.
283
284 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
285 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
286 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
287 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
288 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
289 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
290 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
291 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
292 of the manual.
293
294 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
295 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
296 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
297 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
298 manual to replace it.
299
300 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
301 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
302 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
303 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
304 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
305 the free software community.
306
307 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
308 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
309 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
310 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
311 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
312 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
313 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
314 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
315 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
316
317 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
318 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
319 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
320 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
321 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
322 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
323 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
324 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
325
326 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
327 published by other publishers, at
328 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
329
330 @node Contributors
331 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
332
333 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
334 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
335 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
336 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
337 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
338 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
339 blow-by-blow account.
340
341 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
342
343 @quotation
344 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
345 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
346 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
347 @end quotation
348
349 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
350 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
351 releases:
352 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
353 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
354 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
355 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
356 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
357 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
358 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
359 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
360 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
361
362 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
363 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
364
365 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
366 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
367 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
368 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
369 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
370
371 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
372 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
373 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
374
375 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
376 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
377
378 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
379
380 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
381 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
382 support.
383 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
384 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
385 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
386 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
387 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
388 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
389 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
390 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
391 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
392 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
393 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
394 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
395 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
396 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
397 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
398 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
399
400 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
401
402 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
403 libraries.
404
405 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
406 about several machine instruction sets.
407
408 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
409 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
410 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
411 and RDI targets, respectively.
412
413 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
414 command-line editing and command history.
415
416 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
417 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
418
419 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
420 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
421 symbols.
422
423 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
424 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
425
426 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
427
428 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
429 processors.
430
431 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
432
433 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
434
435 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
436
437 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
438 watchpoints.
439
440 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
441
442 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
443
444 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
445 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
446
447 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
448 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
449 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
450 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
451 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
452 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
453 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
454
455 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
456 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
457
458 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
459 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
460 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
461 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
462 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
463 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
464 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
465 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
466 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
467 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
468 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
469 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
470 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
471 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
472 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
473
474 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
475 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
476
477 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
478 Hat.
479
480 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
481 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
482 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
483 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
484 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
485 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
486
487 @node Sample Session
488 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
489
490 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
491 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
492 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
493
494 @iftex
495 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
496 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
497 @end iftex
498
499 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
500 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
501
502 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
503 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
504 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
505 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
506 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
507 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
508 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
509 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
510 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
511
512 @smallexample
513 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
514 $ @b{./m4}
515 @b{define(foo,0000)}
516
517 @b{foo}
518 0000
519 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
520
521 @b{bar}
522 0000
523 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
524
525 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
526 @b{baz}
527 @b{C-d}
528 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
529 @end smallexample
530
531 @noindent
532 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
533
534 @smallexample
535 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
536 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
537 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
538 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
539 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
540 the conditions.
541 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
542 for details.
543
544 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
545 (@value{GDBP})
546 @end smallexample
547
548 @noindent
549 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
550 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
551 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
552 that examples fit in this manual.
553
554 @smallexample
555 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
556 @end smallexample
557
558 @noindent
559 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
560 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
561 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
562 @code{break} command.
563
564 @smallexample
565 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
566 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
567 @end smallexample
568
569 @noindent
570 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
571 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
572 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
573
574 @smallexample
575 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
576 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
577 @b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579 @b{foo}
580 0000
581 @end smallexample
582
583 @noindent
584 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
585 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
586 context where it stops.
587
588 @smallexample
589 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
590
591 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
592 at builtin.c:879
593 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
594 @end smallexample
595
596 @noindent
597 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
598 the next line of the current function.
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
602 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
603 : nil,
604 @end smallexample
605
606 @noindent
607 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
608 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
609 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
610 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
611
612 @smallexample
613 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
614 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
615 at input.c:530
616 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
621 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
622 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
623 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
624 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
625 stack frame for each active subroutine.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
629 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
630 at input.c:530
631 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
632 at builtin.c:882
633 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
634 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
635 at macro.c:71
636 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
637 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
642 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
643 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
644
645 @smallexample
646 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
647 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
649 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
650 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
651 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
652 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
653 : xstrdup(rq);
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
655 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
660 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
661 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
662 (@code{print}) to see their values.
663
664 @smallexample
665 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
666 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
667 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
668 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
669 @end smallexample
670
671 @noindent
672 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
673 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
674 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
675
676 @smallexample
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
678 533 xfree(rquote);
679 534
680 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
681 : xstrdup (lq);
682 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
683 : xstrdup (rq);
684 537
685 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
686 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
687 540 @}
688 541
689 542 void
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
694 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
695
696 @smallexample
697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
698 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
699 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
700 540 @}
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
702 $3 = 9
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
704 $4 = 7
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
709 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
710 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
711 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
712 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
713 assignments.
714
715 @smallexample
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
717 $5 = 7
718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
719 $6 = 9
720 @end smallexample
721
722 @noindent
723 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
724 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
725 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
726 example that caused trouble initially:
727
728 @smallexample
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
730 Continuing.
731
732 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
733
734 baz
735 0000
736 @end smallexample
737
738 @noindent
739 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
740 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
741 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
742
743 @smallexample
744 @b{C-d}
745 Program exited normally.
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
750 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
751 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
755 @end smallexample
756
757 @node Invocation
758 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
759
760 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
761 The essentials are:
762 @itemize @bullet
763 @item
764 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
765 @item
766 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
767 @end itemize
768
769 @menu
770 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
771 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
772 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
773 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
774 @end menu
775
776 @node Invoking GDB
777 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
778
779 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
780 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
781
782 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
783 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
784
785 The command-line options described here are designed
786 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
787 options may effectively be unavailable.
788
789 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
790 specifying an executable program:
791
792 @smallexample
793 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
794 @end smallexample
795
796 @noindent
797 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
798 specified:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
802 @end smallexample
803
804 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
805 to debug a running process:
806
807 @smallexample
808 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
813 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
814
815 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
816 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
817 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
818 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
819 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
820
821 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
822 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
823 option processing.
824 @smallexample
825 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
826 @end smallexample
827 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
828 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
829
830 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
831 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} -silent
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
839 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
840
841 @noindent
842 Type
843
844 @smallexample
845 @value{GDBP} -help
846 @end smallexample
847
848 @noindent
849 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
850 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
851
852 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
853 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
854 @samp{-x} option is used.
855
856
857 @menu
858 * File Options:: Choosing files
859 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
860 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
861 @end menu
862
863 @node File Options
864 @subsection Choosing files
865
866 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
867 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
868 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
869 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
870 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
871 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
872 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
873 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
874 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
875 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
876 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
877 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
878 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
879
880 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
881 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
882 argument and ignore it.
883
884 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
885 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
886 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
887 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
888 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
889
890 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
891 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
892 @c it.
893
894 @table @code
895 @item -symbols @var{file}
896 @itemx -s @var{file}
897 @cindex @code{--symbols}
898 @cindex @code{-s}
899 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
900
901 @item -exec @var{file}
902 @itemx -e @var{file}
903 @cindex @code{--exec}
904 @cindex @code{-e}
905 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
906 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
907
908 @item -se @var{file}
909 @cindex @code{--se}
910 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
911 file.
912
913 @item -core @var{file}
914 @itemx -c @var{file}
915 @cindex @code{--core}
916 @cindex @code{-c}
917 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
918
919 @item -c @var{number}
920 @item -pid @var{number}
921 @itemx -p @var{number}
922 @cindex @code{--pid}
923 @cindex @code{-p}
924 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
925 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
926 file named @var{number}.
927
928 @item -command @var{file}
929 @itemx -x @var{file}
930 @cindex @code{--command}
931 @cindex @code{-x}
932 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
933 Files,, Command files}.
934
935 @item -eval-command @var{command}
936 @itemx -ex @var{command}
937 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
938 @cindex @code{-ex}
939 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
940
941 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
942 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
943
944 @smallexample
945 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
946 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
947 @end smallexample
948
949 @item -directory @var{directory}
950 @itemx -d @var{directory}
951 @cindex @code{--directory}
952 @cindex @code{-d}
953 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
954
955 @item -r
956 @itemx -readnow
957 @cindex @code{--readnow}
958 @cindex @code{-r}
959 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
960 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
961 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
962
963 @end table
964
965 @node Mode Options
966 @subsection Choosing modes
967
968 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
969 batch mode or quiet mode.
970
971 @table @code
972 @item -nx
973 @itemx -n
974 @cindex @code{--nx}
975 @cindex @code{-n}
976 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
977 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
978 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
979 files}.
980
981 @item -quiet
982 @itemx -silent
983 @itemx -q
984 @cindex @code{--quiet}
985 @cindex @code{--silent}
986 @cindex @code{-q}
987 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
988 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
989
990 @item -batch
991 @cindex @code{--batch}
992 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
993 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
994 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
995 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
996 in the command files.
997
998 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
999 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1000 make this more useful, the message
1001
1002 @smallexample
1003 Program exited normally.
1004 @end smallexample
1005
1006 @noindent
1007 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1008 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1009 mode.
1010
1011 @item -batch-silent
1012 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1013 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1014 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1015 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1016 for an interactive session.
1017
1018 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1019 messages, for example.
1020
1021 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1022 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1023
1024 @item -return-child-result
1025 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1026 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1027 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1028
1029 @itemize @bullet
1030 @item
1031 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1032 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1033 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1034 @item
1035 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1036 @item
1037 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1038 the exit code will be -1.
1039 @end itemize
1040
1041 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1042 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1043 interface.
1044
1045 @item -nowindows
1046 @itemx -nw
1047 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1048 @cindex @code{-nw}
1049 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1050 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1051 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1052
1053 @item -windows
1054 @itemx -w
1055 @cindex @code{--windows}
1056 @cindex @code{-w}
1057 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1058 used if possible.
1059
1060 @item -cd @var{directory}
1061 @cindex @code{--cd}
1062 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1063 instead of the current directory.
1064
1065 @item -fullname
1066 @itemx -f
1067 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1068 @cindex @code{-f}
1069 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1070 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1071 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1072 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1073 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1074 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1075 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1076 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1077 frame.
1078
1079 @item -epoch
1080 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1081 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1082 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1083 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1084 separate window.
1085
1086 @item -annotate @var{level}
1087 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1088 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1089 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1090 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1091 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1092 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1093 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1094 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1095 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1096
1097 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1098 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1099
1100 @item --args
1101 @cindex @code{--args}
1102 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1103 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1104 This option stops option processing.
1105
1106 @item -baud @var{bps}
1107 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1108 @cindex @code{--baud}
1109 @cindex @code{-b}
1110 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1111 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1112
1113 @item -l @var{timeout}
1114 @cindex @code{-l}
1115 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1116 for remote debugging.
1117
1118 @item -tty @var{device}
1119 @itemx -t @var{device}
1120 @cindex @code{--tty}
1121 @cindex @code{-t}
1122 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1123 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1124
1125 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1126 @item -tui
1127 @cindex @code{--tui}
1128 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1129 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1130 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1131 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1132 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1133 @samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1134 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1135
1136 @c @item -xdb
1137 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1138 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1139 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1140 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1141 @c systems.
1142
1143 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1144 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1145 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1146 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1147 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1148 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1149
1150 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1151 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1152 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1153 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1154 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1155 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1156
1157 @item -write
1158 @cindex @code{--write}
1159 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1160 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1161 (@pxref{Patching}).
1162
1163 @item -statistics
1164 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1165 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1166 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1167
1168 @item -version
1169 @cindex @code{--version}
1170 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1171 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1172
1173 @end table
1174
1175 @node Startup
1176 @subsection What @value{GDBN} does during startup
1177 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1178
1179 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1180
1181 @enumerate
1182 @item
1183 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1184 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1185
1186 @item
1187 @cindex init file
1188 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1189 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1190 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1191 that file.
1192
1193 @item
1194 Processes command line options and operands.
1195
1196 @item
1197 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1198 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1199 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1200 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1201 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1202 @value{GDBN}.
1203
1204 @item
1205 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1206 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1207
1208 @item
1209 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1210 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1211 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1212 @end enumerate
1213
1214 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1215 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1216 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1217 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1218 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1219 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
1220
1221 @cindex init file name
1222 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1223 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1224 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
1225 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
1226 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
1227 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
1228 environments with special init file names:
1229
1230 @itemize @bullet
1231 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1232 @item
1233 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1234 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1235 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1236 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1237 the file to the standard name.
1238
1239 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
1240 @item
1241 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
1242
1243 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
1244 @item
1245 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
1246
1247 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
1248 @item
1249 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
1250
1251 @item
1252 CISCO 68k: @file{.cisco-gdbinit}
1253 @end itemize
1254
1255
1256 @node Quitting GDB
1257 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1258 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1259 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1260
1261 @table @code
1262 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1263 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1264 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1265 @itemx q
1266 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1267 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1268 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1269 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1270 error code.
1271 @end table
1272
1273 @cindex interrupt
1274 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1275 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1276 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1277 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1278 until a time when it is safe.
1279
1280 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1281 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1282 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1283
1284 @node Shell Commands
1285 @section Shell commands
1286
1287 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1288 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1289 just use the @code{shell} command.
1290
1291 @table @code
1292 @kindex shell
1293 @cindex shell escape
1294 @item shell @var{command string}
1295 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1296 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1297 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1298 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1299 @end table
1300
1301 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1302 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1303 @value{GDBN}:
1304
1305 @table @code
1306 @kindex make
1307 @cindex calling make
1308 @item make @var{make-args}
1309 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1310 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1311 @end table
1312
1313 @node Logging output
1314 @section Logging output
1315 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1316 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1317
1318 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1319 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1320
1321 @table @code
1322 @kindex set logging
1323 @item set logging on
1324 Enable logging.
1325 @item set logging off
1326 Disable logging.
1327 @cindex logging file name
1328 @item set logging file @var{file}
1329 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1330 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1331 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1332 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1333 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1334 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1335 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1336 @kindex show logging
1337 @item show logging
1338 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1339 @end table
1340
1341 @node Commands
1342 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1343
1344 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1345 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1346 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1347 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1348 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1349
1350 @menu
1351 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1352 * Completion:: Command completion
1353 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1354 @end menu
1355
1356 @node Command Syntax
1357 @section Command syntax
1358
1359 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1360 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1361 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1362 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1363 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1364 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1365
1366 @cindex abbreviation
1367 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1368 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1369 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1370 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1371 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1372 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1373 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1374
1375 @cindex repeating commands
1376 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1377 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1378 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1379 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1380 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1381 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1382 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1383
1384 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1385 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1386 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1387
1388 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1389 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1390 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1391 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1392 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1393
1394 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1395 @cindex comment
1396 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1397 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1398 Files,,Command files}).
1399
1400 @cindex repeating command sequences
1401 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1402 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1403 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1404 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1405 for editing.
1406
1407 @node Completion
1408 @section Command completion
1409
1410 @cindex completion
1411 @cindex word completion
1412 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1413 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1414 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1415 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1416
1417 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1418 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1419 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1420 enter it). For example, if you type
1421
1422 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1423 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1424 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1425 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1426 @smallexample
1427 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1428 @end smallexample
1429
1430 @noindent
1431 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1432 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1433
1434 @smallexample
1435 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1436 @end smallexample
1437
1438 @noindent
1439 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1440 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1441 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1442 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1443 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1444 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1445
1446 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1447 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1448 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1449 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1450 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1451 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1452 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1453 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1454 example:
1455
1456 @smallexample
1457 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1458 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1459 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1460 make_abs_section make_function_type
1461 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1462 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1463 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1464 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1465 @end smallexample
1466
1467 @noindent
1468 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1469 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1470 command.
1471
1472 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1473 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1474 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1475 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1476 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1477
1478 @cindex quotes in commands
1479 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1480 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1481 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1482 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1483 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1484 @value{GDBN} commands.
1485
1486 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1487 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1488 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1489 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1490 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1491 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1492 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1493 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1494 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1495 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1496 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1497
1498 @smallexample
1499 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1500 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1501 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1502 @end smallexample
1503
1504 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1505 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1506 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1507 place:
1508
1509 @smallexample
1510 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1511 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1513 @end smallexample
1514
1515 @noindent
1516 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1517 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1518 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1519
1520 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1521 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1522 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1523 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1524
1525
1526 @node Help
1527 @section Getting help
1528 @cindex online documentation
1529 @kindex help
1530
1531 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1532 using the command @code{help}.
1533
1534 @table @code
1535 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1536 @item help
1537 @itemx h
1538 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1539 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1540
1541 @smallexample
1542 (@value{GDBP}) help
1543 List of classes of commands:
1544
1545 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1546 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1547 data -- Examining data
1548 files -- Specifying and examining files
1549 internals -- Maintenance commands
1550 obscure -- Obscure features
1551 running -- Running the program
1552 stack -- Examining the stack
1553 status -- Status inquiries
1554 support -- Support facilities
1555 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1556 stopping the program
1557 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1558
1559 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1560 commands in that class.
1561 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1562 documentation.
1563 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1564 (@value{GDBP})
1565 @end smallexample
1566 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1567
1568 @item help @var{class}
1569 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1570 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1571 help display for the class @code{status}:
1572
1573 @smallexample
1574 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1575 Status inquiries.
1576
1577 List of commands:
1578
1579 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1580 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1581 info -- Generic command for showing things
1582 about the program being debugged
1583 show -- Generic command for showing things
1584 about the debugger
1585
1586 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1587 documentation.
1588 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1589 (@value{GDBP})
1590 @end smallexample
1591
1592 @item help @var{command}
1593 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1594 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1595
1596 @kindex apropos
1597 @item apropos @var{args}
1598 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1599 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1600 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1601
1602 @smallexample
1603 apropos reload
1604 @end smallexample
1605
1606 @noindent
1607 results in:
1608
1609 @smallexample
1610 @c @group
1611 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1612 multiple times in one run
1613 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1614 multiple times in one run
1615 @c @end group
1616 @end smallexample
1617
1618 @kindex complete
1619 @item complete @var{args}
1620 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1621 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1622 command you want completed. For example:
1623
1624 @smallexample
1625 complete i
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 @noindent results in:
1629
1630 @smallexample
1631 @group
1632 if
1633 ignore
1634 info
1635 inspect
1636 @end group
1637 @end smallexample
1638
1639 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1640 @end table
1641
1642 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1643 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1644 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1645 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1646 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1647 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1648
1649 @c @group
1650 @table @code
1651 @kindex info
1652 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1653 @item info
1654 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1655 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1656 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1657 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1658 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1659 @w{@code{help info}}.
1660
1661 @kindex set
1662 @item set
1663 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1664 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1665 @code{set prompt $}.
1666
1667 @kindex show
1668 @item show
1669 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1670 @value{GDBN} itself.
1671 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1672 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1673 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1674 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1675
1676 @kindex info set
1677 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1678 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1679 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1680 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1681 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1682 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1683 @end table
1684 @c @end group
1685
1686 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1687 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1688
1689 @table @code
1690 @kindex show version
1691 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1692 @item show version
1693 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1694 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1695 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1696 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1697 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1698 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1699 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1700 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1701 @value{GDBN}.
1702
1703 @kindex show copying
1704 @kindex info copying
1705 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1706 @item show copying
1707 @itemx info copying
1708 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1709
1710 @kindex show warranty
1711 @kindex info warranty
1712 @item show warranty
1713 @itemx info warranty
1714 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1715 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1716
1717 @end table
1718
1719 @node Running
1720 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1721
1722 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1723 debugging information when you compile it.
1724
1725 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1726 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1727 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1728 kill a child process.
1729
1730 @menu
1731 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1732 * Starting:: Starting your program
1733 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1734 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1735
1736 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1737 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1738 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1739 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1740
1741 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1742 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1743 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1744 @end menu
1745
1746 @node Compilation
1747 @section Compiling for debugging
1748
1749 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1750 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1751 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1752 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1753 and addresses in the executable code.
1754
1755 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1756 the compiler.
1757
1758 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1759 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1760 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1761 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1762 executables containing debugging information.
1763
1764 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1765 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1766 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1767 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1768 in pushing your luck.
1769
1770 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1771 @cindex debugging optimized code
1772 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1773 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1774 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1775 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1776 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1777 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1778
1779 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1780 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1781 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1782 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1783 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1784
1785 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1786 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1787 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1788
1789 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1790 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1791 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1792 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1793 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1794 provides macro information if you specify the options
1795 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1796 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1797 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1798 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1799 @option{-g} alone.
1800
1801 @need 2000
1802 @node Starting
1803 @section Starting your program
1804 @cindex starting
1805 @cindex running
1806
1807 @table @code
1808 @kindex run
1809 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1810 @item run
1811 @itemx r
1812 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1813 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1814 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1815 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1816 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1817
1818 @end table
1819
1820 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1821 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1822 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1823 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1824
1825 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1826 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1827 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1828 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1829 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1830 divided into four categories:
1831
1832 @table @asis
1833 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1834 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1835 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1836 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1837 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1838 the arguments.
1839 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1840 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1841 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1842
1843 @item The @emph{environment.}
1844 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1845 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1846 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1847 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1848
1849 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1850 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1851 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1852 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1853
1854 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1855 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1856 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1857 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1858 set a different device for your program.
1859 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1860
1861 @cindex pipes
1862 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1863 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1864 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1865 wrong program.
1866 @end table
1867
1868 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1869 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1870 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1871 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1872 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1873
1874 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1875 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1876 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1877 your current breakpoints.
1878
1879 @table @code
1880 @kindex start
1881 @item start
1882 @cindex run to main procedure
1883 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1884 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1885 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1886 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1887 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1888 procedure, depending on the language used.
1889
1890 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1891 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1892 the @samp{run} command.
1893
1894 @cindex elaboration phase
1895 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1896 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1897 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1898 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1899 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1900 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1901 will remain to halt execution.
1902
1903 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1904 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1905 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1906 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1907 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1908
1909 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1910 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1911 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1912 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1913 elaboration code before running your program.
1914 @end table
1915
1916 @node Arguments
1917 @section Your program's arguments
1918
1919 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1920 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1921 @code{run} command.
1922 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1923 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1924 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1925 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1926 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1927
1928 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1929 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1930 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1931 the program, not by the shell.
1932
1933 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1934 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1935
1936 @table @code
1937 @kindex set args
1938 @item set args
1939 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1940 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1941 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1942 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1943 it again without arguments.
1944
1945 @kindex show args
1946 @item show args
1947 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1948 @end table
1949
1950 @node Environment
1951 @section Your program's environment
1952
1953 @cindex environment (of your program)
1954 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1955 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1956 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1957 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1958 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1959 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1960 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1961
1962 @table @code
1963 @kindex path
1964 @item path @var{directory}
1965 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1966 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1967 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1968 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1969 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1970 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1971 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1972
1973 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1974 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1975 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1976 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1977 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1978 @var{directory} to the search path.
1979 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1980 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1981
1982 @kindex show paths
1983 @item show paths
1984 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1985 environment variable).
1986
1987 @kindex show environment
1988 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1989 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1990 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1991 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1992 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1993
1994 @kindex set environment
1995 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1996 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1997 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1998 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1999 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2000 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2001 null value.
2002 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2003 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2004
2005 For example, this command:
2006
2007 @smallexample
2008 set env USER = foo
2009 @end smallexample
2010
2011 @noindent
2012 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2013 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2014 are not actually required.)
2015
2016 @kindex unset environment
2017 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2018 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2019 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2020 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2021 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2022 @end table
2023
2024 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2025 the shell indicated
2026 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2027 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2028 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2029 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2030 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2031 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2032 @file{.profile}.
2033
2034 @node Working Directory
2035 @section Your program's working directory
2036
2037 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2038 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2039 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2040 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2041 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2042 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2043
2044 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2045 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2046 specify files}.
2047
2048 @table @code
2049 @kindex cd
2050 @cindex change working directory
2051 @item cd @var{directory}
2052 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2053
2054 @kindex pwd
2055 @item pwd
2056 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2057 @end table
2058
2059 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2060 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2061 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2062 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2063 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2064 current working directory of the debuggee.
2065
2066 @node Input/Output
2067 @section Your program's input and output
2068
2069 @cindex redirection
2070 @cindex i/o
2071 @cindex terminal
2072 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2073 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2074 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2075 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2076 running your program.
2077
2078 @table @code
2079 @kindex info terminal
2080 @item info terminal
2081 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2082 program is using.
2083 @end table
2084
2085 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2086 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2087
2088 @smallexample
2089 run > outfile
2090 @end smallexample
2091
2092 @noindent
2093 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2094
2095 @kindex tty
2096 @cindex controlling terminal
2097 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2098 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2099 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2100 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2101 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2102
2103 @smallexample
2104 tty /dev/ttyb
2105 @end smallexample
2106
2107 @noindent
2108 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2109 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2110 that as their controlling terminal.
2111
2112 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2113 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2114 terminal.
2115
2116 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2117 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2118 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2119 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2120
2121 @cindex inferior tty
2122 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2123 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2124 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2125 program.
2126
2127 @table @code
2128 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2129 @kindex set inferior-tty
2130 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2131
2132 @item show inferior-tty
2133 @kindex show inferior-tty
2134 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2135 @end table
2136
2137 @node Attach
2138 @section Debugging an already-running process
2139 @kindex attach
2140 @cindex attach
2141
2142 @table @code
2143 @item attach @var{process-id}
2144 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2145 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2146 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2147 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2148 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2149
2150 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2151 executing the command.
2152 @end table
2153
2154 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2155 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2156 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2157 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2158
2159 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2160 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2161 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2162 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
2163 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2164 Specify Files}.
2165
2166 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2167 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2168 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2169 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2170 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2171 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2172 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2173
2174 @table @code
2175 @kindex detach
2176 @item detach
2177 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2178 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2179 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2180 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2181 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2182 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2183 executing the command.
2184 @end table
2185
2186 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2187 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2188 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2189 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2190 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2191 messages}).
2192
2193 @node Kill Process
2194 @section Killing the child process
2195
2196 @table @code
2197 @kindex kill
2198 @item kill
2199 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2200 @end table
2201
2202 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2203 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2204 is running.
2205
2206 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2207 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2208 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2209 outside the debugger.
2210
2211 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2212 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2213 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2214 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2215 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2216 breakpoint settings).
2217
2218 @node Threads
2219 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2220
2221 @cindex threads of execution
2222 @cindex multiple threads
2223 @cindex switching threads
2224 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2225 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2226 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2227 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2228 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2229 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2230 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2231
2232 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2233 programs:
2234
2235 @itemize @bullet
2236 @item automatic notification of new threads
2237 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2238 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2239 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2240 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2241 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2242 @end itemize
2243
2244 @quotation
2245 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2246 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2247 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2248 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2249 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2250 like this:
2251
2252 @smallexample
2253 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2254 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2255 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2256 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2257 @end smallexample
2258 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2259 @c doesn't support threads"?
2260 @end quotation
2261
2262 @cindex focus of debugging
2263 @cindex current thread
2264 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2265 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2266 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2267 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2268 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2269
2270 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2271 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2272 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2273 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2274 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2275 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2276 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2277 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2278 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2279 LynxOS, you might see
2280
2281 @smallexample
2282 [New process 35 thread 27]
2283 @end smallexample
2284
2285 @noindent
2286 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2287 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2288 further qualifier.
2289
2290 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2291 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2292 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2293 @c program?
2294 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2295 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2296 @c threads ab initio?
2297
2298 @cindex thread number
2299 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2300 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2301 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2302
2303 @table @code
2304 @kindex info threads
2305 @item info threads
2306 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2307 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2308
2309 @enumerate
2310 @item
2311 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2312
2313 @item
2314 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2315
2316 @item
2317 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2318 @end enumerate
2319
2320 @noindent
2321 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2322 indicates the current thread.
2323
2324 For example,
2325 @end table
2326 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2327
2328 @smallexample
2329 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2330 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2331 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2332 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2333 at threadtest.c:68
2334 @end smallexample
2335
2336 On HP-UX systems:
2337
2338 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2339 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2340 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2341 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2342 thread in your program.
2343
2344 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2345 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2346 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2347 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2348 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2349 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2350 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2351 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2352 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2353 HP-UX, you see
2354
2355 @smallexample
2356 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2357 @end smallexample
2358
2359 @noindent
2360 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2361
2362 @table @code
2363 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2364 @item info threads
2365 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2366 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2367
2368 @enumerate
2369 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2370
2371 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2372
2373 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2374 @end enumerate
2375
2376 @noindent
2377 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2378 indicates the current thread.
2379
2380 For example,
2381 @end table
2382 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2383
2384 @smallexample
2385 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2386 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2387 at quicksort.c:137
2388 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2389 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2390 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2391 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2392 @end smallexample
2393
2394 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2395 Solaris-specific command:
2396
2397 @table @code
2398 @item maint info sol-threads
2399 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2400 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2401 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2402 @end table
2403
2404 @table @code
2405 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2406 @item thread @var{threadno}
2407 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2408 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2409 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2410 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2411 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2412
2413 @smallexample
2414 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2415 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2416 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2417 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2418 @end smallexample
2419
2420 @noindent
2421 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2422 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2423 threads.
2424
2425 @kindex thread apply
2426 @cindex apply command to several threads
2427 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2428 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2429 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2430 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2431 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2432 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2433 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2434 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2435 @end table
2436
2437 @cindex automatic thread selection
2438 @cindex switching threads automatically
2439 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2440 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2441 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2442 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2443 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2444 thread.
2445
2446 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2447 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2448 programs with multiple threads.
2449
2450 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2451 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2452
2453 @node Processes
2454 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2455
2456 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2457 @cindex multiple processes
2458 @cindex processes, multiple
2459 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2460 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2461 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2462 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2463 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2464 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2465 will cause it to terminate.
2466
2467 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2468 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2469 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2470 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2471 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2472 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2473 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2474 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2475 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2476 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2477
2478 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2479 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2480 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2481 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2482
2483 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2484 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2485
2486 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2487 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2488
2489 @table @code
2490 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2491 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2492 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2493 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2494 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2495
2496 @table @code
2497 @item parent
2498 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2499 unimpeded. This is the default.
2500
2501 @item child
2502 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2503 unimpeded.
2504
2505 @end table
2506
2507 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2508 @item show follow-fork-mode
2509 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2510 @end table
2511
2512 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2513 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2514 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2518 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2519 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2520 retain debugger control over them both.
2521
2522 @table @code
2523 @item on
2524 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2525 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2526 independently. This is the default.
2527
2528 @item off
2529 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2530 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2531 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2532 is held suspended.
2533
2534 @end table
2535
2536 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2537 @item show detach-on-follow
2538 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2539 @end table
2540
2541 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2542 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2543 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2544 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2545 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2546
2547 @table @code
2548 @kindex info forks
2549 @item info forks
2550 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2551 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2552 position (program counter) of the process.
2553
2554
2555 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2556 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2557 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2558 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2559 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2560
2561 @end table
2562
2563 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2564 from it by using the @w{@code{detach-fork}} command (allowing it to
2565 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2566 @w{@code{delete-fork}} command.
2567
2568 @table @code
2569 @kindex detach-fork @var{fork-id}
2570 @item detach-fork @var{fork-id}
2571 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2572 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2573 allowed to run independently.
2574
2575 @kindex delete-fork @var{fork-id}
2576 @item delete-fork @var{fork-id}
2577 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2578 and remove it from the fork list.
2579
2580 @end table
2581
2582 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2583 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2584 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2585 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2586 the child process's @code{main}.
2587
2588 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2589 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2590
2591 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2592 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2593 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2594 argument.
2595
2596 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2597 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2598 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2599
2600 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2601 @section Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2602
2603 @cindex checkpoint
2604 @cindex restart
2605 @cindex bookmark
2606 @cindex snapshot of a process
2607 @cindex rewind program state
2608
2609 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2610 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2611 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2612 later.
2613
2614 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2615 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2616 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2617 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2618 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2619
2620 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2621 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2622 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2623 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2624 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2625 start again from there.
2626
2627 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2628 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2629
2630 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2631
2632 @table @code
2633 @kindex checkpoint
2634 @item checkpoint
2635 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2636 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2637 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2638
2639 @kindex info checkpoints
2640 @item info checkpoints
2641 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2642 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2643 listed:
2644
2645 @table @code
2646 @item Checkpoint ID
2647 @item Process ID
2648 @item Code Address
2649 @item Source line, or label
2650 @end table
2651
2652 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2653 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2654 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2655 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2656 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2657 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2658 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2659
2660 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2661 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2662 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2663 the debugger.
2664
2665 @kindex delete-checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2666 @item delete-checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2667 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2668
2669 @end table
2670
2671 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2672 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2673 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2674 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2675 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2676 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2677 previously read data can be read again.
2678
2679 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2680 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2681 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2682 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2683 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2684 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2685
2686 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2687 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2688 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2689 different execution path this time.
2690
2691 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2692 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2693 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2694 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2695 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2696 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2697 potentially pose a problem.
2698
2699 @subsection A non-obvious benefit of using checkpoints
2700
2701 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2702 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2703 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2704 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2705 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2706 next.
2707
2708 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2709 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2710 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2711 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2712 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2713
2714 @node Stopping
2715 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2716
2717 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2718 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2719 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2720
2721 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2722 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2723 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2724 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2725 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2726 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2727 explicitly request this information at any time.
2728
2729 @table @code
2730 @kindex info program
2731 @item info program
2732 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2733 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2734 @end table
2735
2736 @menu
2737 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2738 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2739 * Signals:: Signals
2740 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2741 @end menu
2742
2743 @node Breakpoints
2744 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2745
2746 @cindex breakpoints
2747 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2748 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2749 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2750 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2751 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2752 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2753 program.
2754
2755 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2756 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2757 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2758 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2759 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2760 call).
2761
2762 @cindex watchpoints
2763 @cindex memory tracing
2764 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2765 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2766 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2767 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2768 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2769 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2770 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2771 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2772
2773 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2774 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2775 Automatic display}.
2776
2777 @cindex catchpoints
2778 @cindex breakpoint on events
2779 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2780 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2781 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2782 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2783 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2784 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2785 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2786
2787 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2788 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2789 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2790 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2791 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2792 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2793 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2794 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2795 enable it again.
2796
2797 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2798 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2799 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2800 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2801 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2802 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2803 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2804
2805 @menu
2806 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2807 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2808 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2809 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2810 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2811 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2812 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2813 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2814 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2815 * Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2816 @end menu
2817
2818 @node Set Breaks
2819 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2820
2821 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2822 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2823 @c
2824 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2825
2826 @kindex break
2827 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2828 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2829 @cindex latest breakpoint
2830 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2831 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2832 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2833 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2834 convenience variables.
2835
2836 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2837
2838 @table @code
2839 @item break @var{function}
2840 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2841 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2842 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2843 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2844
2845 @item break +@var{offset}
2846 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2847 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2848 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2849 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2850
2851 @item break @var{linenum}
2852 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2853 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2854 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2855 code on that line.
2856
2857 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2858 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2859
2860 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2861 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2862 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2863 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2864 functions.
2865
2866 @item break *@var{address}
2867 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2868 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2869 information or source files.
2870
2871 @item break
2872 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2873 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2874 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2875 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2876 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2877 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2878 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2879 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2880 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2881 inside loops.
2882
2883 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2884 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2885 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2886 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2887 existed when your program stopped.
2888
2889 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2890 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2891 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2892 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2893 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2894 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2895 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2896
2897 @kindex tbreak
2898 @item tbreak @var{args}
2899 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2900 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2901 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2902 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2903
2904 @kindex hbreak
2905 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2906 @item hbreak @var{args}
2907 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2908 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2909 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2910 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2911 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2912 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2913 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2914 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2915 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2916 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2917 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2918 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2919 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2920 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2921 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2922 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2923 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2924
2925
2926 @kindex thbreak
2927 @item thbreak @var{args}
2928 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2929 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2930 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2931 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2932 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2933 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2934 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2935 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2936
2937 @kindex rbreak
2938 @cindex regular expression
2939 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2940 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2941 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2942 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2943 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2944 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2945 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2946 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2947 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2948
2949 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2950 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2951 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2952 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2953 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2954 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2955
2956 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2957 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2958 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2959 classes.
2960
2961 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2962 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2963 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2964
2965 @smallexample
2966 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2967 @end smallexample
2968
2969 @kindex info breakpoints
2970 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2971 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2972 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2973 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2974 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2975 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2976
2977 @table @emph
2978 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2979 @item Type
2980 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2981 @item Disposition
2982 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2983 @item Enabled or Disabled
2984 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2985 that are not enabled.
2986 @item Address
2987 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
2988 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
2989 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
2990 @item What
2991 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2992 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
2993 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
2994 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
2995 @end table
2996
2997 @noindent
2998 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2999 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3000 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3001 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3002 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3003 valid location.
3004
3005 @noindent
3006 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3007 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3008 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3009 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3010 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
3011
3012 @noindent
3013 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3014 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3015 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3016 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3017 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3018 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3019 @end table
3020
3021 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3022 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3023 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3024 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3025
3026 @cindex pending breakpoints
3027 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3028 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3029 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3030 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3031 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3032 gets loaded.
3033
3034 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3035 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3036 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3037 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3038 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3039 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3040
3041 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3042 breakpoint support:
3043
3044 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3045 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3046 @table @code
3047 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3048 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3049 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3050
3051 @item set breakpoint pending on
3052 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3053 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3054
3055 @item set breakpoint pending off
3056 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3057 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3058 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3059
3060 @item show breakpoint pending
3061 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3062 @end table
3063
3064 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3065 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3066 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3067 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3068 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3069 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3070 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3071 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3072 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3073 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3074 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3075 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3076 of these loads could resolve the location.
3077
3078 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3079 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3080 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3081 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3082 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3083 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3084 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3085 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3086
3087
3088 @node Set Watchpoints
3089 @subsection Setting watchpoints
3090
3091 @cindex setting watchpoints
3092 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3093 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3094 this may happen.
3095
3096 @cindex software watchpoints
3097 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3098 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3099 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3100 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3101 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3102 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3103 culprit.)
3104
3105 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3106 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3107 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3108
3109 @table @code
3110 @kindex watch
3111 @item watch @var{expr}
3112 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
3113 is written into by the program and its value changes.
3114
3115 @kindex rwatch
3116 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3117 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3118 by the program.
3119
3120 @kindex awatch
3121 @item awatch @var{expr}
3122 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3123 or written into by the program.
3124
3125 @kindex info watchpoints
3126 @item info watchpoints
3127 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3128 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3129 @end table
3130
3131 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3132 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3133 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3134 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3135 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3136 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3137
3138 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3139 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3140 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3141 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3142 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3143 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3144 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3145 mechanism of watching expressiion values.)
3146
3147 @table @code
3148 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3149 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3150 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3151
3152 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3153 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3154 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3155 @end table
3156
3157 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3158 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3159 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3160
3161 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3162
3163 @smallexample
3164 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3165 @end smallexample
3166
3167 @noindent
3168 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3169
3170 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3171 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3172 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3173 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3174 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3175 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3176 will print a message like this:
3177
3178 @smallexample
3179 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3180 @end smallexample
3181
3182 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3183 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3184 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3185 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3186 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3187 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3188 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3189 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3190
3191 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3192 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3193 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3194 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3195 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3196 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3197
3198 @smallexample
3199 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3200 @end smallexample
3201
3202 @noindent
3203 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3204
3205 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3206 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3207 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3208 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3209 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3210 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3211 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3212 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3213 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3214 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3215
3216 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3217 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3218 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3219
3220 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3221 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3222 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3223 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3224 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3225 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3226 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3227 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3228 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3229
3230 @quotation
3231 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3232 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3233 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3234 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3235 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3236 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3237 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3238 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3239 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3240 the expression.
3241
3242 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3243 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3244 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3245 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3246 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3247 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3248 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3249 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3250 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3251 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3252 @end quotation
3253
3254 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3255
3256 @node Set Catchpoints
3257 @subsection Setting catchpoints
3258 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3259 @cindex exception handlers
3260 @cindex event handling
3261
3262 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3263 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3264 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3265
3266 @table @code
3267 @kindex catch
3268 @item catch @var{event}
3269 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3270 @table @code
3271 @item throw
3272 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3273 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3274
3275 @item catch
3276 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3277
3278 @item exec
3279 @cindex break on fork/exec
3280 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3281
3282 @item fork
3283 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3284
3285 @item vfork
3286 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3287
3288 @item load
3289 @itemx load @var{libname}
3290 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3291 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3292 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3293
3294 @item unload
3295 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3296 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3297 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3298 @end table
3299
3300 @item tcatch @var{event}
3301 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3302 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3303
3304 @end table
3305
3306 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3307
3308 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3309 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3310
3311 @itemize @bullet
3312 @item
3313 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3314 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3315 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3316 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3317 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3318 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3319 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3320 disabled within interactive calls.
3321
3322 @item
3323 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3324
3325 @item
3326 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3327 @end itemize
3328
3329 @cindex raise exceptions
3330 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3331 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3332 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3333 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3334 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3335 out where the exception was raised.
3336
3337 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3338 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3339 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3340 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3341
3342 @smallexample
3343 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3344 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3345 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3346 @end smallexample
3347
3348 @noindent
3349 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3350 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3351 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
3352
3353 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
3354 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3355 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3356 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3357 raised.
3358
3359
3360 @node Delete Breaks
3361 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
3362
3363 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3364 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3365 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3366 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3367 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3368 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3369
3370 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3371 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3372 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3373 their breakpoint numbers.
3374
3375 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3376 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3377 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3378
3379 @table @code
3380 @kindex clear
3381 @item clear
3382 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3383 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
3384 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3385 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3386
3387 @item clear @var{function}
3388 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3389 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3390
3391 @item clear @var{linenum}
3392 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3393 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3394 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3395
3396 @cindex delete breakpoints
3397 @kindex delete
3398 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3399 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3400 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3401 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3402 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3403 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3404 @end table
3405
3406 @node Disabling
3407 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
3408
3409 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3410 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3411 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3412 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3413 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3414
3415 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3416 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3417 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3418 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3419 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3420
3421 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3422 states of enablement:
3423
3424 @itemize @bullet
3425 @item
3426 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3427 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3428 @item
3429 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3430 @item
3431 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3432 disabled.
3433 @item
3434 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3435 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3436 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3437 @end itemize
3438
3439 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3440 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3441
3442 @table @code
3443 @kindex disable
3444 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3445 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3446 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3447 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3448 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3449 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3450 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3451
3452 @kindex enable
3453 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3454 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3455 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3456
3457 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3458 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3459 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3460
3461 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3462 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3463 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3464 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3465 @end table
3466
3467 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3468 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3469 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3470 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3471 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3472 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3473 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3474 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3475 stepping}.)
3476
3477 @node Conditions
3478 @subsection Break conditions
3479 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3480 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3481
3482 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3483 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3484 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3485 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3486 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3487 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3488 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3489 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3490
3491 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3492 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3493 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3494 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3495 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3496
3497 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3498 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3499 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3500 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3501 one.
3502
3503 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3504 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3505 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3506 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3507 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3508 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3509 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3510 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3511 conditions for the
3512 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3513 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3514
3515 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3516 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3517 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3518 with the @code{condition} command.
3519
3520 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3521 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3522 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3523 catchpoint.
3524
3525 @table @code
3526 @kindex condition
3527 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3528 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3529 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3530 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3531 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3532 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3533 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3534 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3535 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3536 prints an error message:
3537
3538 @smallexample
3539 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3540 @end smallexample
3541
3542 @noindent
3543 @value{GDBN} does
3544 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3545 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3546 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3547
3548 @item condition @var{bnum}
3549 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3550 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3551 @end table
3552
3553 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3554 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3555 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3556 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3557 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3558 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3559 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3560 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3561 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3562 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3563 your program reaches it.
3564
3565 @table @code
3566 @kindex ignore
3567 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3568 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3569 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3570 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3571 takes no action.
3572
3573 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3574 a count of zero.
3575
3576 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3577 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3578 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3579 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3580
3581 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3582 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3583 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3584
3585 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3586 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3587 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3588 variables}.
3589 @end table
3590
3591 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3592
3593
3594 @node Break Commands
3595 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3596
3597 @cindex breakpoint commands
3598 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3599 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3600 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3601 enable other breakpoints.
3602
3603 @table @code
3604 @kindex commands
3605 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3606 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3607 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3608 @itemx end
3609 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3610 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3611 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3612
3613 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3614 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3615
3616 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3617 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3618 recently encountered).
3619 @end table
3620
3621 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3622 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3623
3624 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3625 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3626 that resumes execution.
3627
3628 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3629 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3630 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3631 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3632 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3633
3634 @kindex silent
3635 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3636 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3637 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3638 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3639 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3640 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3641
3642 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3643 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3644 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3645
3646 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3647 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3648
3649 @smallexample
3650 break foo if x>0
3651 commands
3652 silent
3653 printf "x is %d\n",x
3654 cont
3655 end
3656 @end smallexample
3657
3658 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3659 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3660 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3661 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3662 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3663 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3664 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3665
3666 @smallexample
3667 break 403
3668 commands
3669 silent
3670 set x = y + 4
3671 cont
3672 end
3673 @end smallexample
3674
3675 @node Breakpoint Menus
3676 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3677 @cindex overloading
3678 @cindex symbol overloading
3679
3680 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3681 single function name
3682 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3683 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3684 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3685 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3686 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3687 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3688 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3689 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3690 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3691 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3692 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3693 breakpoints.
3694
3695 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3696 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3697 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3698
3699 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3700 @smallexample
3701 @group
3702 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3703 [0] cancel
3704 [1] all
3705 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3706 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3707 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3708 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3709 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3710 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3711 > 2 4 6
3712 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3713 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3714 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3715 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3716 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3717 breakpoints.
3718 (@value{GDBP})
3719 @end group
3720 @end smallexample
3721
3722 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3723 @node Error in Breakpoints
3724 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3725 @c
3726 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3727 @c
3728 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3729 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3730 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3731 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3732
3733 @smallexample
3734 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3735 The same program may be running in another process.
3736 @end smallexample
3737
3738 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3739
3740 @enumerate
3741 @item
3742 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3743
3744 @item
3745 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3746 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3747 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3748 Then start your program again.
3749
3750 @item
3751 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3752 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3753 to nonsharable executables.
3754 @end enumerate
3755 @c @end ifclear
3756
3757 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3758 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3759
3760 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3761 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3762 @smallexample
3763 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3764 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3765 @end smallexample
3766
3767 @noindent
3768 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3769 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3770 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3771
3772 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3773 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3774
3775 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3776 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3777 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3778
3779 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3780 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3781 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3782 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3783
3784 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3785 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3786 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3787 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3788 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3789 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3790 first in the bundle.
3791
3792 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3793 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3794 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3795 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3796 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3797 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3798 is hit.
3799
3800 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3801 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3802
3803 @smallexample
3804 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3805 @end smallexample
3806
3807 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3808 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3809 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3810 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3811 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3812 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3813 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3814 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3815
3816 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3817 adjusted breakpoints:
3818
3819 @smallexample
3820 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3821 to 0x00010410.
3822 @end smallexample
3823
3824 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3825 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3826 frequently than expected.
3827
3828 @node Continuing and Stepping
3829 @section Continuing and stepping
3830
3831 @cindex stepping
3832 @cindex continuing
3833 @cindex resuming execution
3834 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3835 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3836 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3837 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3838 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3839 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3840 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3841 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3842
3843 @table @code
3844 @kindex continue
3845 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3846 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3847 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3848 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3849 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3850 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3851 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3852 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3853 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3854 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3855
3856 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3857 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3858 @code{continue} is ignored.
3859
3860 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3861 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3862 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3863 @code{continue}.
3864 @end table
3865
3866 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3867 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3868 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3869 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3870
3871 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3872 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3873 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3874 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3875 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3876 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3877
3878 @table @code
3879 @kindex step
3880 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3881 @item step
3882 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3883 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3884 abbreviated @code{s}.
3885
3886 @quotation
3887 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3888 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3889 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3890 @c distinction here.
3891 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3892 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3893 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3894 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3895 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3896 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3897 below.
3898 @end quotation
3899
3900 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3901 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3902 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3903 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3904 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3905 called within the line.
3906
3907 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3908 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3909 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3910 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3911 was any debugging information about the routine.
3912
3913 @item step @var{count}
3914 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3915 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3916 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3917
3918 @kindex next
3919 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3920 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3921 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3922 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3923 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3924 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3925 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3926 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3927
3928 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3929
3930
3931 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3932 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3933 @c
3934 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3935 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3936 @c function are executed without stopping.
3937
3938 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3939 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3940 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3941
3942 @kindex set step-mode
3943 @item set step-mode
3944 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3945 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3946 @itemx set step-mode on
3947 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3948 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3949 information rather than stepping over it.
3950
3951 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3952 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3953 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3954
3955 @item set step-mode off
3956 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3957 debug information. This is the default.
3958
3959 @item show step-mode
3960 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
3961 source line debug information.
3962
3963 @kindex finish
3964 @item finish
3965 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3966 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3967
3968 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3969 ,Returning from a function}).
3970
3971 @kindex until
3972 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3973 @cindex run until specified location
3974 @item until
3975 @itemx u
3976 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3977 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3978 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3979 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3980 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3981 than the address of the jump.
3982
3983 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3984 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3985 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3986 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3987 through the next iteration.
3988
3989 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3990 stack frame.
3991
3992 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3993 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3994 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3995 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3996 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3997
3998 @smallexample
3999 (@value{GDBP}) f
4000 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4001 206 expand_input();
4002 (@value{GDBP}) until
4003 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4004 @end smallexample
4005
4006 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4007 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4008 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4009 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4010 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4011 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4012 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4013
4014 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4015 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4016 argument.
4017
4018 @item until @var{location}
4019 @itemx u @var{location}
4020 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4021 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4022 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4023 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4024 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4025 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4026 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4027 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4028 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4029 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
4030 invocations have returned.
4031
4032 @smallexample
4033 94 int factorial (int value)
4034 95 @{
4035 96 if (value > 1) @{
4036 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4037 98 @}
4038 99 return (value);
4039 100 @}
4040 @end smallexample
4041
4042
4043 @kindex advance @var{location}
4044 @itemx advance @var{location}
4045 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4046 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4047 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4048 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4049 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4050 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4051
4052
4053 @kindex stepi
4054 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4055 @item stepi
4056 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4057 @itemx si
4058 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4059
4060 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4061 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4062 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4063 Display,, Automatic display}.
4064
4065 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4066
4067 @need 750
4068 @kindex nexti
4069 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4070 @item nexti
4071 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4072 @itemx ni
4073 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4074 proceed until the function returns.
4075
4076 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4077 @end table
4078
4079 @node Signals
4080 @section Signals
4081 @cindex signals
4082
4083 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4084 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4085 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4086 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
4087 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4088 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4089 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4090 requested an alarm).
4091
4092 @cindex fatal signals
4093 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4094 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4095 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4096 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4097 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4098 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4099
4100 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4101 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4102 signal.
4103
4104 @cindex handling signals
4105 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4106 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4107 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4108 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4109 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4110
4111 @table @code
4112 @kindex info signals
4113 @kindex info handle
4114 @item info signals
4115 @itemx info handle
4116 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4117 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4118 the defined types of signals.
4119
4120 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4121
4122 @kindex handle
4123 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
4124 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4125 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4126 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4127 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4128 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
4129 @end table
4130
4131 @c @group
4132 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4133 Their full names are:
4134
4135 @table @code
4136 @item nostop
4137 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4138 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4139
4140 @item stop
4141 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4142 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4143
4144 @item print
4145 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4146
4147 @item noprint
4148 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4149 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4150
4151 @item pass
4152 @itemx noignore
4153 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4154 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4155 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4156
4157 @item nopass
4158 @itemx ignore
4159 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4160 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4161 @end table
4162 @c @end group
4163
4164 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4165 program until you
4166 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4167 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4168 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4169 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4170 program sees that signal when you continue.
4171
4172 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4173 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4174 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4175 erroneous signals.
4176
4177 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4178 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4179 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4180 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4181 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4182 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4183 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4184 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4185 program a signal}.
4186
4187 @node Thread Stops
4188 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4189
4190 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4191 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
4192 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4193
4194 @table @code
4195 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4196 @cindex thread breakpoints
4197 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4198 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4199 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4200 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4201 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4202
4203 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4204 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4205 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4206 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4207 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4208
4209 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4210 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4211 program.
4212
4213 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4214 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4215 breakpoint condition, like this:
4216
4217 @smallexample
4218 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4219 @end smallexample
4220
4221 @end table
4222
4223 @cindex stopped threads
4224 @cindex threads, stopped
4225 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4226 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4227 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4228 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4229 underfoot.
4230
4231 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4232 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4233 @cindex premature return from system calls
4234 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4235 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4236 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4237 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4238 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4239 stop execution.
4240
4241 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4242 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4243 style anyways.
4244
4245 For example, do not write code like this:
4246
4247 @smallexample
4248 sleep (10);
4249 @end smallexample
4250
4251 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4252 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4253
4254 Instead, write this:
4255
4256 @smallexample
4257 int unslept = 10;
4258 while (unslept > 0)
4259 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4260 @end smallexample
4261
4262 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4263 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4264 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4265 @value{GDBN}.
4266
4267 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4268 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4269 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4270 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4271
4272 @cindex continuing threads
4273 @cindex threads, continuing
4274 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4275 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4276 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4277
4278 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4279 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4280 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4281 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4282 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4283 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4284 stops.
4285
4286 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4287 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4288 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4289 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4290
4291 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4292 thread to run.
4293
4294 @table @code
4295 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4296 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4297 @cindex lock scheduler
4298 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4299 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4300 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4301 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4302 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4303 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4304 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4305 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4306 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4307 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4308 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4309
4310 @item show scheduler-locking
4311 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4312 @end table
4313
4314
4315 @node Stack
4316 @chapter Examining the Stack
4317
4318 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4319 stopped and how it got there.
4320
4321 @cindex call stack
4322 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4323 is generated.
4324 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4325 the arguments of the call,
4326 and the local variables of the function being called.
4327 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4328 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4329 stack}.
4330
4331 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4332 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4333
4334 @cindex selected frame
4335 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4336 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4337 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4338 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4339 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4340 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4341
4342 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4343 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4344 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
4345
4346 @menu
4347 * Frames:: Stack frames
4348 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4349 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4350 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4351
4352 @end menu
4353
4354 @node Frames
4355 @section Stack frames
4356
4357 @cindex frame, definition
4358 @cindex stack frame
4359 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4360 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4361 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4362 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4363 which the function is executing.
4364
4365 @cindex initial frame
4366 @cindex outermost frame
4367 @cindex innermost frame
4368 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4369 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4370 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4371 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4372 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4373 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4374 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4375 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4376
4377 @cindex frame pointer
4378 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4379 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4380 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4381 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4382 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4383 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4384
4385 @cindex frame number
4386 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4387 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4388 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4389 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4390 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4391
4392 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4393 @c underflow problems.
4394 @cindex frameless execution
4395 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4396 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
4397 @smallexample
4398 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4399 @end smallexample
4400 generates functions without a frame.)
4401 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4402 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4403 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4404 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4405 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4406 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4407 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4408
4409 @table @code
4410 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4411 @cindex current stack frame
4412 @item frame @var{args}
4413 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4414 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4415 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4416 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4417
4418 @kindex select-frame
4419 @cindex selecting frame silently
4420 @item select-frame
4421 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4422 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4423 @code{frame}.
4424 @end table
4425
4426 @node Backtrace
4427 @section Backtraces
4428
4429 @cindex traceback
4430 @cindex call stack traces
4431 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4432 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4433 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4434 stack.
4435
4436 @table @code
4437 @kindex backtrace
4438 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4439 @item backtrace
4440 @itemx bt
4441 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4442 frames in the stack.
4443
4444 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4445 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
4446
4447 @item backtrace @var{n}
4448 @itemx bt @var{n}
4449 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4450
4451 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4452 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4453 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4454
4455 @item backtrace full
4456 Print the values of the local variables also.
4457 @itemx bt full
4458 @end table
4459
4460 @kindex where
4461 @kindex info stack
4462 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4463 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4464
4465 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4466 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4467 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4468 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4469 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4470 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4471 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4472 multi-threaded program.
4473
4474 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4475 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4476 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4477 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4478 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4479 line number.
4480
4481 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4482 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4483
4484 @smallexample
4485 @group
4486 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4487 at builtin.c:993
4488 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4489 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4490 at macro.c:71
4491 (More stack frames follow...)
4492 @end group
4493 @end smallexample
4494
4495 @noindent
4496 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4497 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4498 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4499
4500 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4501 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4502 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4503 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4504 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4505 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4506 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4507 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4508 such a backtrace might look like:
4509
4510 @smallexample
4511 @group
4512 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4513 at builtin.c:993
4514 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4515 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4516 at macro.c:71
4517 (More stack frames follow...)
4518 @end group
4519 @end smallexample
4520
4521 @noindent
4522 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4523 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4524
4525 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4526 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4527 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4528
4529 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4530 @cindex program entry point
4531 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4532 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4533 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4534 @code{main}@footnote{
4535 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4536 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4537 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4538 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4539 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4540 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4541
4542 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4543 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4544
4545 @table @code
4546 @item set backtrace past-main
4547 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4548 @kindex set backtrace
4549 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4550
4551 @item set backtrace past-main off
4552 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4553 default.
4554
4555 @item show backtrace past-main
4556 @kindex show backtrace
4557 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4558
4559 @item set backtrace past-entry
4560 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4561 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4562 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4563 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4564
4565 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4566 Backtraces will stop when they encouter the internal entry point of an
4567 application. This is the default.
4568
4569 @item show backtrace past-entry
4570 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4571
4572 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4573 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4574 @cindex backtrace limit
4575 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4576 unlimited.
4577
4578 @item show backtrace limit
4579 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4580 @end table
4581
4582 @node Selection
4583 @section Selecting a frame
4584
4585 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4586 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4587 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4588 of the stack frame just selected.
4589
4590 @table @code
4591 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4592 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4593 @item frame @var{n}
4594 @itemx f @var{n}
4595 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4596 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4597 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4598 @code{main}.
4599
4600 @item frame @var{addr}
4601 @itemx f @var{addr}
4602 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4603 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4604 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4605 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4606 switches between them.
4607
4608 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4609 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4610
4611 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4612 pointer and a program counter.
4613
4614 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4615 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4616
4617 @kindex up
4618 @item up @var{n}
4619 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4620 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4621 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4622
4623 @kindex down
4624 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4625 @item down @var{n}
4626 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4627 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4628 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4629 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4630 @end table
4631
4632 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4633 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4634 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4635 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4636
4637 @need 1000
4638 For example:
4639
4640 @smallexample
4641 @group
4642 (@value{GDBP}) up
4643 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4644 at env.c:10
4645 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4646 @end group
4647 @end smallexample
4648
4649 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4650 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4651 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4652 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4653 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4654 for details.
4655
4656 @table @code
4657 @kindex down-silently
4658 @kindex up-silently
4659 @item up-silently @var{n}
4660 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4661 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4662 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4663 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4664 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4665 distracting.
4666 @end table
4667
4668 @node Frame Info
4669 @section Information about a frame
4670
4671 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4672 stack frame.
4673
4674 @table @code
4675 @item frame
4676 @itemx f
4677 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4678 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4679 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4680 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4681 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4682
4683 @kindex info frame
4684 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4685 @item info frame
4686 @itemx info f
4687 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4688 including:
4689
4690 @itemize @bullet
4691 @item
4692 the address of the frame
4693 @item
4694 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4695 @item
4696 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4697 @item
4698 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4699 @item
4700 the address of the frame's arguments
4701 @item
4702 the address of the frame's local variables
4703 @item
4704 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4705 @item
4706 which registers were saved in the frame
4707 @end itemize
4708
4709 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4710 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4711 the usual conventions.
4712
4713 @item info frame @var{addr}
4714 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4715 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4716 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4717 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4718 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4719 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4720
4721 @kindex info args
4722 @item info args
4723 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4724
4725 @item info locals
4726 @kindex info locals
4727 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4728 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4729 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4730
4731 @kindex info catch
4732 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4733 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4734 @item info catch
4735 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4736 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4737 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4738 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4739 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4740
4741 @end table
4742
4743
4744 @node Source
4745 @chapter Examining Source Files
4746
4747 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4748 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4749 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4750 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4751 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4752 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4753 source files by explicit command.
4754
4755 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4756 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4757 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4758
4759 @menu
4760 * List:: Printing source lines
4761 * Edit:: Editing source files
4762 * Search:: Searching source files
4763 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4764 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4765 @end menu
4766
4767 @node List
4768 @section Printing source lines
4769
4770 @kindex list
4771 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4772 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4773 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4774 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4775
4776 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4777
4778 @table @code
4779 @item list @var{linenum}
4780 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4781 current source file.
4782
4783 @item list @var{function}
4784 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4785 @var{function}.
4786
4787 @item list
4788 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4789 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4790 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4791 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4792 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4793
4794 @item list -
4795 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4796 @end table
4797
4798 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4799 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4800 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4801
4802 @table @code
4803 @kindex set listsize
4804 @item set listsize @var{count}
4805 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4806 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4807
4808 @kindex show listsize
4809 @item show listsize
4810 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4811 @end table
4812
4813 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4814 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4815 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4816 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4817 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4818
4819 @cindex linespec
4820 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4821 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4822 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4823 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4824
4825 @table @code
4826 @item list @var{linespec}
4827 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4828
4829 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4830 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4831 linespecs.
4832
4833 @item list ,@var{last}
4834 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4835
4836 @item list @var{first},
4837 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4838
4839 @item list +
4840 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4841
4842 @item list -
4843 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4844
4845 @item list
4846 As described in the preceding table.
4847 @end table
4848
4849 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4850 kinds of linespec.
4851
4852 @table @code
4853 @item @var{number}
4854 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4855 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4856 the same source file as the first linespec.
4857
4858 @item +@var{offset}
4859 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4860 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4861 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4862 first linespec.
4863
4864 @item -@var{offset}
4865 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4866
4867 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4868 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4869
4870 @item @var{function}
4871 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4872 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4873
4874 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4875 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4876 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4877 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4878 identically named functions in different source files.
4879
4880 @item *@var{address}
4881 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4882 @var{address} may be any expression.
4883 @end table
4884
4885 @node Edit
4886 @section Editing source files
4887 @cindex editing source files
4888
4889 @kindex edit
4890 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4891 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4892 The editing program of your choice
4893 is invoked with the current line set to
4894 the active line in the program.
4895 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4896 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4897
4898 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4899
4900 @table @code
4901 @item edit
4902 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4903
4904 @item edit @var{number}
4905 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4906
4907 @item edit @var{function}
4908 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4909
4910 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4911 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4912
4913 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4914 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4915 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4916 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4917 identically named functions in different source files.
4918
4919 @item edit *@var{address}
4920 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4921 @var{address} may be any expression.
4922 @end table
4923
4924 @subsection Choosing your editor
4925 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4926 @footnote{
4927 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4928 following command-line syntax:
4929 @smallexample
4930 ex +@var{number} file
4931 @end smallexample
4932 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
4933 the file where to start editing.}.
4934 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
4935 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4936 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4937 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4938 @smallexample
4939 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4940 export EDITOR
4941 gdb @dots{}
4942 @end smallexample
4943 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4944 @smallexample
4945 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4946 gdb @dots{}
4947 @end smallexample
4948
4949 @node Search
4950 @section Searching source files
4951 @cindex searching source files
4952
4953 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4954 regular expression.
4955
4956 @table @code
4957 @kindex search
4958 @kindex forward-search
4959 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4960 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4961 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4962 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4963 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4964 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4965 @code{fo}.
4966
4967 @kindex reverse-search
4968 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4969 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4970 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4971 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4972 this command as @code{rev}.
4973 @end table
4974
4975 @node Source Path
4976 @section Specifying source directories
4977
4978 @cindex source path
4979 @cindex directories for source files
4980 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4981 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4982 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4983 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4984 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4985 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4986 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
4987
4988 For example, suppose an executable references the file
4989 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
4990 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
4991 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
4992 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
4993 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
4994 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
4995 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
4996 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
4997 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
4998 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
4999
5000 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5001 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5002 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5003 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5004 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5005 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5006
5007 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5008 source files. Neither is the current working directory, unless it
5009 happens to be in the source path.
5010
5011 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5012 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5013 each line is in the file.
5014
5015 @kindex directory
5016 @kindex dir
5017 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5018 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5019 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5020
5021 @table @code
5022 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5023 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5024 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5025 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5026 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5027 part of absolute file names) or
5028 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5029 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5030
5031 @kindex cdir
5032 @kindex cwd
5033 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5034 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
5035 @cindex compilation directory
5036 @cindex current directory
5037 @cindex working directory
5038 @cindex directory, current
5039 @cindex directory, compilation
5040 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5041 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5042 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5043 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5044 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5045 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5046
5047 @item directory
5048 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
5049
5050 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5051 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5052
5053 @item show directories
5054 @kindex show directories
5055 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5056 @end table
5057
5058 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5059 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5060 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5061
5062 @enumerate
5063 @item
5064 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
5065
5066 @item
5067 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5068 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5069 directories in one command.
5070 @end enumerate
5071
5072 @node Machine Code
5073 @section Source and machine code
5074 @cindex source line and its code address
5075
5076 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5077 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5078 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5079 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5080 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5081 well as hex.
5082
5083 @table @code
5084 @kindex info line
5085 @item info line @var{linespec}
5086 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5087 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5088 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5089 source lines}).
5090 @end table
5091
5092 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5093 the object code for the first line of function
5094 @code{m4_changequote}:
5095
5096 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5097 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5098 @smallexample
5099 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5100 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5101 @end smallexample
5102
5103 @noindent
5104 @cindex code address and its source line
5105 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5106 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5107 @smallexample
5108 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5109 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5110 @end smallexample
5111
5112 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5113 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5114 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5115 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5116 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5117 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5118 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5119 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5120 variables}).
5121
5122 @table @code
5123 @kindex disassemble
5124 @cindex assembly instructions
5125 @cindex instructions, assembly
5126 @cindex machine instructions
5127 @cindex listing machine instructions
5128 @item disassemble
5129 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5130 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5131 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5132 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5133 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5134 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5135 @end table
5136
5137 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5138 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5139
5140 @smallexample
5141 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5142 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5143 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5144 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5145 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5146 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5147 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5148 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5149 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5150 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5151 End of assembler dump.
5152 @end smallexample
5153
5154 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5155 mnemonics or other syntax.
5156
5157 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5158 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5159 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5160 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5161 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5162
5163 @table @code
5164 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5165 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5166 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5167 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5168 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5169 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5170
5171 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5172 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5173 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5174 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5175
5176 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5177 @item show disassembly-flavor
5178 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5179 @end table
5180
5181
5182 @node Data
5183 @chapter Examining Data
5184
5185 @cindex printing data
5186 @cindex examining data
5187 @kindex print
5188 @kindex inspect
5189 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5190 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5191 @c different window or something like that.
5192 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5193 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5194 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5195 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5196 Different Languages}).
5197
5198 @table @code
5199 @item print @var{expr}
5200 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5201 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5202 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5203 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5204 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5205 formats}.
5206
5207 @item print
5208 @itemx print /@var{f}
5209 @cindex reprint the last value
5210 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5211 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
5212 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5213 @end table
5214
5215 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5216 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5217 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5218
5219 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5220 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5221 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5222 Table}.
5223
5224 @menu
5225 * Expressions:: Expressions
5226 * Variables:: Program variables
5227 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5228 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5229 * Memory:: Examining memory
5230 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5231 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5232 * Value History:: Value history
5233 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5234 * Registers:: Registers
5235 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5236 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5237 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5238 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5239 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5240 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5241 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5242 character set than GDB does
5243 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5244 @end menu
5245
5246 @node Expressions
5247 @section Expressions
5248
5249 @cindex expressions
5250 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5251 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5252 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5253 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5254 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5255 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5256 @ref{Compilation}.
5257
5258 @cindex arrays in expressions
5259 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5260 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5261 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5262 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5263
5264 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5265 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5266 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5267 languages.
5268
5269 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5270 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5271
5272 @cindex casts, in expressions
5273 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5274 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5275 at that address in memory.
5276 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5277
5278 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5279 to programming languages:
5280
5281 @table @code
5282 @item @@
5283 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5284 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
5285
5286 @item ::
5287 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5288 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
5289
5290 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5291 @cindex type casting memory
5292 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5293 @cindex casts, to view memory
5294 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5295 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5296 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5297 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5298 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5299 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5300 @end table
5301
5302 @node Variables
5303 @section Program variables
5304
5305 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5306 in your program.
5307
5308 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5309 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
5310
5311 @itemize @bullet
5312 @item
5313 global (or file-static)
5314 @end itemize
5315
5316 @noindent or
5317
5318 @itemize @bullet
5319 @item
5320 visible according to the scope rules of the
5321 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5322 @end itemize
5323
5324 @noindent This means that in the function
5325
5326 @smallexample
5327 foo (a)
5328 int a;
5329 @{
5330 bar (a);
5331 @{
5332 int b = test ();
5333 bar (b);
5334 @}
5335 @}
5336 @end smallexample
5337
5338 @noindent
5339 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5340 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5341 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5342 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5343
5344 @cindex variable name conflict
5345 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5346 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5347 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5348 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5349 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5350 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5351 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5352
5353 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5354 @iftex
5355 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5356 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5357 @end iftex
5358 @smallexample
5359 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5360 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5361 @end smallexample
5362
5363 @noindent
5364 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5365 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5366 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5367 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5368
5369 @smallexample
5370 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5371 @end smallexample
5372
5373 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5374 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5375 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5376 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5377 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5378 @c conflict?? --mew
5379
5380 @cindex wrong values
5381 @cindex variable values, wrong
5382 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5383 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5384 @quotation
5385 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5386 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5387 scope, and just before exit.
5388 @end quotation
5389 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5390 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5391 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5392 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5393 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5394 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5395 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5396 variable definitions may be gone.
5397
5398 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5399 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5400 when compiling.
5401
5402 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5403 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5404 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5405 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5406 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5407 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5408 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5409
5410 @smallexample
5411 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5412 @end smallexample
5413
5414 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5415 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5416 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5417 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5418 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5419 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5420 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5421 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
5422 @xref{C, , Debugging C++}, for more info about debug info formats
5423 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5424
5425 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5426 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5427 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5428 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5429
5430 @node Arrays
5431 @section Artificial arrays
5432
5433 @cindex artificial array
5434 @cindex arrays
5435 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5436 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5437 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5438 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5439 program.
5440
5441 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5442 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5443 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5444 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5445 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5446 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5447 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5448 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5449 example. If a program says
5450
5451 @smallexample
5452 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5453 @end smallexample
5454
5455 @noindent
5456 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5457
5458 @smallexample
5459 p *array@@len
5460 @end smallexample
5461
5462 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5463 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5464 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5465 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5466 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
5467
5468 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5469 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5470 The value need not be in memory:
5471 @smallexample
5472 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5473 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5474 @end smallexample
5475
5476 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5477 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5478 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5479 @smallexample
5480 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5481 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5482 @end smallexample
5483
5484 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5485 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5486 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5487 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5488 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5489 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5490 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5491 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5492 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5493 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5494
5495 @smallexample
5496 set $i = 0
5497 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5498 @key{RET}
5499 @key{RET}
5500 @dots{}
5501 @end smallexample
5502
5503 @node Output Formats
5504 @section Output formats
5505
5506 @cindex formatted output
5507 @cindex output formats
5508 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5509 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5510 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5511 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5512 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5513
5514 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5515 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5516 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5517 letters supported are:
5518
5519 @table @code
5520 @item x
5521 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5522 hexadecimal.
5523
5524 @item d
5525 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5526
5527 @item u
5528 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5529
5530 @item o
5531 Print as integer in octal.
5532
5533 @item t
5534 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5535 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5536 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5537 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
5538
5539 @item a
5540 @cindex unknown address, locating
5541 @cindex locate address
5542 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5543 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5544 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5545
5546 @smallexample
5547 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5548 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5549 @end smallexample
5550
5551 @noindent
5552 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5553 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5554
5555 @item c
5556 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5557 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5558 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5559 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5560
5561 @item f
5562 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5563 using typical floating point syntax.
5564 @end table
5565
5566 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5567
5568 @smallexample
5569 p/x $pc
5570 @end smallexample
5571
5572 @noindent
5573 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5574 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5575
5576 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5577 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5578 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5579
5580 @node Memory
5581 @section Examining memory
5582
5583 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5584 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5585
5586 @cindex examining memory
5587 @table @code
5588 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5589 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5590 @itemx x @var{addr}
5591 @itemx x
5592 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5593 @end table
5594
5595 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5596 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5597 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5598 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5599 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5600
5601 @table @r
5602 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5603 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5604 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5605 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5606 @c 4.1.2.
5607
5608 @item @var{f}, the display format
5609 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5610 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5611 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5612 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5613 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5614 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5615
5616 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5617 The unit size is any of
5618
5619 @table @code
5620 @item b
5621 Bytes.
5622 @item h
5623 Halfwords (two bytes).
5624 @item w
5625 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5626 @item g
5627 Giant words (eight bytes).
5628 @end table
5629
5630 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5631 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5632 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5633
5634 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5635 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5636 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5637 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5638 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5639 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5640 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5641 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5642 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5643 a value from memory).
5644 @end table
5645
5646 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5647 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5648 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5649 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5650 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5651
5652 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5653 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5654 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5655 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5656 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5657
5658 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5659 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5660 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5661 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5662 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5663 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5664
5665 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5666 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5667 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5668 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5669 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5670 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5671 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5672
5673 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5674 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5675 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5676 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5677 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5678 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5679 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5680 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5681 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5682
5683 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5684 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5685 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5686
5687 @cindex remote memory comparison
5688 @cindex verify remote memory image
5689 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5690 (@pxref{Remote}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5691 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5692 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5693 situations.
5694
5695 @table @code
5696 @kindex compare-sections
5697 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5698 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5699 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5700 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5701 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5702 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5703 remote request.
5704 @end table
5705
5706 @node Auto Display
5707 @section Automatic display
5708 @cindex automatic display
5709 @cindex display of expressions
5710
5711 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5712 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5713 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5714 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5715 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5716 The automatic display looks like this:
5717
5718 @smallexample
5719 2: foo = 38
5720 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5721 @end smallexample
5722
5723 @noindent
5724 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5725 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5726 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5727 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5728 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5729 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5730 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5731
5732 @table @code
5733 @kindex display
5734 @item display @var{expr}
5735 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5736 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5737
5738 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5739
5740 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5741 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5742 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5743 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5744 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5745
5746 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5747 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5748 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5749 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5750 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5751 @end table
5752
5753 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5754 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5755 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5756
5757 @table @code
5758 @kindex delete display
5759 @kindex undisplay
5760 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5761 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5762 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5763
5764 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5765 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5766
5767 @kindex disable display
5768 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5769 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5770 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5771 enabled again later.
5772
5773 @kindex enable display
5774 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5775 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5776 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5777
5778 @item display
5779 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5780 done when your program stops.
5781
5782 @kindex info display
5783 @item info display
5784 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5785 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5786 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5787 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5788 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5789 @end table
5790
5791 @cindex display disabled out of scope
5792 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5793 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5794 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5795 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5796 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5797 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5798 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5799 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5800 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5801 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5802
5803 @node Print Settings
5804 @section Print settings
5805
5806 @cindex format options
5807 @cindex print settings
5808 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5809 and symbols are printed.
5810
5811 @noindent
5812 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5813
5814 @table @code
5815 @kindex set print
5816 @item set print address
5817 @itemx set print address on
5818 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
5819 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5820 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5821 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5822 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5823 @code{set print address on}:
5824
5825 @smallexample
5826 @group
5827 (@value{GDBP}) f
5828 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5829 at input.c:530
5830 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5831 @end group
5832 @end smallexample
5833
5834 @item set print address off
5835 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5836 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5837
5838 @smallexample
5839 @group
5840 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5841 (@value{GDBP}) f
5842 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5843 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5844 @end group
5845 @end smallexample
5846
5847 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5848 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5849 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5850 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5851
5852 @kindex show print
5853 @item show print address
5854 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5855 @end table
5856
5857 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5858 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5859 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5860 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5861 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5862 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5863 it prints a symbolic address:
5864
5865 @table @code
5866 @item set print symbol-filename on
5867 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
5868 @cindex symbol, source file and line
5869 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5870 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5871
5872 @item set print symbol-filename off
5873 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5874 default.
5875
5876 @item show print symbol-filename
5877 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5878 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5879 @end table
5880
5881 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5882 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5883 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5884
5885 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5886 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5887
5888 @table @code
5889 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5890 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
5891 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5892 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5893 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5894 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5895
5896 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5897 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5898 symbolic address.
5899 @end table
5900
5901 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5902 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5903 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5904 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5905 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5906 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5907 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5908 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5909
5910 @smallexample
5911 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5912 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5913 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5914 @end smallexample
5915
5916 @quotation
5917 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5918 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5919 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5920 @end quotation
5921
5922 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5923
5924 @table @code
5925 @item set print array
5926 @itemx set print array on
5927 @cindex pretty print arrays
5928 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5929 but uses more space. The default is off.
5930
5931 @item set print array off
5932 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5933
5934 @item show print array
5935 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5936 arrays.
5937
5938 @cindex print array indexes
5939 @item set print array-indexes
5940 @itemx set print array-indexes on
5941 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
5942 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
5943 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
5944
5945 @item set print array-indexes off
5946 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
5947
5948 @item show print array-indexes
5949 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
5950 arrays.
5951
5952 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5953 @cindex number of array elements to print
5954 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
5955 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5956 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5957 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5958 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5959 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5960 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5961
5962 @item show print elements
5963 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5964 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5965
5966 @item set print repeats
5967 @cindex repeated array elements
5968 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
5969 elelments. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
5970 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
5971 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
5972 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
5973 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
5974 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
5975
5976 @item show print repeats
5977 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
5978 elements.
5979
5980 @item set print null-stop
5981 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
5982 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5983 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5984 contain only short strings.
5985 The default is off.
5986
5987 @item show print null-stop
5988 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
5989 @sc{null} character.
5990
5991 @item set print pretty on
5992 @cindex print structures in indented form
5993 @cindex indentation in structure display
5994 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5995 per line, like this:
5996
5997 @smallexample
5998 @group
5999 $1 = @{
6000 next = 0x0,
6001 flags = @{
6002 sweet = 1,
6003 sour = 1
6004 @},
6005 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6006 @}
6007 @end group
6008 @end smallexample
6009
6010 @item set print pretty off
6011 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6012
6013 @smallexample
6014 @group
6015 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6016 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6017 @end group
6018 @end smallexample
6019
6020 @noindent
6021 This is the default format.
6022
6023 @item show print pretty
6024 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6025
6026 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6027 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6028 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6029 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6030 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6031 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6032 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6033 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6034
6035 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6036 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6037 international character sets, and is the default.
6038
6039 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6040 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6041
6042 @item set print union on
6043 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6044 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6045 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6046
6047 @item set print union off
6048 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6049 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6050 instead.
6051
6052 @item show print union
6053 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6054 structures and other unions.
6055
6056 For example, given the declarations
6057
6058 @smallexample
6059 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6060 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6061 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6062 Bug_forms;
6063
6064 struct thing @{
6065 Species it;
6066 union @{
6067 Tree_forms tree;
6068 Bug_forms bug;
6069 @} form;
6070 @};
6071
6072 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6073 @end smallexample
6074
6075 @noindent
6076 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6077
6078 @smallexample
6079 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6080 @end smallexample
6081
6082 @noindent
6083 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6084
6085 @smallexample
6086 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6087 @end smallexample
6088
6089 @noindent
6090 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6091 and in Pascal.
6092 @end table
6093
6094 @need 1000
6095 @noindent
6096 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6097
6098 @table @code
6099 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6100 @item set print demangle
6101 @itemx set print demangle on
6102 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6103 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6104 linkage. The default is on.
6105
6106 @item show print demangle
6107 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6108
6109 @item set print asm-demangle
6110 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6111 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6112 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6113 The default is off.
6114
6115 @item show print asm-demangle
6116 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6117 or demangled form.
6118
6119 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6120 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6121 @kindex set demangle-style
6122 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6123 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6124 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6125
6126 @table @code
6127 @item auto
6128 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6129
6130 @item gnu
6131 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6132 This is the default.
6133
6134 @item hp
6135 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6136
6137 @item lucid
6138 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6139
6140 @item arm
6141 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6142 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6143 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6144 require further enhancement to permit that.
6145
6146 @end table
6147 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6148
6149 @item show demangle-style
6150 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6151
6152 @item set print object
6153 @itemx set print object on
6154 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6155 @cindex display derived types
6156 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6157 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6158 the virtual function table.
6159
6160 @item set print object off
6161 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6162 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6163
6164 @item show print object
6165 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6166
6167 @item set print static-members
6168 @itemx set print static-members on
6169 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6170 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6171
6172 @item set print static-members off
6173 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6174
6175 @item show print static-members
6176 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6177
6178 @item set print pascal_static-members
6179 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6180 @cindex static members of Pacal objects
6181 @cindex Pacal objects, static members display
6182 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6183
6184 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6185 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6186
6187 @item show print pascal_static-members
6188 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6189
6190 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6191 @item set print vtbl
6192 @itemx set print vtbl on
6193 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6194 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6195 @cindex VTBL display
6196 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6197 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6198 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6199
6200 @item set print vtbl off
6201 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6202
6203 @item show print vtbl
6204 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6205 @end table
6206
6207 @node Value History
6208 @section Value history
6209
6210 @cindex value history
6211 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6212 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6213 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6214 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6215 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6216 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6217 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6218 symbol table.
6219
6220 @cindex @code{$}
6221 @cindex @code{$$}
6222 @cindex history number
6223 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6224 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6225 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6226 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6227 history number.
6228
6229 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6230 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6231 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6232 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6233 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6234 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6235 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6236
6237 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6238 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6239
6240 @smallexample
6241 p *$
6242 @end smallexample
6243
6244 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6245 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6246
6247 @smallexample
6248 p *$.next
6249 @end smallexample
6250
6251 @noindent
6252 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6253 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6254
6255 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6256 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6257
6258 @smallexample
6259 print x
6260 set x=5
6261 @end smallexample
6262
6263 @noindent
6264 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6265 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6266
6267 @table @code
6268 @kindex show values
6269 @item show values
6270 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6271 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6272 values} does not change the history.
6273
6274 @item show values @var{n}
6275 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6276
6277 @item show values +
6278 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6279 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6280 @end table
6281
6282 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6283 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6284
6285 @node Convenience Vars
6286 @section Convenience variables
6287
6288 @cindex convenience variables
6289 @cindex user-defined variables
6290 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6291 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6292 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6293 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6294 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6295
6296 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6297 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6298 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6299 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6300 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
6301
6302 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6303 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6304 For example:
6305
6306 @smallexample
6307 set $foo = *object_ptr
6308 @end smallexample
6309
6310 @noindent
6311 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6312 @code{object_ptr}.
6313
6314 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6315 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6316 value with another assignment at any time.
6317
6318 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6319 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6320 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6321 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6322
6323 @table @code
6324 @kindex show convenience
6325 @cindex show all user variables
6326 @item show convenience
6327 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6328 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6329
6330 @kindex init-if-undefined
6331 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6332 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6333 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6334 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6335 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6336 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6337 override default values used in a command script.
6338
6339 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6340 any side-effects do not occur.
6341 @end table
6342
6343 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6344 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6345 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6346
6347 @smallexample
6348 set $i = 0
6349 print bar[$i++]->contents
6350 @end smallexample
6351
6352 @noindent
6353 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6354
6355 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6356 values likely to be useful.
6357
6358 @table @code
6359 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6360 @item $_
6361 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6362 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
6363 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6364 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6365 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6366 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6367 to the type of @code{$__}.
6368
6369 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6370 @item $__
6371 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6372 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6373 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6374
6375 @item $_exitcode
6376 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6377 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6378 the program being debugged terminates.
6379 @end table
6380
6381 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6382 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6383 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6384
6385 @node Registers
6386 @section Registers
6387
6388 @cindex registers
6389 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6390 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6391 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6392 your machine.
6393
6394 @table @code
6395 @kindex info registers
6396 @item info registers
6397 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6398 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6399
6400 @kindex info all-registers
6401 @cindex floating point registers
6402 @item info all-registers
6403 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6404 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6405
6406 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6407 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6408 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6409 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6410 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6411 @end table
6412
6413 @cindex stack pointer register
6414 @cindex program counter register
6415 @cindex process status register
6416 @cindex frame pointer register
6417 @cindex standard registers
6418 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6419 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6420 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6421 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6422 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6423 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6424 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6425 you could print the program counter in hex with
6426
6427 @smallexample
6428 p/x $pc
6429 @end smallexample
6430
6431 @noindent
6432 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6433
6434 @smallexample
6435 x/i $pc
6436 @end smallexample
6437
6438 @noindent
6439 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6440 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6441 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6442 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6443 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6444 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6445 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
6446
6447 @smallexample
6448 set $sp += 4
6449 @end smallexample
6450
6451 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6452 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6453 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6454 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6455 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6456 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6457 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6458
6459 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6460 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6461 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6462 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6463 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6464 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6465 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6466
6467 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6468 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6469 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6470 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6471 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6472 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6473 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6474 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6475 prints the data in both formats.
6476
6477 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6478 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6479 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6480 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6481 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6482 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6483 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6484
6485 @smallexample
6486 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6487 $1 = @{
6488 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6489 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6490 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6491 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6492 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6493 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6494 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6495 @}
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 @noindent
6499 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6500 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6501 value to a @code{struct} member:
6502
6503 @smallexample
6504 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6505 @end smallexample
6506
6507 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6508 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
6509 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6510 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6511 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6512 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6513
6514 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6515 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6516 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6517 frame makes no difference.
6518
6519 @node Floating Point Hardware
6520 @section Floating point hardware
6521 @cindex floating point
6522
6523 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6524 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6525
6526 @table @code
6527 @kindex info float
6528 @item info float
6529 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6530 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6531 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6532 the ARM and x86 machines.
6533 @end table
6534
6535 @node Vector Unit
6536 @section Vector Unit
6537 @cindex vector unit
6538
6539 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6540 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6541
6542 @table @code
6543 @kindex info vector
6544 @item info vector
6545 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6546 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6547 @end table
6548
6549 @node OS Information
6550 @section Operating system auxiliary information
6551 @cindex OS information
6552
6553 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6554 you debug your program.
6555
6556 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6557 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6558 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6559 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6560 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6561 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6562 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6563 structure.
6564
6565 @table @code
6566 @item info udot
6567 @kindex info udot
6568 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6569 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6570 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6571 the @code{examine} command.
6572 @end table
6573
6574 @cindex auxiliary vector
6575 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6576 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6577 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6578 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6579 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6580 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6581 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6582 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6583 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6584 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6585 support of the @samp{qPart:auxv:read} packet, see @ref{Remote
6586 configuration, auxiliary vector}.
6587
6588 @table @code
6589 @kindex info auxv
6590 @item info auxv
6591 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6592 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6593 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6594 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6595 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6596 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6597 an unrecognized tag.
6598 @end table
6599
6600
6601 @node Memory Region Attributes
6602 @section Memory region attributes
6603 @cindex memory region attributes
6604
6605 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6606 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
6607 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
6608 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
6609
6610 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6611 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6612 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6613 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6614 all memory.
6615
6616 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6617 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6618
6619 @table @code
6620 @kindex mem
6621 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6622 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6623 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6624 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6625 case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
6626 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6627
6628 @kindex delete mem
6629 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6630 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6631 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6632
6633 @kindex disable mem
6634 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6635 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6636 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6637 It may be enabled again later.
6638
6639 @kindex enable mem
6640 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6641 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6642
6643 @kindex info mem
6644 @item info mem
6645 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6646 for each region:
6647
6648 @table @emph
6649 @item Memory Region Number
6650 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6651 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6652 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6653
6654 @item Lo Address
6655 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6656
6657 @item Hi Address
6658 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6659
6660 @item Attributes
6661 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6662 @end table
6663 @end table
6664
6665
6666 @subsection Attributes
6667
6668 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6669 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6670 write accesses to a memory region.
6671
6672 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6673 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6674 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6675
6676 @table @code
6677 @item ro
6678 Memory is read only.
6679 @item wo
6680 Memory is write only.
6681 @item rw
6682 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6683 @end table
6684
6685 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6686 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6687 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6688 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6689 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6690
6691 @table @code
6692 @item 8
6693 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6694 @item 16
6695 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6696 @item 32
6697 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6698 @item 64
6699 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6700 @end table
6701
6702 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6703 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6704 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6705 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6706 @c
6707 @c @table @code
6708 @c @item hwbreak
6709 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6710 @c @item swbreak (default)
6711 @c @end table
6712
6713 @subsubsection Data Cache
6714 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6715 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6716 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6717 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6718 registers.
6719
6720 @table @code
6721 @item cache
6722 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6723 @item nocache
6724 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6725 @end table
6726
6727 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6728 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6729 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6730 @c
6731 @c @table @code
6732 @c @item verify
6733 @c @item noverify (default)
6734 @c @end table
6735
6736 @node Dump/Restore Files
6737 @section Copy between memory and a file
6738 @cindex dump/restore files
6739 @cindex append data to a file
6740 @cindex dump data to a file
6741 @cindex restore data from a file
6742
6743 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6744 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6745 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6746 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6747 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6748 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6749 files.
6750
6751 @table @code
6752
6753 @kindex dump
6754 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6755 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6756 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6757 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6758
6759 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6760 @table @code
6761 @item binary
6762 Raw binary form.
6763 @item ihex
6764 Intel hex format.
6765 @item srec
6766 Motorola S-record format.
6767 @item tekhex
6768 Tektronix Hex format.
6769 @end table
6770
6771 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
6772 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
6773 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
6774 form.
6775
6776 @kindex append
6777 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6778 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6779 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6780 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
6781 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
6782
6783 @kindex restore
6784 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
6785 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
6786 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
6787 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
6788 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
6789
6790 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
6791 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
6792 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
6793 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
6794 from that location.
6795
6796 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
6797 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
6798 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
6799 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
6800
6801 @end table
6802
6803 @node Core File Generation
6804 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
6805 @cindex dump core from inferior
6806
6807 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
6808 image of a running process and its process status (register values
6809 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
6810 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
6811 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
6812 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
6813 the post-mortem debugging mode.
6814
6815 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
6816 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
6817 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
6818
6819 @table @code
6820 @kindex gcore
6821 @kindex generate-core-file
6822 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
6823 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
6824 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
6825 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
6826 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
6827 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
6828
6829 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
6830 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
6831 @end table
6832
6833 @node Character Sets
6834 @section Character Sets
6835 @cindex character sets
6836 @cindex charset
6837 @cindex translating between character sets
6838 @cindex host character set
6839 @cindex target character set
6840
6841 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
6842 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
6843 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
6844 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
6845 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
6846 @dfn{target character set}.
6847
6848 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
6849 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
6850 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
6851 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
6852 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
6853 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
6854 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
6855 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
6856 character and string literals in expressions.
6857
6858 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
6859 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
6860 target-charset} command, described below.
6861
6862 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
6863 support:
6864
6865 @table @code
6866 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
6867 @kindex set target-charset
6868 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
6869 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
6870 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6871 list the target character sets it supports.
6872 @end table
6873
6874 @table @code
6875 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
6876 @kindex set host-charset
6877 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
6878
6879 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
6880 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
6881 @code{set host-charset} command.
6882
6883 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
6884 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
6885 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
6886 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6887 list the host character sets it supports.
6888
6889 @item set charset @var{charset}
6890 @kindex set charset
6891 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
6892 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6893 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
6894 for both host and target.
6895
6896
6897 @item show charset
6898 @kindex show charset
6899 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
6900
6901 @itemx show host-charset
6902 @kindex show host-charset
6903 Show the name of the current host charset.
6904
6905 @itemx show target-charset
6906 @kindex show target-charset
6907 Show the name of the current target charset.
6908
6909 @end table
6910
6911 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6912 sets:
6913
6914 @table @code
6915
6916 @item ASCII
6917 @cindex ASCII character set
6918 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6919 character set.
6920
6921 @item ISO-8859-1
6922 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6923 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6924 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
6925 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6926 this as its host character set.
6927
6928 @item EBCDIC-US
6929 @itemx IBM1047
6930 @cindex EBCDIC character set
6931 @cindex IBM1047 character set
6932 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6933 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6934 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6935
6936 @end table
6937
6938 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6939 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6940 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6941
6942 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6943 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6944 @file{charset-test.c}:
6945
6946 @smallexample
6947 #include <stdio.h>
6948
6949 char ascii_hello[]
6950 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6951 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6952 char ibm1047_hello[]
6953 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6954 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6955
6956 main ()
6957 @{
6958 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6959 @}
6960 @end smallexample
6961
6962 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6963 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6964 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6965
6966 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6967
6968 @smallexample
6969 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6970 $ gdb -nw charset-test
6971 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6972 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6973 @dots{}
6974 (@value{GDBP})
6975 @end smallexample
6976
6977 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6978 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6979 strings:
6980
6981 @smallexample
6982 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
6983 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
6984 (@value{GDBP})
6985 @end smallexample
6986
6987 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6988 initial character set:
6989 @smallexample
6990 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
6991 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
6992 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
6993 (@value{GDBP})
6994 @end smallexample
6995
6996 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6997 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6998 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6999 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7000 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7001
7002 @smallexample
7003 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7004 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7005 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7006 $2 = 72 'H'
7007 (@value{GDBP})
7008 @end smallexample
7009
7010 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7011 literals you use in expressions:
7012
7013 @smallexample
7014 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7015 $3 = 43 '+'
7016 (@value{GDBP})
7017 @end smallexample
7018
7019 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7020 character.
7021
7022 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7023 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7024 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7025
7026 @smallexample
7027 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7028 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7029 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7030 $5 = 200 '\310'
7031 (@value{GDBP})
7032 @end smallexample
7033
7034 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7035 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7036
7037 @smallexample
7038 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7039 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7040 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7041 @end smallexample
7042
7043 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7044 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7045 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7046 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7047 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7048
7049 @smallexample
7050 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7051 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7052 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7053 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7054 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7055 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7056 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7057 $7 = 72 '\110'
7058 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7059 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7060 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7061 $9 = 200 'H'
7062 (@value{GDBP})
7063 @end smallexample
7064
7065 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7066 string literals you use in expressions:
7067
7068 @smallexample
7069 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7070 $10 = 78 '+'
7071 (@value{GDBP})
7072 @end smallexample
7073
7074 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7075 character.
7076
7077 @node Caching Remote Data
7078 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7079 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7080
7081 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7082 remote target (@pxref{Remote}). Such caching generally improves
7083 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7084 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7085 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7086 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7087 volatile registers are in use.
7088
7089 @table @code
7090 @kindex set remotecache
7091 @item set remotecache on
7092 @itemx set remotecache off
7093 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7094 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7095
7096 @kindex show remotecache
7097 @item show remotecache
7098 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7099
7100 @kindex info dcache
7101 @item info dcache
7102 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7103 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7104 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7105 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7106 the data cache operation.
7107 @end table
7108
7109
7110 @node Macros
7111 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7112
7113 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7114 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7115 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7116 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7117 where it was defined.
7118
7119 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7120 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7121 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7122 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7123
7124 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7125 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7126 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7127 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7128 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7129 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7130 see @ref{List}.
7131
7132 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7133 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7134 variable-arity macros.
7135
7136 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7137 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7138 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7139
7140 @table @code
7141
7142 @kindex macro expand
7143 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7144 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7145 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7146 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7147 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7148 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7149 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7150 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7151 it can be any string of tokens.
7152
7153 @kindex macro exp1
7154 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7155 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7156 @cindex expand macro once
7157 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7158 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7159 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7160 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7161 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7162 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7163 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7164 can be any string of tokens.
7165
7166 @kindex info macro
7167 @cindex macro definition, showing
7168 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7169 @item info macro @var{macro}
7170 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7171 source location where that definition was established.
7172
7173 @kindex macro define
7174 @cindex user-defined macros
7175 @cindex defining macros interactively
7176 @cindex macros, user-defined
7177 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7178 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7179 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7180 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7181 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7182 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7183 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7184 given in @var{arglist}.
7185
7186 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7187 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7188 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7189 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7190 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7191
7192 @kindex macro undef
7193 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7194 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7195 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7196 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7197 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7198 debugged.
7199
7200 @kindex macro list
7201 @item macro list
7202 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7203 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7204 @end table
7205
7206 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7207 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7208 show our source files:
7209
7210 @smallexample
7211 $ cat sample.c
7212 #include <stdio.h>
7213 #include "sample.h"
7214
7215 #define M 42
7216 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7217
7218 main ()
7219 @{
7220 #define N 28
7221 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7222 #undef N
7223 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7224 #define N 1729
7225 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7226 @}
7227 $ cat sample.h
7228 #define Q <
7229 $
7230 @end smallexample
7231
7232 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7233 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7234 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7235 information.
7236
7237 @smallexample
7238 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7239 $
7240 @end smallexample
7241
7242 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7243
7244 @smallexample
7245 $ gdb -nw sample
7246 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7247 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7248 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7249 (@value{GDBP})
7250 @end smallexample
7251
7252 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7253 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7254 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7255
7256 @smallexample
7257 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7258 3
7259 4 #define M 42
7260 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7261 6
7262 7 main ()
7263 8 @{
7264 9 #define N 28
7265 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7266 11 #undef N
7267 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7268 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7269 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7270 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7271 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7272 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7273 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7274 #define Q <
7275 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7276 expands to: (42 + 1)
7277 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7278 expands to: once (M + 1)
7279 (@value{GDBP})
7280 @end smallexample
7281
7282 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7283 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7284 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7285 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7286
7287 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
7288 the source line of the current stack frame:
7289
7290 @smallexample
7291 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7292 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7293 (@value{GDBP}) run
7294 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7295
7296 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7297 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7298 (@value{GDBP})
7299 @end smallexample
7300
7301 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7302
7303 @smallexample
7304 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7305 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7306 #define N 28
7307 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7308 expands to: 28 < 42
7309 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7310 $1 = 1
7311 (@value{GDBP})
7312 @end smallexample
7313
7314 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7315 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7316 thereof) in force at each point:
7317
7318 @smallexample
7319 (@value{GDBP}) next
7320 Hello, world!
7321 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7322 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7323 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7324 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7325 (@value{GDBP}) next
7326 We're so creative.
7327 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7328 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7329 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7330 #define N 1729
7331 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7332 expands to: 1729 < 42
7333 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7334 $2 = 0
7335 (@value{GDBP})
7336 @end smallexample
7337
7338
7339 @node Tracepoints
7340 @chapter Tracepoints
7341 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7342 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7343
7344 @cindex tracepoints
7345 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7346 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7347 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7348 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7349 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7350 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7351 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7352
7353 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7354 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7355 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7356 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7357 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7358 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7359 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7360 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7361 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7362 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7363 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7364
7365 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7366 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7367 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7368 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7369 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7370 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7371 Packets}.
7372
7373 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7374
7375 @menu
7376 * Set Tracepoints::
7377 * Analyze Collected Data::
7378 * Tracepoint Variables::
7379 @end menu
7380
7381 @node Set Tracepoints
7382 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7383
7384 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7385 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7386 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7387 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7388 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7389 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7390 work on.
7391
7392 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7393 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7394 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7395 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7396 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7397 tracepoint was hit.
7398
7399 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7400 conditions and actions.
7401
7402 @menu
7403 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7404 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7405 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7406 * Tracepoint Actions::
7407 * Listing Tracepoints::
7408 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
7409 @end menu
7410
7411 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7412 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7413
7414 @table @code
7415 @cindex set tracepoint
7416 @kindex trace
7417 @item trace
7418 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7419 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7420 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7421 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7422 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7423 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7424 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7425 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7426 running.
7427
7428 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7429
7430 @smallexample
7431 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7432
7433 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7434
7435 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7436
7437 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7438
7439 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7440 @end smallexample
7441
7442 @noindent
7443 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7444
7445 @vindex $tpnum
7446 @cindex last tracepoint number
7447 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7448 @cindex tracepoint number
7449 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7450 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7451
7452 @kindex delete tracepoint
7453 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7454 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7455 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7456 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7457
7458 Examples:
7459
7460 @smallexample
7461 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7462
7463 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7464 @end smallexample
7465
7466 @noindent
7467 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7468 @end table
7469
7470 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7471 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7472
7473 @table @code
7474 @kindex disable tracepoint
7475 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7476 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7477 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7478 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7479 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7480
7481 @kindex enable tracepoint
7482 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7483 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7484 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7485 run.
7486 @end table
7487
7488 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7489 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7490
7491 @table @code
7492 @kindex passcount
7493 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7494 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7495 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7496 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7497 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7498 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7499 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7500 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7501 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7502 user.
7503
7504 Examples:
7505
7506 @smallexample
7507 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7508 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7509
7510 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7511 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7512 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7513 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7514 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7515 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7516 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7517 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7518 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7519 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7520 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7521 @end smallexample
7522 @end table
7523
7524 @node Tracepoint Actions
7525 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7526
7527 @table @code
7528 @kindex actions
7529 @cindex tracepoint actions
7530 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7531 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7532 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7533 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7534 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7535 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7536 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7537 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7538 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7539 @code{while-stepping}.
7540
7541 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7542 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7543 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7544
7545 @smallexample
7546 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7547
7548 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7549
7550 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7551 @end smallexample
7552
7553 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7554 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7555 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7556 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7557 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7558 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7559 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7560 @code{end} command.
7561
7562 @smallexample
7563 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7564 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7565 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7566 > collect bar,baz
7567 > collect $regs
7568 > while-stepping 12
7569 > collect $fp, $sp
7570 > end
7571 end
7572 @end smallexample
7573
7574 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7575 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7576 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7577 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7578 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7579 special arguments are supported:
7580
7581 @table @code
7582 @item $regs
7583 collect all registers
7584
7585 @item $args
7586 collect all function arguments
7587
7588 @item $locals
7589 collect all local variables.
7590 @end table
7591
7592 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7593 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7594 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7595
7596 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7597 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7598
7599 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7600 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7601 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7602 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7603 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7604 its own @code{end} command):
7605
7606 @smallexample
7607 > while-stepping 12
7608 > collect $regs, myglobal
7609 > end
7610 >
7611 @end smallexample
7612
7613 @noindent
7614 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7615 @code{stepping}.
7616 @end table
7617
7618 @node Listing Tracepoints
7619 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7620
7621 @table @code
7622 @kindex info tracepoints
7623 @kindex info tp
7624 @cindex information about tracepoints
7625 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7626 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7627 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7628 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7629 shown:
7630
7631 @itemize @bullet
7632 @item
7633 its number
7634 @item
7635 whether it is enabled or disabled
7636 @item
7637 its address
7638 @item
7639 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7640 @item
7641 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7642 @item
7643 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7644 @item
7645 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7646 @end itemize
7647
7648 @smallexample
7649 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7650 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7651 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7652 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7653 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7654 (@value{GDBP})
7655 @end smallexample
7656
7657 @noindent
7658 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7659 @end table
7660
7661 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7662 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7663
7664 @table @code
7665 @kindex tstart
7666 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7667 @cindex collected data discarded
7668 @item tstart
7669 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7670 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7671 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7672 experiment.
7673
7674 @kindex tstop
7675 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7676 @item tstop
7677 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7678 stops collecting data.
7679
7680 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7681 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7682 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7683
7684 @kindex tstatus
7685 @cindex status of trace data collection
7686 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7687 @item tstatus
7688 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7689 collection.
7690 @end table
7691
7692 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7693
7694 @smallexample
7695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7697 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7698 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7699 > while-stepping 11
7700 > collect $regs
7701 > end
7702 > end
7703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7704 [time passes @dots{}]
7705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7706 @end smallexample
7707
7708
7709 @node Analyze Collected Data
7710 @section Using the collected data
7711
7712 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7713 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7714 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7715 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7716 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7717 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7718 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7719 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7720 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7721 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7722 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7723 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7724 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7725 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7726 the buffer will fail.
7727
7728 @menu
7729 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7730 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7731 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7732 @end menu
7733
7734 @node tfind
7735 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7736
7737 @kindex tfind
7738 @cindex select trace snapshot
7739 @cindex find trace snapshot
7740 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7741 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7742 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7743 snapshot is selected.
7744
7745 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7746
7747 @table @code
7748 @item tfind start
7749 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7750 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7751
7752 @item tfind none
7753 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7754
7755 @item tfind end
7756 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7757
7758 @item tfind
7759 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7760
7761 @item tfind -
7762 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7763 retracing earlier steps.
7764
7765 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7766 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
7767 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
7768 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
7769 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
7770
7771 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
7772 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
7773 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
7774 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
7775 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
7776
7777 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7778 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
7779 addresses.
7780
7781 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7782 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
7783 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
7784
7785 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
7786 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
7787 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
7788 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
7789 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
7790 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
7791 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
7792 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
7793 @end table
7794
7795 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
7796 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
7797 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
7798 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
7799 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
7800 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
7801 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
7802 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
7803 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
7804 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
7805 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
7806 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
7807 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
7808 tracepoint as the current one.
7809
7810 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
7811 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
7812 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
7813 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
7814 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
7815
7816 @smallexample
7817 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7818 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7819 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
7820 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
7821 > tfind
7822 > end
7823
7824 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
7825 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
7826 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
7827 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
7828 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
7829 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
7830 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
7831 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
7832 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
7833 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
7834 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
7835 @end smallexample
7836
7837 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
7838 the buffer:
7839
7840 @smallexample
7841 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7842 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7843 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
7844 > tfind line
7845 > end
7846
7847 Frame 0, X = 1
7848 Frame 7, X = 2
7849 Frame 13, X = 255
7850 @end smallexample
7851
7852 @node tdump
7853 @subsection @code{tdump}
7854 @kindex tdump
7855 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
7856 @cindex tracepoint data, display
7857
7858 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
7859 the current trace snapshot.
7860
7861 @smallexample
7862 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
7863 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7864 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
7865 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
7866 > end
7867
7868 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7869
7870 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
7871 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
7872 at gdb_test.c:444
7873 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
7874
7875 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
7876 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
7877 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
7878 d1 0x18 24
7879 d2 0x80 128
7880 d3 0x33 51
7881 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
7882 d5 0x22 34
7883 d6 0xe0 224
7884 d7 0x380035 3670069
7885 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
7886 a1 0x3000668 50333288
7887 a2 0x100 256
7888 a3 0x322000 3284992
7889 a4 0x3000698 50333336
7890 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
7891 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
7892 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
7893 ps 0x0 0
7894 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
7895 fpcontrol 0x0 0
7896 fpstatus 0x0 0
7897 fpiaddr 0x0 0
7898 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
7899 p1 = (void *) 0x11
7900 p2 = (void *) 0x22
7901 p3 = (void *) 0x33
7902 p4 = (void *) 0x44
7903 p5 = (void *) 0x55
7904 p6 = (void *) 0x66
7905 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
7906
7907 (@value{GDBP})
7908 @end smallexample
7909
7910 @node save-tracepoints
7911 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
7912 @kindex save-tracepoints
7913 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
7914
7915 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
7916 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
7917 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
7918 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
7919 Files}).
7920
7921 @node Tracepoint Variables
7922 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
7923 @cindex tracepoint variables
7924 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
7925
7926 @table @code
7927 @vindex $trace_frame
7928 @item (int) $trace_frame
7929 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
7930 snapshot is selected.
7931
7932 @vindex $tracepoint
7933 @item (int) $tracepoint
7934 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
7935
7936 @vindex $trace_line
7937 @item (int) $trace_line
7938 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7939
7940 @vindex $trace_file
7941 @item (char []) $trace_file
7942 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7943
7944 @vindex $trace_func
7945 @item (char []) $trace_func
7946 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7947 @end table
7948
7949 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7950 use @code{output} instead.
7951
7952 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7953 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7954 data.
7955
7956 @smallexample
7957 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7958
7959 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7960 > output $trace_file
7961 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7962 > tfind
7963 > end
7964 @end smallexample
7965
7966 @node Overlays
7967 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7968 @cindex overlays
7969
7970 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7971 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7972 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7973 use overlays.
7974
7975 @menu
7976 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7977 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7978 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7979 mapped by asking the inferior.
7980 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7981 @end menu
7982
7983 @node How Overlays Work
7984 @section How Overlays Work
7985 @cindex mapped overlays
7986 @cindex unmapped overlays
7987 @cindex load address, overlay's
7988 @cindex mapped address
7989 @cindex overlay area
7990
7991 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7992 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7993 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7994 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7995 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7996
7997 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7998 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7999 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8000 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8001 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8002 largest overlay as well.
8003
8004 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8005 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8006 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8007 there.
8008
8009 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8010 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8011 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8012
8013 @smallexample
8014 @group
8015 Data Instruction Larger
8016 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8017 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8018 | | | | | |
8019 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8020 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8021 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8022 | and heap | | | | | |
8023 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8024 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8025 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8026 | | | | | |
8027 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8028 address | | | | | |
8029 | overlay | <-' | | |
8030 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8031 | | <---. | | load address
8032 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8033 | | | |
8034 +-----------+ | |
8035 +-----------+
8036 | |
8037 +-----------+
8038
8039 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8040 @end group
8041 @end smallexample
8042
8043 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8044 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8045 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8046 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8047 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8048 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8049 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8050 program and the overlay area.
8051
8052 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8053 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8054 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8055 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8056 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8057 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8058 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8059
8060 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8061 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8062 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8063
8064 @itemize @bullet
8065
8066 @item
8067 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8068 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8069 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8070 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8071
8072 @item
8073 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8074 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8075 your program's performance.
8076
8077 @item
8078 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8079 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8080 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8081 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8082 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8083 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8084 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8085
8086 @item
8087 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8088 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8089 instruction and data spaces.
8090
8091 @end itemize
8092
8093 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8094 improved in many ways:
8095
8096 @itemize @bullet
8097
8098 @item
8099 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8100 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8101 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8102 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8103 area in the usual way.
8104
8105 @item
8106 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8107 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8108
8109 @item
8110 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8111 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8112 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8113 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8114 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8115 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8116 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8117
8118 @end itemize
8119
8120
8121 @node Overlay Commands
8122 @section Overlay Commands
8123
8124 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8125 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8126 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8127 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8128 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8129 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8130
8131 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8132 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8133
8134 @table @code
8135 @item overlay off
8136 @kindex overlay
8137 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8138 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8139 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8140 overlay support is disabled.
8141
8142 @item overlay manual
8143 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8144 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8145 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8146 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8147 commands described below.
8148
8149 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8150 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8151 @cindex map an overlay
8152 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8153 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8154 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8155 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8156 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8157 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8158
8159 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8160 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8161 @cindex unmap an overlay
8162 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8163 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8164 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8165 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8166
8167 @item overlay auto
8168 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8169 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8170 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8171 Overlay Debugging}.
8172
8173 @item overlay load-target
8174 @itemx overlay load
8175 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8176 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8177 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8178 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8179 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8180 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8181
8182 @item overlay list-overlays
8183 @itemx overlay list
8184 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8185 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8186 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8187
8188 @end table
8189
8190 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8191 of the function the address falls in:
8192
8193 @smallexample
8194 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8195 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8196 @end smallexample
8197 @noindent
8198 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8199 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8200 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8201 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8202
8203 @smallexample
8204 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8205 No sections are mapped.
8206 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8207 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8208 @end smallexample
8209 @noindent
8210 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8211 name normally:
8212
8213 @smallexample
8214 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8215 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8216 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8217 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8218 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8219 @end smallexample
8220
8221 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8222 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8223 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8224 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8225 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8226
8227 @itemize @bullet
8228 @item
8229 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8230 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8231 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8232 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8233 @item
8234 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8235 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8236 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8237 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8238 breakpoints properly.
8239 @end itemize
8240
8241
8242 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8243 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8244 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8245
8246 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8247 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8248 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8249 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8250 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8251 current state of the overlays.
8252
8253 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8254 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8255
8256 @table @asis
8257
8258 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8259 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8260
8261 @smallexample
8262 struct
8263 @{
8264 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8265 unsigned long vma;
8266
8267 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8268 unsigned long size;
8269
8270 /* The overlay's load address. */
8271 unsigned long lma;
8272
8273 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8274 zero otherwise. */
8275 unsigned long mapped;
8276 @}
8277 @end smallexample
8278
8279 @item @code{_novlys}:
8280 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8281 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8282
8283 @end table
8284
8285 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8286 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8287 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8288 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8289 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8290 currently mapped.
8291
8292 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8293 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8294 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8295 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8296 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8297 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8298 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8299 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8300 are not being executed.
8301
8302 @node Overlay Sample Program
8303 @section Overlay Sample Program
8304 @cindex overlay example program
8305
8306 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8307 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8308 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8309 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8310 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8311 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8312 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8313
8314 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8315 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8316 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8317 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8318
8319 @table @file
8320 @item overlays.c
8321 The main program file.
8322 @item ovlymgr.c
8323 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8324 @item foo.c
8325 @itemx bar.c
8326 @itemx baz.c
8327 @itemx grbx.c
8328 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8329 @item d10v.ld
8330 @itemx m32r.ld
8331 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8332 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8333 @end table
8334
8335 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8336 cross-compiler like this:
8337
8338 @smallexample
8339 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8340 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8341 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8342 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8343 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8344 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8345 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8346 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8347 @end smallexample
8348
8349 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8350 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8351 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8352
8353
8354 @node Languages
8355 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8356 @cindex languages
8357
8358 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8359 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8360 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8361 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8362 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8363 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8364
8365 @cindex working language
8366 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8367 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8368 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8369 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8370 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8371 language}.
8372
8373 @menu
8374 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8375 * Show:: Displaying the language
8376 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8377 * Supported languages:: Supported languages
8378 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
8379 @end menu
8380
8381 @node Setting
8382 @section Switching between source languages
8383
8384 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8385 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8386 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8387 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8388 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8389 are printed, etc.
8390
8391 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8392 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8393 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8394 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8395 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8396 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8397 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8398 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8399 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8400 Displaying the language}.
8401
8402 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8403 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8404 another language. In that case, make the
8405 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8406 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8407 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8408
8409 @menu
8410 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8411 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8412 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8413 @end menu
8414
8415 @node Filenames
8416 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
8417
8418 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8419 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8420
8421 @table @file
8422 @item .ada
8423 @itemx .ads
8424 @itemx .adb
8425 @itemx .a
8426 Ada source file.
8427
8428 @item .c
8429 C source file
8430
8431 @item .C
8432 @itemx .cc
8433 @itemx .cp
8434 @itemx .cpp
8435 @itemx .cxx
8436 @itemx .c++
8437 C@t{++} source file
8438
8439 @item .m
8440 Objective-C source file
8441
8442 @item .f
8443 @itemx .F
8444 Fortran source file
8445
8446 @item .mod
8447 Modula-2 source file
8448
8449 @item .s
8450 @itemx .S
8451 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8452 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8453 @end table
8454
8455 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8456 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
8457
8458 @node Manually
8459 @subsection Setting the working language
8460
8461 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8462 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8463 your program.
8464
8465 @kindex set language
8466 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8467 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8468 a language, such as
8469 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8470 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8471
8472 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8473 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8474 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8475 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8476 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8477 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8478 command such as:
8479
8480 @smallexample
8481 print a = b + c
8482 @end smallexample
8483
8484 @noindent
8485 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8486 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8487 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8488 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8489
8490 @node Automatically
8491 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8492
8493 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8494 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8495 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8496 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8497 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8498 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8499 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8500 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8501 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8502
8503 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8504 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8505 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8506 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8507 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8508
8509 @node Show
8510 @section Displaying the language
8511
8512 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8513 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8514
8515 @table @code
8516 @item show language
8517 @kindex show language
8518 Display the current working language. This is the
8519 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8520 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8521
8522 @item info frame
8523 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8524 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8525 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8526 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
8527 information listed here.
8528
8529 @item info source
8530 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8531 Display the source language of this source file.
8532 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8533 information listed here.
8534 @end table
8535
8536 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8537 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8538 with a language explicitly:
8539
8540 @table @code
8541 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8542 @kindex set extension-language
8543 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8544 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8545
8546 @item info extensions
8547 @kindex info extensions
8548 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8549 @end table
8550
8551 @node Checks
8552 @section Type and range checking
8553
8554 @quotation
8555 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8556 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8557 section documents the intended facilities.
8558 @end quotation
8559 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8560
8561 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8562 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8563 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8564 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8565 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8566 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8567 errors when your program is running.
8568
8569 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8570 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8571 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8572 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8573 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8574 automatically based on your program's source language.
8575 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default
8576 settings of supported languages.
8577
8578 @menu
8579 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8580 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8581 @end menu
8582
8583 @cindex type checking
8584 @cindex checks, type
8585 @node Type Checking
8586 @subsection An overview of type checking
8587
8588 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8589 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8590 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8591 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8592
8593 @smallexample
8594 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8595 @exdent but
8596 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8597 @end smallexample
8598
8599 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8600 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8601
8602 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8603 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8604 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8605 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8606 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8607 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8608 also issues a warning.
8609
8610 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8611 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8612 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8613 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8614 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8615 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8616
8617 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8618 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8619 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8620 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8621 operators. @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for further
8622 details on specific languages.
8623
8624 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8625
8626 @kindex set check type
8627 @kindex show check type
8628 @table @code
8629 @item set check type auto
8630 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8631 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8632 each language.
8633
8634 @item set check type on
8635 @itemx set check type off
8636 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8637 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8638 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8639 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8640 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8641
8642 @item set check type warn
8643 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8644 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8645 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8646 numbers and structures.
8647
8648 @item show type
8649 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8650 is setting it automatically.
8651 @end table
8652
8653 @cindex range checking
8654 @cindex checks, range
8655 @node Range Checking
8656 @subsection An overview of range checking
8657
8658 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8659 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8660 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8661 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8662 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8663
8664 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8665 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8666 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8667 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8668
8669 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8670 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8671 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8672 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8673 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8674 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8675
8676 @smallexample
8677 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8678 @end smallexample
8679
8680 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8681 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported languages, ,
8682 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8683
8684 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8685
8686 @kindex set check range
8687 @kindex show check range
8688 @table @code
8689 @item set check range auto
8690 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8691 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8692 each language.
8693
8694 @item set check range on
8695 @itemx set check range off
8696 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8697 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8698 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8699 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8700
8701 @item set check range warn
8702 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8703 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8704 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8705 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8706 systems).
8707
8708 @item show range
8709 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8710 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8711 @end table
8712
8713 @node Supported languages
8714 @section Supported languages
8715
8716 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8717 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8718 @c This is false ...
8719 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8720 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8721 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8722 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8723 language.
8724
8725 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8726 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8727 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8728 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8729 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8730 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8731 language reference or tutorial.
8732
8733 @menu
8734 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8735 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8736 * Fortran:: Fortran
8737 * Pascal:: Pascal
8738 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8739 * Ada:: Ada
8740 @end menu
8741
8742 @node C
8743 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8744
8745 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8746 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8747
8748 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8749 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8750 together.
8751
8752 @cindex C@t{++}
8753 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8754 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8755 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8756 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8757 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8758 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8759 compiler (@code{aCC}).
8760
8761 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8762 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8763 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8764 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8765 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
8766 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
8767
8768 @menu
8769 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
8770 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
8771 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
8772 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
8773 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8774 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
8775 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8776 @end menu
8777
8778 @node C Operators
8779 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
8780
8781 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
8782
8783 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8784 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8785 often defined on groups of types.
8786
8787 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
8788
8789 @itemize @bullet
8790
8791 @item
8792 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
8793 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
8794
8795 @item
8796 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
8797 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
8798
8799 @item
8800 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
8801
8802 @item
8803 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
8804
8805 @end itemize
8806
8807 @noindent
8808 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
8809 in order of increasing precedence:
8810
8811 @table @code
8812 @item ,
8813 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
8814 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
8815 expression being the last expression evaluated.
8816
8817 @item =
8818 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
8819 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
8820
8821 @item @var{op}=
8822 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
8823 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
8824 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
8825 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
8826 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
8827
8828 @item ?:
8829 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
8830 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
8831 integral type.
8832
8833 @item ||
8834 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8835
8836 @item &&
8837 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8838
8839 @item |
8840 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8841
8842 @item ^
8843 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8844
8845 @item &
8846 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8847
8848 @item ==@r{, }!=
8849 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
8850 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
8851
8852 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
8853 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
8854 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
8855 and non-zero for true.
8856
8857 @item <<@r{, }>>
8858 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
8859
8860 @item @@
8861 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8862
8863 @item +@r{, }-
8864 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
8865 pointer types.
8866
8867 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
8868 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
8869 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
8870 integral types.
8871
8872 @item ++@r{, }--
8873 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
8874 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
8875 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
8876 operation takes place.
8877
8878 @item *
8879 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
8880 @code{++}.
8881
8882 @item &
8883 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
8884
8885 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
8886 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
8887 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
8888 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
8889 stored.
8890
8891 @item -
8892 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
8893 precedence as @code{++}.
8894
8895 @item !
8896 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8897 @code{++}.
8898
8899 @item ~
8900 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8901 @code{++}.
8902
8903
8904 @item .@r{, }->
8905 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
8906 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
8907 pointer based on the stored type information.
8908 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
8909
8910 @item .*@r{, }->*
8911 Dereferences of pointers to members.
8912
8913 @item []
8914 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
8915 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8916
8917 @item ()
8918 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8919
8920 @item ::
8921 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
8922 and @code{class} types.
8923
8924 @item ::
8925 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
8926 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
8927 above.
8928 @end table
8929
8930 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
8931 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
8932 predefined meaning.
8933
8934 @menu
8935 * C Constants::
8936 @end menu
8937
8938 @node C Constants
8939 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
8940
8941 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
8942
8943 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
8944 following ways:
8945
8946 @itemize @bullet
8947 @item
8948 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
8949 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8950 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
8951 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8952 @code{long} value.
8953
8954 @item
8955 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8956 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8957 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8958 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8959 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
8960 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8961 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8962 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8963 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8964 constant.
8965
8966 @item
8967 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8968 integral equivalents.
8969
8970 @item
8971 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8972 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
8973 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
8974 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8975 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8976 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8977 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8978 @samp{\n} for newline.
8979
8980 @item
8981 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8982 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8983 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8984 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8985 characters.
8986
8987 @item
8988 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8989 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8990
8991 @item
8992 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8993 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8994 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8995 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8996 @end itemize
8997
8998 @menu
8999 * C plus plus expressions::
9000 * C Defaults::
9001 * C Checks::
9002
9003 * Debugging C::
9004 @end menu
9005
9006 @node C plus plus expressions
9007 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
9008
9009 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9010 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9011
9012 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9013 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9014 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9015 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9016 @quotation
9017 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9018 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9019 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9020 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9021 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9022 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9023 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9024 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9025 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9026 C@t{++} code.
9027 @end quotation
9028
9029 @enumerate
9030
9031 @cindex member functions
9032 @item
9033 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9034
9035 @smallexample
9036 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9037 @end smallexample
9038
9039 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9040 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9041 @item
9042 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9043 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9044 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9045 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9046
9047 @cindex call overloaded functions
9048 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9049 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9050 @item
9051 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9052 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9053 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9054 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9055 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9056 default arguments.
9057
9058 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9059 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9060 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9061 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9062 number of function arguments.
9063
9064 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9065 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
9066 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
9067
9068 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9069 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9070 @smallexample
9071 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9072 @end smallexample
9073
9074 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9075 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
9076
9077 @cindex reference declarations
9078 @item
9079 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9080 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9081 dereferenced.
9082
9083 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9084 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9085 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9086 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9087 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9088
9089 @item
9090 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9091 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9092 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9093 necessary, for example in an expression like
9094 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9095 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9096 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
9097 @end enumerate
9098
9099 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9100 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9101 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9102 invoking user-defined operators.
9103
9104 @node C Defaults
9105 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
9106
9107 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9108
9109 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9110 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9111 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9112 selects the working language.
9113
9114 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9115 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9116 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9117 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9118 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
9119 for further details.
9120
9121 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9122 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9123 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9124
9125 @node C Checks
9126 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9127
9128 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9129
9130 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9131 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9132 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9133
9134 @itemize @bullet
9135 @item
9136 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9137 enumerated tag.
9138
9139 @item
9140 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9141 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9142
9143 @ignore
9144 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9145 @c FIXME--beers?
9146 @item
9147 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9148 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9149 compilers.)
9150 @end ignore
9151 @end itemize
9152
9153 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9154 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9155 that is not itself an array.
9156
9157 @node Debugging C
9158 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9159
9160 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9161 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9162 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9163 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9164
9165 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9166 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9167 ,Expressions}.
9168
9169 @menu
9170 * Debugging C plus plus::
9171 @end menu
9172
9173 @node Debugging C plus plus
9174 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9175
9176 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9177
9178 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9179 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9180
9181 @table @code
9182 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9183 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9184 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9185 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9186 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
9187
9188 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9189 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9190 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9191 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9192 classes.
9193 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
9194
9195 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9196 @item catch throw
9197 @itemx catch catch
9198 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9199 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
9200
9201 @cindex inheritance
9202 @item ptype @var{typename}
9203 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9204 @var{typename}.
9205 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9206
9207 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9208 @item set print demangle
9209 @itemx show print demangle
9210 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9211 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9212 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9213 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9214 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9215
9216 @item set print object
9217 @itemx show print object
9218 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9219 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9220
9221 @item set print vtbl
9222 @itemx show print vtbl
9223 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9224 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9225 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9226 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9227
9228 @kindex set overload-resolution
9229 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9230 @item set overload-resolution on
9231 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9232 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9233 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9234 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
9235 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
9236 message.
9237
9238 @item set overload-resolution off
9239 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9240 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9241 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9242 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9243 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9244 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9245 argument types.
9246
9247 @kindex show overload-resolution
9248 @item show overload-resolution
9249 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9250
9251 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9252 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9253 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9254 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9255 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9256 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9257 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
9258 @end table
9259
9260 @node Objective-C
9261 @subsection Objective-C
9262
9263 @cindex Objective-C
9264 This section provides information about some commands and command
9265 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9266 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9267 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9268
9269 @menu
9270 * Method Names in Commands::
9271 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9272 @end menu
9273
9274 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
9275 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9276
9277 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9278 names as line specifications:
9279
9280 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9281 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9282 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9283 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9284 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9285 @itemize
9286 @item @code{clear}
9287 @item @code{break}
9288 @item @code{info line}
9289 @item @code{jump}
9290 @item @code{list}
9291 @end itemize
9292
9293 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9294
9295 @smallexample
9296 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9297 @end smallexample
9298
9299 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9300 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9301 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9302 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9303 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9304 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9305 debugged, enter:
9306
9307 @smallexample
9308 break -[Fruit create]
9309 @end smallexample
9310
9311 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9312 enter:
9313
9314 @smallexample
9315 list +[NSText initialize]
9316 @end smallexample
9317
9318 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9319 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9320 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9321 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9322
9323 @smallexample
9324 break create
9325 @end smallexample
9326
9327 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9328 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9329 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9330 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9331 none apply.
9332
9333 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9334 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9335
9336 @smallexample
9337 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9338 @end smallexample
9339
9340 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9341 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9342 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9343 @kindex print-object
9344 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9345
9346 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9347
9348 @smallexample
9349 print -[@var{object} hash]
9350 @end smallexample
9351
9352 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9353 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9354 @noindent
9355 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9356 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9357 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9358 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9359 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9360 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9361
9362 @node Fortran
9363 @subsection Fortran
9364 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9365
9366 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9367 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9368
9369 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9370 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9371 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9372 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9373 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9374 underscore.
9375
9376 @menu
9377 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9378 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9379 * Special Fortran commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9380 @end menu
9381
9382 @node Fortran Operators
9383 @subsubsection Fortran operators and expressions
9384
9385 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9386
9387 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9388 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9389 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9390
9391 @table @code
9392 @item **
9393 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9394 of the second one.
9395
9396 @item :
9397 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9398 represent a section of array.
9399 @end table
9400
9401 @node Fortran Defaults
9402 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9403
9404 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9405
9406 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9407 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9408 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9409 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9410
9411 @node Special Fortran commands
9412 @subsubsection Special Fortran commands
9413
9414 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9415
9416 @value{GDBN} had some commands to support Fortran specific feature,
9417 such as common block displaying.
9418
9419 @table @code
9420 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9421 @kindex info common
9422 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9423 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9424 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9425 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at current program location are
9426 printed.
9427 @end table
9428
9429 @node Pascal
9430 @subsection Pascal
9431
9432 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9433 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9434 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9435 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9436 syntax.
9437
9438 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9439 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9440 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9441
9442 @node Modula-2
9443 @subsection Modula-2
9444
9445 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9446
9447 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9448 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9449 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9450 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9451 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9452 table.
9453
9454 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9455 @menu
9456 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9457 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9458 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9459 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9460 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9461 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9462 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9463 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9464 @end menu
9465
9466 @node M2 Operators
9467 @subsubsection Operators
9468 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9469
9470 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9471 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9472 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9473 following definitions hold:
9474
9475 @itemize @bullet
9476
9477 @item
9478 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9479 their subranges.
9480
9481 @item
9482 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9483
9484 @item
9485 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9486
9487 @item
9488 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9489 @var{type}}.
9490
9491 @item
9492 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9493
9494 @item
9495 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9496
9497 @item
9498 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9499 @end itemize
9500
9501 @noindent
9502 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9503 increasing precedence:
9504
9505 @table @code
9506 @item ,
9507 Function argument or array index separator.
9508
9509 @item :=
9510 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9511 @var{value}.
9512
9513 @item <@r{, }>
9514 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9515 types.
9516
9517 @item <=@r{, }>=
9518 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9519 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9520 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9521
9522 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9523 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9524 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9525 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9526 comment character.
9527
9528 @item IN
9529 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9530 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9531
9532 @item OR
9533 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9534
9535 @item AND@r{, }&
9536 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9537
9538 @item @@
9539 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9540
9541 @item +@r{, }-
9542 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9543 and difference on set types.
9544
9545 @item *
9546 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9547 on set types.
9548
9549 @item /
9550 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9551 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9552
9553 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9554 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9555 precedence as @code{*}.
9556
9557 @item -
9558 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9559
9560 @item ^
9561 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9562
9563 @item NOT
9564 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9565 @code{^}.
9566
9567 @item .
9568 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9569 precedence as @code{^}.
9570
9571 @item []
9572 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9573
9574 @item ()
9575 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9576 as @code{^}.
9577
9578 @item ::@r{, }.
9579 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9580 @end table
9581
9582 @quotation
9583 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9584 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9585 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9586 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9587 @end quotation
9588
9589
9590 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9591 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
9592 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9593
9594 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9595 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9596
9597 @table @var
9598
9599 @item a
9600 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9601
9602 @item c
9603 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9604
9605 @item i
9606 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9607
9608 @item m
9609 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9610 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9611 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9612
9613 @item n
9614 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9615
9616 @item r
9617 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9618
9619 @item t
9620 represents a type.
9621
9622 @item v
9623 represents a variable.
9624
9625 @item x
9626 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9627 explanation of the function for details.
9628 @end table
9629
9630 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9631
9632 @table @code
9633 @item ABS(@var{n})
9634 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9635
9636 @item CAP(@var{c})
9637 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9638 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9639
9640 @item CHR(@var{i})
9641 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9642
9643 @item DEC(@var{v})
9644 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9645
9646 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9647 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9648 new value.
9649
9650 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9651 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9652 set.
9653
9654 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9655 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9656
9657 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9658 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9659
9660 @item INC(@var{v})
9661 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9662
9663 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9664 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9665 new value.
9666
9667 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9668 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9669 there. Returns the new set.
9670
9671 @item MAX(@var{t})
9672 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9673
9674 @item MIN(@var{t})
9675 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9676
9677 @item ODD(@var{i})
9678 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9679
9680 @item ORD(@var{x})
9681 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9682 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9683 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9684 integral, character and enumerated types.
9685
9686 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9687 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9688
9689 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9690 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9691
9692 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9693 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9694 @end table
9695
9696 @quotation
9697 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9698 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9699 an error.
9700 @end quotation
9701
9702 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9703 @node M2 Constants
9704 @subsubsection Constants
9705
9706 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9707 ways:
9708
9709 @itemize @bullet
9710
9711 @item
9712 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9713 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9714 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9715 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9716
9717 @item
9718 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9719 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9720 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9721 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9722 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9723 digits.
9724
9725 @item
9726 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9727 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9728 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9729 followed by a @samp{C}.
9730
9731 @item
9732 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9733 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9734 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9735 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9736 sequences.
9737
9738 @item
9739 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9740
9741 @item
9742 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9743 @code{FALSE}.
9744
9745 @item
9746 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9747
9748 @item
9749 Set constants are not yet supported.
9750 @end itemize
9751
9752 @node M2 Defaults
9753 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
9754 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
9755
9756 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
9757 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
9758 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9759 selected the working language.
9760
9761 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
9762 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
9763 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
9764 the language automatically}, for further details.
9765
9766 @node Deviations
9767 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
9768 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
9769
9770 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
9771 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
9772
9773 @itemize @bullet
9774 @item
9775 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
9776 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
9777 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
9778 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
9779 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
9780 returned a pointer.)
9781
9782 @item
9783 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
9784 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
9785 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
9786 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
9787
9788 @item
9789 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
9790 argument.
9791
9792 @item
9793 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
9794 @end itemize
9795
9796 @node M2 Checks
9797 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
9798 @cindex Modula-2 checks
9799
9800 @quotation
9801 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
9802 range checking.
9803 @end quotation
9804 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
9805
9806 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
9807
9808 @itemize @bullet
9809 @item
9810 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
9811 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
9812
9813 @item
9814 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
9815 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
9816 @end itemize
9817
9818 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
9819 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
9820
9821 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
9822 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
9823
9824 @node M2 Scope
9825 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9826 @cindex scope
9827 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
9828 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
9829 @ifinfo
9830 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
9831 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
9832 @end ifinfo
9833 @iftex
9834 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
9835 @end iftex
9836
9837 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
9838 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
9839 similar syntax:
9840
9841 @smallexample
9842
9843 @var{module} . @var{id}
9844 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
9845 @end smallexample
9846
9847 @noindent
9848 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
9849 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
9850 identifier within your program, except another module.
9851
9852 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
9853 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
9854 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
9855 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
9856
9857 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
9858 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
9859 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
9860 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
9861 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
9862 @var{module}.
9863
9864 @node GDB/M2
9865 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9866
9867 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
9868 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
9869 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
9870 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
9871 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
9872 analogue in Modula-2.
9873
9874 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
9875 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
9876 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
9877 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
9878 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
9879 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
9880
9881 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
9882 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
9883 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
9884
9885 @node Ada
9886 @subsection Ada
9887 @cindex Ada
9888
9889 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
9890 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
9891 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
9892 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9893 to be difficult.
9894
9895
9896 @cindex expressions in Ada
9897 @menu
9898 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
9899 and semantics supported by Ada mode
9900 in @value{GDBN}.
9901 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
9902 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
9903 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
9904 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
9905 @end menu
9906
9907 @node Ada Mode Intro
9908 @subsubsection Introduction
9909 @cindex Ada mode, general
9910
9911 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
9912 syntax, with some extensions.
9913 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
9914
9915 @itemize @bullet
9916 @item
9917 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
9918 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
9919 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
9920 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
9921
9922 @item
9923 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
9924 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
9925
9926 @item
9927 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
9928 @end itemize
9929
9930 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
9931 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
9932 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
9933 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
9934 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
9935
9936 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
9937 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
9938 was translated from an Ada source file.
9939
9940 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
9941 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
9942 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
9943 middle (to allow based literals).
9944
9945 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
9946 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
9947 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
9948 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
9949 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
9950 functions to procedures elsewhere.
9951
9952 @node Omissions from Ada
9953 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
9954 @cindex Ada, omissions from
9955
9956 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
9957
9958 @itemize @bullet
9959 @item
9960 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
9961
9962 @itemize @minus
9963 @item
9964 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
9965 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
9966
9967 @item
9968 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
9969
9970 @item
9971 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
9972
9973 @item
9974 @t{'Tag}.
9975
9976 @item
9977 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
9978 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
9979
9980 @item
9981 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
9982 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
9983
9984 @item
9985 @t{'Address}.
9986 @end itemize
9987
9988 @item
9989 The names in
9990 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
9991 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
9992 not currently available.
9993
9994 @item
9995 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
9996 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
9997 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
9998 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
9999 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10000 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10001 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10002 indeterminate values.
10003
10004 @item
10005 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10006 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10007 are not implemented.
10008
10009 @item
10010 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10011 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10012 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10013 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10014 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10015
10016 @smallexample
10017 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10018 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10019 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10020 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10021 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10022 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10023 @end smallexample
10024
10025 Changing a
10026 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10027 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10028 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10029 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10030 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10031 declared to have a type such as:
10032
10033 @smallexample
10034 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10035 Id : Integer;
10036 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10037 end record;
10038 @end smallexample
10039
10040 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10041 assignments:
10042
10043 @smallexample
10044 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10045 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10046 @end smallexample
10047
10048 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10049 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10050 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10051 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10052 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10053 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10054 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10055 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10056
10057 @item
10058 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10059
10060 @item
10061 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10062 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in which a subexpression
10063 appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much looser in its rules for allowing
10064 type matches. As a result, some function calls will be ambiguous, and the user
10065 will be asked to choose the proper resolution.
10066
10067 @item
10068 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10069
10070 @item
10071 Entry calls are not implemented.
10072
10073 @item
10074 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10075 formats are not supported.
10076
10077 @item
10078 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10079 @end itemize
10080
10081 @node Additions to Ada
10082 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10083 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10084
10085 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10086 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10087
10088 @itemize @bullet
10089 @item
10090 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory
10091 (typically a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is
10092 a positive integer, then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of
10093 @var{E} and the @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.
10094 In Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use
10095 is in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in Ada.
10096 However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs
10097 in which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10098
10099 @item
10100 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that appears
10101 in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, you must typically
10102 surround it in single quotes.
10103
10104 @item
10105 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10106 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10107
10108 @item
10109 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10110 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10111 @end itemize
10112
10113 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright additions specific
10114 to Ada:
10115
10116 @itemize @bullet
10117 @item
10118 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10119 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10120
10121 @smallexample
10122 set x := y + 3
10123 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10124 @end smallexample
10125
10126 @item
10127 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10128 the value of its right-hand operand.
10129 This allows, for example,
10130 complex conditional breaks:
10131
10132 @smallexample
10133 break f
10134 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10135 @end smallexample
10136
10137 @item
10138 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10139 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10140 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10141 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10142 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10143 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10144 in strings. For example,
10145 @smallexample
10146 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10147 @end smallexample
10148 @noindent
10149 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) after each
10150 period.
10151
10152 @item
10153 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10154 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10155 to write
10156
10157 @smallexample
10158 print 'max(x, y)
10159 @end smallexample
10160
10161 @item
10162 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10163 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10164 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound of 3 might print as
10165
10166 @smallexample
10167 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10168 @end smallexample
10169
10170 @noindent
10171 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10172 clause.
10173
10174 @item
10175 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10176 multi-character subsequence of
10177 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10178 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10179 in place of @t{a'length}.
10180
10181 @item
10182 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10183 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10184 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10185 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10186 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10187 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10188 For example,
10189 @smallexample
10190 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10191 @end smallexample
10192
10193 @item
10194 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10195 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10196 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10197 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10198 object.
10199
10200 @end itemize
10201
10202 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10203 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10204
10205 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10206 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10207 before reaching the main procedure.
10208 As defined in the Ada Reference
10209 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10210 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10211 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10212 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10213
10214 @node Ada Glitches
10215 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10216 @cindex Ada, problems
10217
10218 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10219 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10220 @value{GDBN},
10221 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10222 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10223
10224 @itemize @bullet
10225 @item
10226 Currently, the debugger
10227 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10228 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10229 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10230 to get it printed properly.
10231
10232 @item
10233 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10234 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10235
10236 @item
10237 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10238 argument lists are treated as positional).
10239
10240 @item
10241 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10242
10243 @item
10244 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10245 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10246 the host machine.
10247
10248 @item
10249 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10250
10251 @item
10252 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10253 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10254 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10255 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10256 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10257 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10258 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10259 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10260 you can usually resolve the confusion
10261 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10262 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10263 @end itemize
10264
10265 @node Unsupported languages
10266 @section Unsupported languages
10267
10268 @cindex unsupported languages
10269 @cindex minimal language
10270 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10271 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10272 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10273 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10274 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10275 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10276
10277 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10278 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10279 language.
10280
10281 @node Symbols
10282 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10283
10284 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10285 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10286 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10287 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10288 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10289 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
10290 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10291
10292 @cindex symbol names
10293 @cindex names of symbols
10294 @cindex quoting names
10295 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10296 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10297 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10298 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
10299 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10300 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10301 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10302 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10303
10304 @smallexample
10305 p 'foo.c'::x
10306 @end smallexample
10307
10308 @noindent
10309 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10310
10311 @table @code
10312 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10313 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10314 @kindex set case-sensitive
10315 @item set case-sensitive on
10316 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10317 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10318 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10319 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10320 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10321 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10322 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10323 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10324 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10325 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10326 case-insensitive matches.
10327
10328 @kindex show case-sensitive
10329 @item show case-sensitive
10330 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10331 lookups.
10332
10333 @kindex info address
10334 @cindex address of a symbol
10335 @item info address @var{symbol}
10336 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10337 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10338 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10339 is always stored.
10340
10341 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10342 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10343 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10344
10345 @kindex info symbol
10346 @cindex symbol from address
10347 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10348 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10349 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10350 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10351 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10352
10353 @smallexample
10354 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10355 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10356 @end smallexample
10357
10358 @noindent
10359 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10360 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10361
10362 @kindex whatis
10363 @item whatis @var{expr}
10364 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
10365 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10366 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
10367 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10368
10369 @item whatis
10370 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10371
10372 @kindex ptype
10373 @item ptype @var{typename}
10374 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
10375 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
10376 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
10377 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10378
10379 @item ptype @var{expr}
10380 @itemx ptype
10381 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
10382 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
10383 of just the name of the type.
10384
10385 For example, for this variable declaration:
10386
10387 @smallexample
10388 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10389 @end smallexample
10390
10391 @noindent
10392 the two commands give this output:
10393
10394 @smallexample
10395 @group
10396 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10397 type = struct complex
10398 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10399 type = struct complex @{
10400 double real;
10401 double imag;
10402 @}
10403 @end group
10404 @end smallexample
10405
10406 @noindent
10407 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10408 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10409
10410 @cindex incomplete type
10411 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10412 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10413 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10414 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10415 given these declarations:
10416
10417 @smallexample
10418 struct foo;
10419 struct foo *fooptr;
10420 @end smallexample
10421
10422 @noindent
10423 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10424
10425 @smallexample
10426 (gdb) ptype foo
10427 $1 = <incomplete type>
10428 @end smallexample
10429
10430 @noindent
10431 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10432 completely specified.
10433
10434 @kindex info types
10435 @item info types @var{regexp}
10436 @itemx info types
10437 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10438 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10439 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10440 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10441 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10442 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10443 name is @code{value}.
10444
10445 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10446 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10447 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10448
10449 @kindex info scope
10450 @cindex local variables
10451 @item info scope @var{location}
10452 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10453 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10454 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10455 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10456
10457 @smallexample
10458 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10459 Scope for command_line_handler:
10460 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10461 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10462 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10463 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10464 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10465 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10466 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10467 @end smallexample
10468
10469 @noindent
10470 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10471 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10472 collect}.
10473
10474 @kindex info source
10475 @item info source
10476 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10477 the function containing the current point of execution:
10478 @itemize @bullet
10479 @item
10480 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10481 @item
10482 the directory it was compiled in,
10483 @item
10484 its length, in lines,
10485 @item
10486 which programming language it is written in,
10487 @item
10488 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10489 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10490 @item
10491 whether the debugging information includes information about
10492 preprocessor macros.
10493 @end itemize
10494
10495
10496 @kindex info sources
10497 @item info sources
10498 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10499 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10500 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10501
10502 @kindex info functions
10503 @item info functions
10504 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10505
10506 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10507 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10508 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10509 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10510 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10511 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10512 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10513 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10514
10515 @kindex info variables
10516 @item info variables
10517 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10518 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10519
10520 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10521 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10522 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10523 @var{regexp}.
10524
10525 @kindex info classes
10526 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10527 @item info classes
10528 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10529 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10530 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10531 expression.
10532
10533 @kindex info selectors
10534 @item info selectors
10535 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10536 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10537 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10538 expression.
10539
10540 @ignore
10541 This was never implemented.
10542 @kindex info methods
10543 @item info methods
10544 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10545 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10546 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10547 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10548 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10549 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10550 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10551 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10552 @end ignore
10553
10554 @cindex reloading symbols
10555 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10556 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10557 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10558 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10559 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10560
10561 @table @code
10562 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10563 @item set symbol-reloading on
10564 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10565 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10566
10567 @item set symbol-reloading off
10568 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10569 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10570 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10571 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10572 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10573 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10574 name.
10575
10576 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10577 @item show symbol-reloading
10578 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10579 @end table
10580
10581 @cindex opaque data types
10582 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10583 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10584 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10585 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10586 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10587 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10588 another source file. The default is on.
10589
10590 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10591 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10592
10593 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10594 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10595 is printed as follows:
10596 @smallexample
10597 @{<no data fields>@}
10598 @end smallexample
10599
10600 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10601 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10602 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10603
10604 @kindex maint print symbols
10605 @cindex symbol dump
10606 @kindex maint print psymbols
10607 @cindex partial symbol dump
10608 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
10609 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
10610 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
10611 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
10612 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
10613 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
10614 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
10615 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
10616 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
10617 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
10618 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
10619 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
10620 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
10621 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
10622 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
10623 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
10624 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
10625
10626 @kindex maint info symtabs
10627 @kindex maint info psymtabs
10628 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
10629 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10630 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10631 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10632 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10633 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10634
10635 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
10636 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
10637 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
10638 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
10639 structure in more detail. For example:
10640
10641 @smallexample
10642 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
10643 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10644 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10645 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10646 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
10647 readin no
10648 fullname (null)
10649 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
10650 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
10651 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
10652 dependencies (none)
10653 @}
10654 @}
10655 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10656 (@value{GDBP})
10657 @end smallexample
10658 @noindent
10659 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
10660 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
10661 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
10662 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
10663 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
10664
10665 @smallexample
10666 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
10667 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
10668 line 1574.
10669 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10670 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10671 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10672 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10673 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
10674 dirname (null)
10675 fullname (null)
10676 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
10677 debugformat DWARF 2
10678 @}
10679 @}
10680 (@value{GDBP})
10681 @end smallexample
10682 @end table
10683
10684
10685 @node Altering
10686 @chapter Altering Execution
10687
10688 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
10689 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
10690 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
10691 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
10692 program.
10693
10694 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
10695 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
10696 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
10697
10698 @menu
10699 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
10700 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
10701 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
10702 * Returning:: Returning from a function
10703 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
10704 * Patching:: Patching your program
10705 @end menu
10706
10707 @node Assignment
10708 @section Assignment to variables
10709
10710 @cindex assignment
10711 @cindex setting variables
10712 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
10713 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
10714
10715 @smallexample
10716 print x=4
10717 @end smallexample
10718
10719 @noindent
10720 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
10721 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
10722 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
10723 information on operators in supported languages.
10724
10725 @kindex set variable
10726 @cindex variables, setting
10727 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
10728 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
10729 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
10730 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
10731 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
10732
10733 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
10734 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
10735 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
10736 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
10737 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
10738 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
10739 command @code{set width}:
10740
10741 @smallexample
10742 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
10743 type = double
10744 (@value{GDBP}) p width
10745 $4 = 13
10746 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
10747 Invalid syntax in expression.
10748 @end smallexample
10749
10750 @noindent
10751 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
10752 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
10753
10754 @smallexample
10755 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
10756 @end smallexample
10757
10758 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
10759 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
10760 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
10761 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
10762 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
10763 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
10764
10765 @smallexample
10766 @group
10767 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
10768 type = double
10769 (@value{GDBP}) p g
10770 $1 = 1
10771 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
10772 (@value{GDBP}) p g
10773 $2 = 1
10774 (@value{GDBP}) r
10775 The program being debugged has been started already.
10776 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
10777 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
10778 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
10779 Invalid bfd target.
10780 (@value{GDBP}) show g
10781 The current BFD target is "=4".
10782 @end group
10783 @end smallexample
10784
10785 @noindent
10786 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
10787 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
10788 @code{g}, use
10789
10790 @smallexample
10791 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
10792 @end smallexample
10793
10794 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
10795 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
10796 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
10797 same length or shorter.
10798 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
10799 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
10800
10801 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
10802 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
10803 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
10804 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
10805 and representation in memory), and
10806
10807 @smallexample
10808 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
10809 @end smallexample
10810
10811 @noindent
10812 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
10813
10814 @node Jumping
10815 @section Continuing at a different address
10816
10817 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
10818 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
10819 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
10820
10821 @table @code
10822 @kindex jump
10823 @item jump @var{linespec}
10824 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
10825 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
10826 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
10827 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
10828 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
10829 breakpoints}.
10830
10831 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
10832 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
10833 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
10834 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
10835 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
10836 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
10837 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
10838 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
10839 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
10840
10841 @item jump *@var{address}
10842 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
10843 @end table
10844
10845 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
10846 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
10847 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
10848 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
10849 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
10850 example,
10851
10852 @smallexample
10853 set $pc = 0x485
10854 @end smallexample
10855
10856 @noindent
10857 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
10858 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
10859 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
10860
10861 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
10862 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
10863 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
10864 detail.
10865
10866 @c @group
10867 @node Signaling
10868 @section Giving your program a signal
10869 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
10870
10871 @table @code
10872 @kindex signal
10873 @item signal @var{signal}
10874 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
10875 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
10876 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
10877 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
10878
10879 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
10880 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
10881 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
10882 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
10883 signal.
10884
10885 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
10886 after executing the command.
10887 @end table
10888 @c @end group
10889
10890 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
10891 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
10892 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
10893 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
10894 passes the signal directly to your program.
10895
10896
10897 @node Returning
10898 @section Returning from a function
10899
10900 @table @code
10901 @cindex returning from a function
10902 @kindex return
10903 @item return
10904 @itemx return @var{expression}
10905 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
10906 command. If you give an
10907 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
10908 value.
10909 @end table
10910
10911 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
10912 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
10913 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
10914 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
10915
10916 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
10917 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
10918 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
10919 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
10920 of functions.
10921
10922 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
10923 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
10924 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
10925 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
10926 selected stack frame returns naturally.
10927
10928 @node Calling
10929 @section Calling program functions
10930
10931 @table @code
10932 @cindex calling functions
10933 @cindex inferior functions, calling
10934 @item print @var{expr}
10935 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resuling value.
10936 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
10937 debugged.
10938
10939 @kindex call
10940 @item call @var{expr}
10941 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
10942 returned values.
10943
10944 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
10945 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
10946 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
10947 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
10948 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
10949 value history.
10950 @end table
10951
10952 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
10953 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
10954 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
10955 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
10956
10957 @table @code
10958 @item set unwindonsignal
10959 @kindex set unwindonsignal
10960 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
10961 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
10962 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
10963 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
10964 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
10965 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
10966 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
10967 received.
10968
10969 @item show unwindonsignal
10970 @kindex show unwindonsignal
10971 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
10972 @value{GDBN}.
10973 @end table
10974
10975 @cindex weak alias functions
10976 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
10977 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
10978 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
10979 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
10980 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
10981 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
10982 function instead.
10983
10984 @node Patching
10985 @section Patching programs
10986
10987 @cindex patching binaries
10988 @cindex writing into executables
10989 @cindex writing into corefiles
10990
10991 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
10992 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
10993 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
10994 patching your program's binary.
10995
10996 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
10997 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
10998 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
10999 repairs.
11000
11001 @table @code
11002 @kindex set write
11003 @item set write on
11004 @itemx set write off
11005 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11006 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11007 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11008
11009 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11010 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11011 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11012
11013 @item show write
11014 @kindex show write
11015 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11016 as well as reading.
11017 @end table
11018
11019 @node GDB Files
11020 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11021
11022 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11023 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11024 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11025 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11026
11027 @menu
11028 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11029 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11030 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11031 @end menu
11032
11033 @node Files
11034 @section Commands to specify files
11035
11036 @cindex symbol table
11037 @cindex core dump file
11038
11039 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11040 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11041 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11042 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11043
11044 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11045 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11046 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11047 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file}). In these situations the
11048 @value{GDBN} commands to specify new files are useful.
11049
11050 @table @code
11051 @cindex executable file
11052 @kindex file
11053 @item file @var{filename}
11054 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11055 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11056 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11057 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11058 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11059 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11060 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11061 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11062
11063 @cindex unlinked object files
11064 @cindex patching object files
11065 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11066 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11067 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11068 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11069 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11070 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11071 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11072 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11073
11074 @item file
11075 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11076 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11077
11078 @kindex exec-file
11079 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11080 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11081 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11082 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11083 discard information on the executable file.
11084
11085 @kindex symbol-file
11086 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11087 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11088 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11089 table and program to run from the same file.
11090
11091 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11092 program's symbol table.
11093
11094 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
11095 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
11096 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
11097 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
11098 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
11099
11100 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11101 executing it once.
11102
11103 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11104 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11105 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11106 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11107 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11108 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11109 optimized code.
11110
11111 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11112 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11113 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11114 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11115 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11116
11117 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11118 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11119 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11120 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11121 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11122 warnings and messages}.)
11123
11124 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11125 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11126 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11127 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11128 in stabs format.
11129
11130 @kindex readnow
11131 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11132 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11133 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11134 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11135 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11136 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11137 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11138 entire symbol table available.
11139
11140 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11141 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11142 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11143 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11144 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11145 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11146 @c files.
11147
11148 @kindex core-file
11149 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11150 @itemx core
11151 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11152 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11153 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11154 executable file itself for other parts.
11155
11156 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11157 to be used.
11158
11159 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11160 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11161 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11162 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11163 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
11164
11165 @kindex add-symbol-file
11166 @cindex dynamic linking
11167 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11168 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11169 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11170 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11171 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11172 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11173 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11174 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11175 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11176 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11177 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11178 @var{address} as an expression.
11179
11180 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11181 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11182 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11183 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11184 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11185
11186 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11187 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11188 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11189 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11190 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11191 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11192 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11193 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11194 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11195
11196 @itemize @bullet
11197 @item
11198 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11199 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11200 @item
11201 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11202 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11203 @item
11204 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11205 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11206 @end itemize
11207
11208 @noindent
11209 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11210 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11211 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11212 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11213 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11214 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11215 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11216 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11217 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11218 way.
11219
11220 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11221
11222 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11223 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11224 @cindex load symbols from memory
11225 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11226 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11227 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11228 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11229 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11230 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11231 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11232 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11233 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11234
11235 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11236 @kindex assf
11237 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11238 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11239 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11240 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11241 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11242 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11243 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11244 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11245 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11246 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11247
11248 @kindex section
11249 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11250 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11251 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11252 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11253 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11254 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11255 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11256 their addresses.
11257
11258 @kindex info files
11259 @kindex info target
11260 @item info files
11261 @itemx info target
11262 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11263 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11264 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11265 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11266 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11267 current ones.
11268
11269 @kindex maint info sections
11270 @item maint info sections
11271 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11272 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11273 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11274 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11275 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11276 may be arbitrarily combined):
11277
11278 @table @code
11279 @item ALLOBJ
11280 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11281 @item @var{sections}
11282 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11283 @item @var{section-flags}
11284 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11285 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11286 @table @code
11287 @item ALLOC
11288 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11289 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11290 @item LOAD
11291 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11292 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11293 @item RELOC
11294 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11295 @item READONLY
11296 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11297 @item CODE
11298 Section contains executable code only.
11299 @item DATA
11300 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11301 @item ROM
11302 Section will reside in ROM.
11303 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11304 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11305 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11306 Section is not empty.
11307 @item NEVER_LOAD
11308 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11309 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11310 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11311 COFF shared library information.
11312 @item IS_COMMON
11313 Section contains common symbols.
11314 @end table
11315 @end table
11316 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11317 @cindex read-only sections
11318 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11319 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11320 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11321 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11322 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11323 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11324 enhancement to debugging performance.
11325
11326 The default is off.
11327
11328 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11329 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11330 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11331 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11332
11333 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11334 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11335 @end table
11336
11337 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11338 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11339 name and remembers it that way.
11340
11341 @cindex shared libraries
11342 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11343 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11344
11345 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11346 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11347 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11348 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11349 debugging a core file).
11350
11351 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11352 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11353
11354 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11355 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11356 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11357
11358 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11359 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11360 particularly large or there are many of them.
11361
11362 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11363 commands:
11364
11365 @table @code
11366 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11367 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11368 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11369 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11370 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11371 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11372 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11373 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11374
11375 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11376 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11377 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11378 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11379 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11380 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11381 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11382 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expresion that matches
11383 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11384
11385 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11386 @item show auto-solib-add
11387 Display the current autoloading mode.
11388 @end table
11389
11390 @cindex load shared library
11391 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11392 command:
11393
11394 @table @code
11395 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11396 @kindex info share
11397 @item info share
11398 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11399 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11400
11401 @kindex sharedlibrary
11402 @kindex share
11403 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11404 @itemx share @var{regex}
11405 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11406 Unix regular expression.
11407 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11408 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11409 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11410 loaded.
11411
11412 @item nosharedlibrary
11413 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11414 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11415 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11416 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11417 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11418 discarded.
11419 @end table
11420
11421 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11422 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11423 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11424
11425 @table @code
11426 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11427 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11428 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11429 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11430 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11431 shared library.
11432
11433 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11434 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11435 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11436 library events happen.
11437 @end table
11438
11439 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11440 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11441 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11442 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11443 not.
11444
11445 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11446 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11447 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11448 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11449 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11450
11451 @table @code
11452 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11453 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11454 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
11455 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
11456 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
11457 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
11458 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
11459 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
11460 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
11461
11462 @cindex default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
11463 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11464 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
11465 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
11466
11467 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
11468 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
11469 Display the current shared library prefix.
11470
11471 @kindex set solib-search-path
11472 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11473 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
11474 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
11475 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
11476 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
11477 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
11478 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
11479 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
11480
11481 @kindex show solib-search-path
11482 @item show solib-search-path
11483 Display the current shared library search path.
11484 @end table
11485
11486
11487 @node Separate Debug Files
11488 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11489 @cindex separate debugging information files
11490 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11491 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11492 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11493 @cindex global debugging information directory
11494
11495 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11496 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11497 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11498 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11499 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11500 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11501 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11502
11503 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11504 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11505 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11506 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11507 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11508 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11509 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11510 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11511 places:
11512
11513 @itemize @bullet
11514 @item
11515 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11516 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11517 @item
11518 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11519 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11520 @item
11521 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11522 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11523 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11524 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11525 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11526 @end itemize
11527 @noindent
11528 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11529 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11530 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11531
11532 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11533 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11534 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11535 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11536 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11537 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11538
11539 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11540 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11541
11542 @table @code
11543
11544 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11545 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11546 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11547 information files to @var{directory}.
11548
11549 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11550 @item show debug-file-directory
11551 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11552 information files.
11553
11554 @end table
11555
11556 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11557 @cindex debug links
11558 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11559 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11560
11561 @itemize
11562 @item
11563 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11564 a zero byte,
11565 @item
11566 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11567 boundary within the section, and
11568 @item
11569 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11570 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11571 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11572 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11573 @end itemize
11574
11575 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11576 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11577 described above.
11578
11579 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11580 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11581 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11582 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11583 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11584 in an ordinary executable.
11585
11586 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11587 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11588 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11589 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11590 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11591 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11592 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11593
11594 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11595 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11596 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11597 complete code for a function that computes it:
11598
11599 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
11600 @smallexample
11601 unsigned long
11602 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
11603 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
11604 @{
11605 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
11606 @{
11607 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
11608 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
11609 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
11610 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
11611 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
11612 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
11613 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
11614 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
11615 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
11616 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
11617 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
11618 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
11619 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
11620 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
11621 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
11622 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
11623 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
11624 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
11625 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
11626 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
11627 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
11628 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
11629 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
11630 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
11631 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
11632 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
11633 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
11634 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
11635 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
11636 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
11637 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
11638 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
11639 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
11640 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
11641 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
11642 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
11643 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
11644 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
11645 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
11646 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
11647 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
11648 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
11649 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
11650 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
11651 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
11652 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
11653 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
11654 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
11655 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
11656 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
11657 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
11658 0x2d02ef8d
11659 @};
11660 unsigned char *end;
11661
11662 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11663 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
11664 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
11665 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11666 @}
11667 @end smallexample
11668
11669
11670 @node Symbol Errors
11671 @section Errors reading symbol files
11672
11673 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
11674 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
11675 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
11676 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
11677 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
11678 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
11679 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
11680 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
11681 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
11682 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
11683 messages}).
11684
11685 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
11686
11687 @table @code
11688 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
11689
11690 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
11691 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
11692 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
11693 in its outer scope blocks.
11694
11695 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
11696 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
11697 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
11698 function.
11699
11700 @item block at @var{address} out of order
11701
11702 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
11703 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
11704 do so.
11705
11706 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
11707 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
11708 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
11709 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
11710 messages}.)
11711
11712 @item bad block start address patched
11713
11714 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
11715 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
11716 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
11717
11718 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
11719 starting on the previous source line.
11720
11721 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
11722
11723 @cindex foo
11724 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
11725 larger than the size of the string table.
11726
11727 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
11728 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
11729 with this name.
11730
11731 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
11732
11733 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
11734 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
11735 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
11736
11737 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
11738 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
11739 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
11740 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
11741 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
11742 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
11743
11744 @item stub type has NULL name
11745
11746 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
11747
11748 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
11749 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
11750 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
11751 it.
11752
11753 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
11754
11755 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
11756
11757 @end table
11758
11759 @node Targets
11760 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
11761
11762 @cindex debugging target
11763 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
11764
11765 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
11766 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
11767 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
11768 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
11769 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
11770 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
11771 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
11772 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11773
11774 @cindex target architecture
11775 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
11776 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
11777 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
11778 command.
11779
11780 @table @code
11781 @kindex set architecture
11782 @kindex show architecture
11783 @item set architecture @var{arch}
11784 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
11785 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
11786 supported architectures.
11787
11788 @item show architecture
11789 Show the current target architecture.
11790
11791 @item set processor
11792 @itemx processor
11793 @kindex set processor
11794 @kindex show processor
11795 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
11796 and @code{show architecture}.
11797 @end table
11798
11799 @menu
11800 * Active Targets:: Active targets
11801 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
11802 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
11803 * Remote:: Remote debugging
11804 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
11805
11806 @end menu
11807
11808 @node Active Targets
11809 @section Active targets
11810
11811 @cindex stacking targets
11812 @cindex active targets
11813 @cindex multiple targets
11814
11815 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
11816 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
11817 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
11818 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
11819 a core file.
11820
11821 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
11822 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
11823 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
11824 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
11825 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
11826 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
11827 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
11828 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
11829 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
11830
11831 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
11832 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
11833 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
11834 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
11835 process target is active.
11836
11837 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
11838 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
11839 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
11840 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
11841 process}).
11842
11843 @node Target Commands
11844 @section Commands for managing targets
11845
11846 @table @code
11847 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
11848 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
11849 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
11850 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
11851 protocol of the target machine.
11852
11853 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
11854 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
11855 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
11856
11857 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
11858 after executing the command.
11859
11860 @kindex help target
11861 @item help target
11862 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
11863 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
11864 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
11865
11866 @item help target @var{name}
11867 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
11868 select it.
11869
11870 @kindex set gnutarget
11871 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
11872 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
11873 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
11874 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
11875 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
11876 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
11877
11878 @quotation
11879 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
11880 you must know the actual BFD name.
11881 @end quotation
11882
11883 @noindent
11884 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
11885
11886 @kindex show gnutarget
11887 @item show gnutarget
11888 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
11889 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
11890 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
11891 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
11892 @end table
11893
11894 @cindex common targets
11895 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
11896 configuration):
11897
11898 @table @code
11899 @kindex target
11900 @item target exec @var{program}
11901 @cindex executable file target
11902 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
11903 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
11904
11905 @item target core @var{filename}
11906 @cindex core dump file target
11907 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
11908 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
11909
11910 @item target remote @var{dev}
11911 @cindex remote target
11912 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
11913 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.@:
11914 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
11915 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
11916 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
11917 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
11918
11919 @item target sim
11920 @cindex built-in simulator target
11921 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
11922 In general,
11923 @smallexample
11924 target sim
11925 load
11926 run
11927 @end smallexample
11928 @noindent
11929 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
11930 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
11931 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
11932 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
11933 Processors}.
11934
11935 @end table
11936
11937 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
11938
11939 @table @code
11940
11941 @item target nrom @var{dev}
11942 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
11943 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
11944
11945 @end table
11946
11947 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
11948 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
11949
11950 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
11951 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
11952 various aspects of this process, such as the size of the data chunks
11953 used by @value{GDBN} to download program parts to the remote target.
11954
11955 @table @code
11956 @kindex set download-write-size
11957 @item set download-write-size @var{size}
11958 Set the write size used when downloading a program. Only used when
11959 downloading a program onto a remote target. Specify zero or a
11960 negative value to disable blocked writes. The actual size of each
11961 transfer is also limited by the size of the target packet and the
11962 memory cache.
11963
11964 @kindex show download-write-size
11965 @item show download-write-size
11966 @kindex show download-write-size
11967 Show the current value of the write size.
11968
11969 @item set hash
11970 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
11971 @cindex hash mark while downloading
11972 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
11973 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
11974 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
11975 monitor.
11976
11977 @item show hash
11978 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
11979 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
11980
11981 @item set debug monitor
11982 @kindex set debug monitor
11983 @cindex display remote monitor communications
11984 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
11985 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
11986
11987 @item show debug monitor
11988 @kindex show debug monitor
11989 Show the current status of displaying communications between
11990 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
11991 @end table
11992
11993 @table @code
11994
11995 @kindex load @var{filename}
11996 @item load @var{filename}
11997 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
11998 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
11999 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12000 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12001 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12002 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12003
12004 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12005 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12006 target is @dots{}}''
12007
12008 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12009 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12010 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12011 specifies a fixed address.
12012 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12013
12014 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12015 @end table
12016
12017 @node Byte Order
12018 @section Choosing target byte order
12019
12020 @cindex choosing target byte order
12021 @cindex target byte order
12022
12023 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12024 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12025 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12026 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12027 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12028 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12029
12030 @table @code
12031 @kindex set endian
12032 @item set endian big
12033 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12034
12035 @item set endian little
12036 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12037
12038 @item set endian auto
12039 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12040 executable.
12041
12042 @item show endian
12043 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12044
12045 @end table
12046
12047 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12048 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12049 target system.
12050
12051 @node Remote
12052 @section Remote debugging
12053 @cindex remote debugging
12054
12055 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12056 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12057 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12058 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12059 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12060
12061 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12062 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12063 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12064 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12065 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12066 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12067
12068 Other remote targets may be available in your
12069 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12070
12071 Once you've connected to the remote target, @value{GDBN} allows you to
12072 send arbitrary commands to the remote monitor:
12073
12074 @table @code
12075 @item remote @var{command}
12076 @kindex remote@r{, a command}
12077 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12078 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the remote monitor.
12079 @end table
12080
12081
12082 @node KOD
12083 @section Kernel Object Display
12084 @cindex kernel object display
12085 @cindex KOD
12086
12087 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
12088 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
12089 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
12090 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
12091 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
12092
12093 @kindex set os
12094 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
12095 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
12096
12097 @smallexample
12098 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
12099 @end smallexample
12100
12101 @kindex show os
12102 The associated command @code{show os} displays the operating system
12103 set with the @code{set os} command; if no operating system has been
12104 set, @code{show os} will display an empty string @samp{""}.
12105
12106 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
12107 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
12108 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
12109 after the operating system:
12110
12111 @kindex info cisco
12112 @smallexample
12113 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
12114 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
12115 Object Description
12116 any Any and all objects
12117 @end smallexample
12118
12119 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
12120 by the kernel.
12121
12122 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating
12123 system is supported other than to try setting it with @kbd{set os
12124 @var{name}}, where @var{name} is the name of the operating system you
12125 want to try.
12126
12127
12128 @node Remote Debugging
12129 @chapter Debugging remote programs
12130
12131 @menu
12132 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12133 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12134 * NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
12135 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
12136 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12137 @end menu
12138
12139 @node Connecting
12140 @section Connecting to a remote target
12141
12142 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12143 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
12144 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12145 program as the first argument.
12146
12147 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12148 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12149 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12150 (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12151 @code{target} command.
12152
12153 After that, use @code{target remote} to establish communications with
12154 the target machine. Its argument specifies how to communicate---either
12155 via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a TCP or UDP port
12156 (possibly to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12157 target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the device
12158 named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12159
12160 @smallexample
12161 target remote /dev/ttyb
12162 @end smallexample
12163
12164 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
12165 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
12166 @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
12167 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
12168 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12169
12170 @smallexample
12171 target remote manyfarms:2828
12172 @end smallexample
12173
12174 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
12175 your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
12176 the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
12177 to port 1234 on your local machine:
12178
12179 @smallexample
12180 target remote :1234
12181 @end smallexample
12182 @noindent
12183
12184 Note that the colon is still required here.
12185
12186 @cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
12187 To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
12188 @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
12189 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12190
12191 @smallexample
12192 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12193 @end smallexample
12194
12195 When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
12196 that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
12197 busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
12198 session.
12199
12200 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
12201 step and continue the remote program.
12202
12203 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12204 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12205 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12206 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12207 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12208 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12209 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12210
12211 @smallexample
12212 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12213 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12214 @end smallexample
12215
12216 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12217 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12218 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12219 goes back to waiting.
12220
12221 @table @code
12222 @kindex detach (remote)
12223 @item detach
12224 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12225 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12226 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12227 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12228 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12229
12230 @kindex disconnect
12231 @item disconnect
12232 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12233 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12234 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12235 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12236 another target.
12237
12238 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12239 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12240 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12241 @kindex monitor
12242 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12243 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12244 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12245 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12246 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12247 and implement.
12248 @end table
12249
12250 @node Server
12251 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
12252
12253 @kindex gdbserver
12254 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12255 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12256 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12257 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12258
12259 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12260 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12261 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12262 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12263 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12264 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12265 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12266 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12267 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12268 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12269 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12270 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12271 choice for debugging.
12272
12273 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12274 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12275 protocol.
12276
12277 @table @emph
12278 @item On the target machine,
12279 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12280 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12281 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12282 system does all the symbol handling.
12283
12284 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12285 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12286 syntax is:
12287
12288 @smallexample
12289 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12290 @end smallexample
12291
12292 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12293 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12294 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12295 @file{/dev/com1}:
12296
12297 @smallexample
12298 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12299 @end smallexample
12300
12301 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12302 with it.
12303
12304 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12305
12306 @smallexample
12307 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12308 @end smallexample
12309
12310 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12311 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12312 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12313 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12314 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12315 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12316 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12317 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12318 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12319 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12320 @code{target remote} command.
12321
12322 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12323 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12324
12325 @smallexample
12326 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12327 @end smallexample
12328
12329 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12330 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12331
12332 @pindex pidof
12333 @cindex attach to a program by name
12334 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12335 @code{pidof} utility:
12336
12337 @smallexample
12338 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
12339 @end smallexample
12340
12341 In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
12342 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12343 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12344
12345 @item On the host machine,
12346 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12347 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12348 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12349 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12350 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12351 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12352 already on the target. However, if you want to load the symbols (as
12353 you normally would), do that with the @code{file} command, and issue
12354 it @emph{before} connecting to the server; otherwise, you will get an
12355 error message saying @code{"Program is already running"}, since the
12356 program is considered running after the connection.
12357
12358 @end table
12359
12360 @node NetWare
12361 @section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
12362
12363 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
12364 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
12365 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12366 @code{target remote}.
12367
12368 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
12369 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
12370
12371 @table @emph
12372 @item On the target machine,
12373 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12374 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
12375 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
12376 host system does all the symbol handling.
12377
12378 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
12379 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
12380 program. The syntax is:
12381
12382 @smallexample
12383 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
12384 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12385 @end smallexample
12386
12387 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
12388 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
12389 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
12390
12391 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
12392 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
12393 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
12394
12395 @smallexample
12396 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
12397 @end smallexample
12398
12399 @item
12400 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,
12401 Connecting to a remote target}).
12402
12403 @end table
12404
12405 @node Remote configuration
12406 @section Remote configuration
12407
12408 @kindex set remote
12409 @kindex show remote
12410 This section documents the configuration options available when
12411 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12412 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{The system call,
12413 system-call-allowed}.
12414
12415 @table @code
12416 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12417 @cindex adress size for remote targets
12418 @cindex bits in remote address
12419 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12420 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12421 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12422 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12423
12424 @item show remoteaddresssize
12425 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12426
12427 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12428 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12429 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12430 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12431 remote targets.
12432
12433 @item show remotebaud
12434 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12435
12436 @item set remotebreak
12437 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12438 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12439 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12440 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12441 when you press the @key{Ctrl-C} key to interrupt the program running
12442 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12443 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12444 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12445
12446 @item show remotebreak
12447 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12448 interrupt the remote program.
12449
12450 @item set remotedebug
12451 @cindex debug remote protocol
12452 @cindex remote protocol debugging
12453 @cindex display remote packets
12454 Control the debugging of the remote protocol. When enabled, each
12455 packet sent to or received from the remote target is displayed. The
12456 defaults is off.
12457
12458 @item show remotedebug
12459 Show the current setting of the remote protocol debugging.
12460
12461 @item set remotedevice @var{device}
12462 @cindex serial port name
12463 Set the name of the serial port through which to communicate to the
12464 remote target to @var{device}. This is the device used by
12465 @value{GDBN} to open the serial communications line to the remote
12466 target. There's no default, so you must set a valid port name for the
12467 remote serial communications to work. (Some varieties of the
12468 @code{target} command accept the port name as part of their
12469 arguments.)
12470
12471 @item show remotedevice
12472 Show the current name of the serial port.
12473
12474 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12475 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12476 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12477 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12478 @code{ascii}.
12479
12480 @item show remotelogbase
12481 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12482 protocol.
12483
12484 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12485 @cindex record serial communications on file
12486 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12487 default is not to record at all.
12488
12489 @item show remotelogfile.
12490 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12491 serial communications.
12492
12493 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12494 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12495 @cindex remote timeout
12496 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12497 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12498
12499 @item show remotetimeout
12500 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12501 responses.
12502
12503 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12504 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12505 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12506 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12507 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12508 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12509 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12510 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12511
12512 @item set remote fetch-register-packet
12513 @itemx set remote set-register-packet
12514 @itemx set remote P-packet
12515 @itemx set remote p-packet
12516 @cindex P-packet
12517 @cindex fetch registers from remote targets
12518 @cindex set registers in remote targets
12519 Determine whether @value{GDBN} can set and fetch registers from the
12520 remote target using the @samp{P} packets. The default depends on the
12521 remote stub's support of the @samp{P} packets (@value{GDBN} queries
12522 the stub when this packet is first required).
12523
12524 @item show remote fetch-register-packet
12525 @itemx show remote set-register-packet
12526 @itemx show remote P-packet
12527 @itemx show remote p-packet
12528 Show the current setting of using the @samp{P} packets for setting and
12529 fetching registers from the remote target.
12530
12531 @cindex binary downloads
12532 @cindex X-packet
12533 @item set remote binary-download-packet
12534 @itemx set remote X-packet
12535 Determine whether @value{GDBN} sends downloads in binary mode using
12536 the @samp{X} packets. The default is on.
12537
12538 @item show remote binary-download-packet
12539 @itemx show remote X-packet
12540 Show the current setting of using the @samp{X} packets for binary
12541 downloads.
12542
12543 @item set remote read-aux-vector-packet
12544 @cindex auxiliary vector of remote target
12545 @cindex @code{auxv}, and remote targets
12546 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{qPart:auxv:read} (target
12547 auxiliary vector read) request. This request is used to fetch the
12548 remote target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}, see @ref{OS Information,
12549 Auxiliary Vector}. The default setting depends on the remote stub's
12550 support of this request (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when this
12551 request is first required). @xref{General Query Packets, qPart}, for
12552 more information about this request.
12553
12554 @item show remote read-aux-vector-packet
12555 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{qPart:auxv:read} request.
12556
12557 @item set remote symbol-lookup-packet
12558 @cindex remote symbol lookup request
12559 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{qSymbol} (target symbol
12560 lookup) request. This request is used to communicate symbol
12561 information to the remote target, e.g., whenever a new shared library
12562 is loaded by the remote (@pxref{Files, shared libraries}). The
12563 default setting depends on the remote stub's support of this request
12564 (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when this request is first required).
12565 @xref{General Query Packets, qSymbol}, for more information about this
12566 request.
12567
12568 @item show remote symbol-lookup-packet
12569 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{qSymbol} request.
12570
12571 @item set remote verbose-resume-packet
12572 @cindex resume remote target
12573 @cindex signal thread, and remote targets
12574 @cindex single-step thread, and remote targets
12575 @cindex thread-specific operations on remote targets
12576 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{vCont} (descriptive resume)
12577 request. This request is used to resume specific threads in the
12578 remote target, and to single-step or signal them. The default setting
12579 depends on the remote stub's support of this request (@value{GDBN}
12580 queries the stub when this request is first required). This setting
12581 affects debugging of multithreaded programs: if @samp{vCont} cannot be
12582 used, @value{GDBN} might be unable to single-step a specific thread,
12583 especially under @code{set scheduler-locking off}; it is also
12584 impossible to pause a specific thread. @xref{Packets, vCont}, for
12585 more details.
12586
12587 @item show remote verbose-resume-packet
12588 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{vCont} request
12589
12590 @item set remote software-breakpoint-packet
12591 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-packet
12592 @itemx set remote write-watchpoint-packet
12593 @itemx set remote read-watchpoint-packet
12594 @itemx set remote access-watchpoint-packet
12595 @itemx set remote Z-packet
12596 @cindex Z-packet
12597 @cindex remote hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12598 These commands enable or disable the use of @samp{Z} packets for
12599 setting breakpoints and watchpoints in the remote target. The default
12600 depends on the remote stub's support of the @samp{Z} packets
12601 (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when each packet is first required).
12602 The command @code{set remote Z-packet}, kept for back-compatibility,
12603 turns on or off all the features that require the use of @samp{Z}
12604 packets.
12605
12606 @item show remote software-breakpoint-packet
12607 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-packet
12608 @itemx show remote write-watchpoint-packet
12609 @itemx show remote read-watchpoint-packet
12610 @itemx show remote access-watchpoint-packet
12611 @itemx show remote Z-packet
12612 Show the current setting of @samp{Z} packets usage.
12613
12614 @item set remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12615 @kindex set remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12616 @cindex thread local storage of remote targets
12617 This command enables or disables the use of the @samp{qGetTLSAddr}
12618 (Get Thread Local Storage Address) request packet. The default
12619 depends on whether the remote stub supports this request.
12620 @xref{General Query Packets, qGetTLSAddr}, for more details about this
12621 packet.
12622
12623 @item show remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12624 @kindex show remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12625 Show the current setting of @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet usage.
12626 @end table
12627
12628 @node remote stub
12629 @section Implementing a remote stub
12630
12631 @cindex debugging stub, example
12632 @cindex remote stub, example
12633 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12634 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12635 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12636 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12637 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12638 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12639 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12640 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12641
12642 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12643 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12644 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12645 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12646 program, you need:
12647
12648 @enumerate
12649 @item
12650 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12651 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12652 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12653
12654 @item
12655 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12656 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12657
12658 @item
12659 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12660 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12661 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12662 documentation.
12663 @end enumerate
12664
12665 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12666 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12667 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12668
12669 @table @emph
12670 @item On the host,
12671 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12672 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12673 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12674
12675 @item On the target,
12676 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12677 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12678 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
12679
12680 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
12681 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
12682 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
12683 @end table
12684
12685 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
12686 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
12687 @sc{sparc} boards.
12688
12689 @cindex remote serial stub list
12690 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
12691
12692 @table @code
12693
12694 @item i386-stub.c
12695 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
12696 @cindex Intel
12697 @cindex i386
12698 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
12699
12700 @item m68k-stub.c
12701 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
12702 @cindex Motorola 680x0
12703 @cindex m680x0
12704 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
12705
12706 @item sh-stub.c
12707 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
12708 @cindex Renesas
12709 @cindex SH
12710 For Renesas SH architectures.
12711
12712 @item sparc-stub.c
12713 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
12714 @cindex Sparc
12715 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
12716
12717 @item sparcl-stub.c
12718 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
12719 @cindex Fujitsu
12720 @cindex SparcLite
12721 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
12722
12723 @end table
12724
12725 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
12726 recently added stubs.
12727
12728 @menu
12729 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
12730 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
12731 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
12732 @end menu
12733
12734 @node Stub Contents
12735 @subsection What the stub can do for you
12736
12737 @cindex remote serial stub
12738 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
12739 subroutines:
12740
12741 @table @code
12742 @item set_debug_traps
12743 @findex set_debug_traps
12744 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
12745 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
12746 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
12747 beginning of your program.
12748
12749 @item handle_exception
12750 @findex handle_exception
12751 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
12752 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
12753 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
12754 run when a trap is triggered.
12755
12756 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
12757 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
12758 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
12759 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
12760 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
12761 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
12762 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
12763 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
12764 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
12765 machine.
12766
12767 @item breakpoint
12768 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
12769 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
12770 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
12771 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
12772 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
12773 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
12774 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
12775 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
12776 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
12777 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
12778 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
12779
12780 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
12781 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
12782 start of your debugging session.
12783 @end table
12784
12785 @node Bootstrapping
12786 @subsection What you must do for the stub
12787
12788 @cindex remote stub, support routines
12789 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
12790 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
12791 debugging target machine.
12792
12793 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
12794 serial port.
12795
12796 @table @code
12797 @item int getDebugChar()
12798 @findex getDebugChar
12799 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
12800 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
12801 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
12802
12803 @item void putDebugChar(int)
12804 @findex putDebugChar
12805 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
12806 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
12807 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
12808 @end table
12809
12810 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
12811 @cindex interrupting remote targets
12812 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
12813 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
12814 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
12815 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
12816 remote system to stop.
12817
12818 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
12819 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
12820 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
12821 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
12822
12823 Other routines you need to supply are:
12824
12825 @table @code
12826 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
12827 @findex exceptionHandler
12828 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
12829 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
12830 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
12831 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
12832 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
12833 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
12834 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
12835 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
12836 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
12837 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
12838 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
12839 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
12840 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
12841
12842 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
12843 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
12844 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
12845 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
12846 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
12847
12848 @item void flush_i_cache()
12849 @findex flush_i_cache
12850 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
12851 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
12852 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
12853
12854 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
12855 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
12856 @end table
12857
12858 @noindent
12859 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
12860
12861 @table @code
12862 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
12863 @findex memset
12864 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
12865 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
12866 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
12867 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
12868 @end table
12869
12870 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
12871 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
12872 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
12873 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
12874
12875
12876 @node Debug Session
12877 @subsection Putting it all together
12878
12879 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
12880 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
12881 steps.
12882
12883 @enumerate
12884 @item
12885 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
12886 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
12887 @display
12888 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
12889 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
12890 @end display
12891
12892 @item
12893 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
12894
12895 @smallexample
12896 set_debug_traps();
12897 breakpoint();
12898 @end smallexample
12899
12900 @item
12901 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
12902 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
12903
12904 @smallexample
12905 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
12906 @end smallexample
12907
12908 @noindent
12909 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
12910 function in your program, that function is called when
12911 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
12912 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
12913 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
12914
12915 @item
12916 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
12917 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
12918
12919 @item
12920 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
12921 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
12922
12923 @item
12924 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
12925 @c document that. FIXME.
12926 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
12927 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
12928
12929 @item
12930 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
12931 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12932
12933 @end enumerate
12934
12935 @node Configurations
12936 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
12937
12938 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
12939 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
12940 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
12941
12942 There are three major categories of configurations: native
12943 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
12944 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
12945 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
12946 are quite different from each other.
12947
12948 @menu
12949 * Native::
12950 * Embedded OS::
12951 * Embedded Processors::
12952 * Architectures::
12953 @end menu
12954
12955 @node Native
12956 @section Native
12957
12958 This section describes details specific to particular native
12959 configurations.
12960
12961 @menu
12962 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
12963 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
12964 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
12965 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
12966 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
12967 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
12968 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
12969 @end menu
12970
12971 @node HP-UX
12972 @subsection HP-UX
12973
12974 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
12975 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
12976 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
12977
12978
12979 @node BSD libkvm Interface
12980 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
12981
12982 @cindex libkvm
12983 @cindex kernel memory image
12984 @cindex kernel crash dump
12985
12986 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
12987 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
12988 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
12989 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
12990 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
12991 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
12992 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
12993 @code{kvm} target:
12994
12995 @smallexample
12996 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
12997 @end smallexample
12998
12999 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13000 argument:
13001
13002 @smallexample
13003 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13004 @end smallexample
13005
13006 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13007 available:
13008
13009 @table @code
13010 @kindex kvm
13011 @item kvm pcb
13012 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13013
13014 @item kvm proc
13015 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13016 modern FreeBSD systems.
13017 @end table
13018
13019 @node SVR4 Process Information
13020 @subsection SVR4 process information
13021 @cindex /proc
13022 @cindex examine process image
13023 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13024
13025 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13026 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13027 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13028 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13029 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13030 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13031 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13032 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13033 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13034
13035 @table @code
13036 @kindex info proc
13037 @cindex process ID
13038 @item info proc
13039 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13040 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13041 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13042 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13043 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13044 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13045 executable file's absolute file name.
13046
13047 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13048 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13049 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13050 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13051 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13052 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13053
13054 @item info proc mappings
13055 @cindex memory address space mappings
13056 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13057 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13058 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13059 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13060 memory access rights to that range.
13061
13062 @item info proc stat
13063 @itemx info proc status
13064 @cindex process detailed status information
13065 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13066 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13067 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13068 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13069 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13070 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13071 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13072
13073 @item info proc all
13074 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13075 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13076
13077 @ignore
13078 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13079 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13080 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13081 @kindex info proc times
13082 @item info proc times
13083 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13084 its children.
13085
13086 @kindex info proc id
13087 @item info proc id
13088 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13089 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13090 @end ignore
13091
13092 @item set procfs-trace
13093 @kindex set procfs-trace
13094 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13095 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13096
13097 @item show procfs-trace
13098 @kindex show procfs-trace
13099 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13100
13101 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13102 @kindex set procfs-file
13103 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13104 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13105 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13106 standard output.
13107
13108 @item show procfs-file
13109 @kindex show procfs-file
13110 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13111
13112 @item proc-trace-entry
13113 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13114 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13115 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13116 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13117 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13118 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13119 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13120 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13121 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13122
13123 @item info pidlist
13124 @kindex info pidlist
13125 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13126 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13127 processes and all the threads within each process.
13128
13129 @item info meminfo
13130 @kindex info meminfo
13131 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13132 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13133 @end table
13134
13135 @node DJGPP Native
13136 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13137 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13138 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13139 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13140
13141 @cindex DPMI
13142 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13143 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13144 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13145 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13146
13147 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13148 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13149 subsection describes those commands.
13150
13151 @table @code
13152 @kindex info dos
13153 @item info dos
13154 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13155 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13156
13157 @kindex sysinfo
13158 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13159 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13160 @item info dos sysinfo
13161 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13162 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13163 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13164
13165 @cindex GDT
13166 @cindex LDT
13167 @cindex IDT
13168 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13169 @cindex descriptor tables display
13170 @item info dos gdt
13171 @itemx info dos ldt
13172 @itemx info dos idt
13173 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13174 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13175 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13176 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13177 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13178 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13179 rights.
13180
13181 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13182 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13183 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13184 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13185 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13186
13187 @cindex garbled pointers
13188 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13189 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13190 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13191 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13192 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13193 debugged program's data segment:
13194
13195 @smallexample
13196 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13197 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13198 @end smallexample
13199
13200 @noindent
13201 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13202 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13203
13204 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13205 @item info dos pde
13206 @itemx info dos pte
13207 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13208 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13209 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13210 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13211 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13212 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13213 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13214 that is currently in use.
13215
13216 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13217 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13218 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13219 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13220 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13221 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13222 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13223
13224 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13225 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13226 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13227 controller.
13228
13229 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13230
13231 @cindex physical address from linear address
13232 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13233 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13234 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13235 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13236 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13237 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13238 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13239
13240 @smallexample
13241 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13242 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13243 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13244 @end smallexample
13245
13246 @noindent
13247 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13248 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13249 attributes of that page.
13250
13251 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13252 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13253 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13254 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13255 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13256 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13257
13258 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13259 transfer buffer:
13260
13261 @smallexample
13262 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13263 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13264 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13265 @end smallexample
13266
13267 @noindent
13268 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13269 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13270 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13271 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13272 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13273
13274 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13275 @end table
13276
13277 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13278 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13279 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13280 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13281
13282 @table @code
13283 @kindex set com1base
13284 @kindex set com1irq
13285 @kindex set com2base
13286 @kindex set com2irq
13287 @kindex set com3base
13288 @kindex set com3irq
13289 @kindex set com4base
13290 @kindex set com4irq
13291 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13292 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13293 port.
13294
13295 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13296 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13297 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13298
13299 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13300 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13301 other 3 COM ports.
13302
13303 @kindex show com1base
13304 @kindex show com1irq
13305 @kindex show com2base
13306 @kindex show com2irq
13307 @kindex show com3base
13308 @kindex show com3irq
13309 @kindex show com4base
13310 @kindex show com4irq
13311 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13312 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13313 lines used by the COM ports.
13314
13315 @item info serial
13316 @kindex info serial
13317 @cindex DOS serial port status
13318 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13319 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13320 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13321 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13322 @end table
13323
13324
13325 @node Cygwin Native
13326 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
13327 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13328 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13329 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13330
13331 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13332 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13333 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
13334 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
13335 that have no debugging symbols.
13336
13337
13338 @table @code
13339 @kindex info w32
13340 @item info w32
13341 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
13342 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13343
13344 @item info w32 selector
13345 This command displays information returned by
13346 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13347 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13348 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13349 Without argument, this command displays information
13350 about the the six segment registers.
13351
13352 @kindex info dll
13353 @item info dll
13354 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
13355
13356 @kindex dll-symbols
13357 @item dll-symbols
13358 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13359 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13360
13361 @kindex set new-console
13362 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13363 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13364 be started in a new console on next start.
13365 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13366 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13367
13368 @kindex show new-console
13369 @item show new-console
13370 Displays whether a new console is used
13371 when the debuggee is started.
13372
13373 @kindex set new-group
13374 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13375 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13376 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13377 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13378 Ctrl-C.
13379
13380 @kindex show new-group
13381 @item show new-group
13382 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13383
13384 @kindex set debugevents
13385 @item set debugevents
13386 This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
13387
13388 @kindex set debugexec
13389 @item set debugexec
13390 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13391 seen by the debugger.
13392
13393 @kindex set debugexceptions
13394 @item set debugexceptions
13395 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
13396 seen by the debugger.
13397
13398 @kindex set debugmemory
13399 @item set debugmemory
13400 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
13401 seen by the debugger.
13402
13403 @kindex set shell
13404 @item set shell
13405 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13406 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13407
13408 @kindex show shell
13409 @item show shell
13410 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13411
13412 @end table
13413
13414 @menu
13415 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13416 @end menu
13417
13418 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
13419 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13420 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13421 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13422
13423 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13424 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13425 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13426 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13427 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
13428 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13429 ``minimal symbols''.
13430
13431 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13432 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13433 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13434 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13435 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13436 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
13437 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13438 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13439 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13440 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13441
13442 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
13443
13444 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13445 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13446 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13447 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13448 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13449 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13450 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13451 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13452 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13453
13454 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13455 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13456 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13457 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13458 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
13459 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13460
13461 @smallexample
13462 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13463 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13464
13465 Non-debugging symbols:
13466 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13467 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13468 @end smallexample
13469
13470 @smallexample
13471 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13472 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13473
13474 Non-debugging symbols:
13475 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13476 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13477 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13478 [etc...]
13479 @end smallexample
13480
13481 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
13482
13483 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13484 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13485 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13486 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13487 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13488 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13489 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13490
13491 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13492 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13493 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13494 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13495 problem:
13496
13497 @smallexample
13498 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13499 $1 = 268572168
13500 @end smallexample
13501
13502 @smallexample
13503 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13504 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13505 @end smallexample
13506
13507 And two possible solutions:
13508
13509 @smallexample
13510 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13511 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13512 @end smallexample
13513
13514 @smallexample
13515 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13516 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13517 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13518 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13519 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13520 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13521 @end smallexample
13522
13523 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13524 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13525 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13526 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13527 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13528
13529 @smallexample
13530 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13531 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13532 @end smallexample
13533
13534 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13535 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13536 safe.
13537
13538 @node Hurd Native
13539 @subsection Commands specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd systems
13540 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13541
13542 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13543 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13544
13545 @table @code
13546 @item set signals
13547 @itemx set sigs
13548 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13549 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13550 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13551 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13552 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13553 @code{signals}.
13554
13555 @item show signals
13556 @itemx show sigs
13557 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13558 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13559 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13560
13561 @item set signal-thread
13562 @itemx set sigthread
13563 @kindex set signal-thread
13564 @kindex set sigthread
13565 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13566 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13567 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13568 signal-thread}.
13569
13570 @item show signal-thread
13571 @itemx show sigthread
13572 @kindex show signal-thread
13573 @kindex show sigthread
13574 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13575 delivered a signal.
13576
13577 @item set stopped
13578 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13579 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13580 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13581 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13582
13583 @item show stopped
13584 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13585 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13586 stopped.
13587
13588 @item set exceptions
13589 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13590 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13591 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13592 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13593 trapping on.
13594
13595 @item show exceptions
13596 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13597 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13598
13599 @item set task pause
13600 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13601 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13602 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13603 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13604 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13605 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13606 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13607 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13608 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13609
13610 @item show task pause
13611 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13612 Show the current state of task suspension.
13613
13614 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13615 @cindex task suspend count
13616 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13617 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13618 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13619
13620 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13621 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13622
13623 @item set task exception-port
13624 @itemx set task excp
13625 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13626 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13627 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13628 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13629
13630 @item set noninvasive
13631 @cindex noninvasive task options
13632 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13633 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13634 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13635 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13636
13637 @item info send-rights
13638 @itemx info receive-rights
13639 @itemx info port-rights
13640 @itemx info port-sets
13641 @itemx info dead-names
13642 @itemx info ports
13643 @itemx info psets
13644 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13645 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13646 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13647 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13648 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13649 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13650 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13651 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13652 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13653
13654 @item set thread pause
13655 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13656 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13657 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13658 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
13659 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
13660 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
13661 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
13662 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
13663 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
13664 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
13665 only the current thread.
13666
13667 @item show thread pause
13668 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
13669 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
13670
13671 @item set thread run
13672 This comamnd sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13673
13674 @item show thread run
13675 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13676
13677 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
13678 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13679 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13680 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
13681 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
13682 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
13683 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
13684
13685 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
13686 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
13687 detaching.
13688
13689 @item set thread exception-port
13690 @itemx set thread excp
13691 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
13692 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
13693 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
13694
13695 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
13696 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
13697 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
13698 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
13699
13700 @item set thread default
13701 @itemx show thread default
13702 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13703 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
13704 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
13705 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
13706 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
13707 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
13708 the non-default commands.
13709 @end table
13710
13711
13712 @node Neutrino
13713 @subsection QNX Neutrino
13714 @cindex QNX Neutrino
13715
13716 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
13717 Neutrino target:
13718
13719 @table @code
13720 @item set debug nto-debug
13721 @kindex set debug nto-debug
13722 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
13723 Neutrino support.
13724
13725 @item show debug nto-debug
13726 @kindex show debug nto-debug
13727 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
13728 @end table
13729
13730
13731 @node Embedded OS
13732 @section Embedded Operating Systems
13733
13734 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
13735 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
13736 architectures.
13737
13738 @menu
13739 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13740 @end menu
13741
13742 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
13743 various real-time operating systems.
13744
13745 @node VxWorks
13746 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13747
13748 @cindex VxWorks
13749
13750 @table @code
13751
13752 @kindex target vxworks
13753 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
13754 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
13755 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
13756
13757 @end table
13758
13759 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
13760 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
13761
13762 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
13763 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
13764 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
13765 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
13766 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
13767 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
13768 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
13769
13770 @table @code
13771 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
13772 @kindex vxworks-timeout
13773 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
13774 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
13775 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
13776 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
13777 of a thin network line.
13778 @end table
13779
13780 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
13781 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
13782 procedures.
13783
13784 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
13785 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
13786 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
13787 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
13788 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
13789 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
13790 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
13791 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
13792 manual.
13793 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
13794
13795 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
13796 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
13797 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
13798 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
13799
13800 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
13801
13802 @smallexample
13803 (vxgdb)
13804 @end smallexample
13805
13806 @menu
13807 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
13808 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
13809 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
13810 @end menu
13811
13812 @node VxWorks Connection
13813 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
13814
13815 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
13816 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
13817
13818 @smallexample
13819 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
13820 @end smallexample
13821
13822 @need 750
13823 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
13824
13825 @smallexample
13826 Attaching remote machine across net...
13827 Connected to tt.
13828 @end smallexample
13829
13830 @need 1000
13831 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
13832 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
13833 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
13834 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
13835 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
13836
13837 @smallexample
13838 prog.o: No such file or directory.
13839 @end smallexample
13840
13841 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
13842 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
13843 command again.
13844
13845 @node VxWorks Download
13846 @subsubsection VxWorks download
13847
13848 @cindex download to VxWorks
13849 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
13850 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
13851 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
13852 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
13853 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
13854 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
13855 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
13856 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
13857 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
13858 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
13859 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
13860 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
13861 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
13862 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
13863 program, type this on VxWorks:
13864
13865 @smallexample
13866 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
13867 @end smallexample
13868
13869 @noindent
13870 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
13871
13872 @smallexample
13873 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
13874 (vxgdb) load prog.o
13875 @end smallexample
13876
13877 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
13878
13879 @smallexample
13880 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
13881 @end smallexample
13882
13883 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
13884 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
13885 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
13886 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
13887 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
13888 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
13889 table.)
13890
13891 @node VxWorks Attach
13892 @subsubsection Running tasks
13893
13894 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
13895 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
13896 follows:
13897
13898 @smallexample
13899 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
13900 @end smallexample
13901
13902 @noindent
13903 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
13904 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
13905 the time of attachment.
13906
13907 @node Embedded Processors
13908 @section Embedded Processors
13909
13910 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
13911 configurations.
13912
13913 @cindex send command to simulator
13914 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
13915 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
13916
13917 @table @code
13918 @item sim @var{command}
13919 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
13920 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
13921 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
13922 acceptable commands.
13923 @end table
13924
13925
13926 @menu
13927 * ARM:: ARM RDI
13928 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
13929 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
13930 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
13931 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
13932 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
13933 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
13934 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
13935 * PowerPC: PowerPC
13936 * SH:: Renesas SH
13937 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
13938 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
13939 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
13940 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
13941 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
13942 * CRIS:: CRIS
13943 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
13944 * WinCE:: Windows CE child processes
13945 @end menu
13946
13947 @node ARM
13948 @subsection ARM
13949 @cindex ARM RDI
13950
13951 @table @code
13952 @kindex target rdi
13953 @item target rdi @var{dev}
13954 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
13955 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
13956 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
13957
13958 @kindex target rdp
13959 @item target rdp @var{dev}
13960 ARM Demon monitor.
13961
13962 @end table
13963
13964 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
13965
13966 @table @code
13967 @item set arm disassembler
13968 @kindex set arm
13969 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
13970 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
13971
13972 @item show arm disassembler
13973 @kindex show arm
13974 Show the current disassembly style.
13975
13976 @item set arm apcs32
13977 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
13978 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
13979
13980 @item show arm apcs32
13981 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
13982
13983 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
13984 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
13985 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
13986
13987 @table @code
13988 @item auto
13989 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
13990 @item softfpa
13991 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
13992 processors.
13993 @item fpa
13994 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
13995 @item softvfp
13996 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
13997 @item vfp
13998 VFP co-processor.
13999 @end table
14000
14001 @item show arm fpu
14002 Show the current type of the FPU.
14003
14004 @item set arm abi
14005 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14006
14007 @item show arm abi
14008 Show the currently used ABI.
14009
14010 @item set debug arm
14011 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14012 target support subsystem.
14013
14014 @item show debug arm
14015 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14016 @end table
14017
14018 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14019 using the RDI interface:
14020
14021 @table @code
14022 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14023 @kindex rdilogfile
14024 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14025 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14026 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14027 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14028 @file{rdi.log}.
14029
14030 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14031 @kindex rdilogenable
14032 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14033 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14034 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14035 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14036 are logged to a file.
14037
14038 @item set rdiromatzero
14039 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14040 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14041 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14042 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14043 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14044 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14045
14046 @item show rdiromatzero
14047 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14048 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14049
14050 @item set rdiheartbeat
14051 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14052 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14053 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14054 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14055 well as the Angel monitor.
14056
14057 @item show rdiheartbeat
14058 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14059 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14060 @end table
14061
14062
14063 @node H8/300
14064 @subsection Renesas H8/300
14065
14066 @table @code
14067
14068 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
14069 @item target hms @var{dev}
14070 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
14071 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
14072 line and the communications speed used.
14073
14074 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
14075 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14076 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
14077
14078 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
14079 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
14080 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14081 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
14082 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14083
14084 @end table
14085
14086 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
14087 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
14088 @cindex download to Renesas SH
14089 @cindex Renesas SH download
14090 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
14091 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
14092 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
14093 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
14094
14095 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
14096 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
14097
14098 @enumerate
14099 @item
14100 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
14101 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
14102 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
14103 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
14104 H8/300, or H8/500.)
14105
14106 @item
14107 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
14108 serial device available on your host is the default).
14109
14110 @item
14111 what speed to use over the serial device.
14112 @end enumerate
14113
14114 @menu
14115 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
14116 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
14117 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
14118 @end menu
14119
14120 @node Renesas Boards
14121 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
14122
14123 @c only for Unix hosts
14124 @kindex device
14125 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
14126 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
14127 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
14128 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
14129 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
14130
14131 @kindex speed
14132 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
14133 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
14134 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
14135 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
14136 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
14137 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
14138
14139 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
14140 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
14141 use a DOS host,
14142 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
14143 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
14144 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
14145 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
14146
14147 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
14148 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
14149 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
14150 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
14151
14152 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
14153 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
14154 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
14155 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
14156 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
14157 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
14158 @code{COM2}.
14159
14160 @smallexample
14161 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
14162 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
14163
14164 Resident portion of MODE loaded
14165
14166 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
14167
14168 @end smallexample
14169
14170 @quotation
14171 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
14172 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
14173 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
14174 your development board.
14175 @end quotation
14176
14177 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
14178 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
14179 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBN}} with
14180 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
14181 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
14182 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
14183 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
14184 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
14185 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
14186 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
14187 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
14188 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
14189 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
14190
14191 @smallexample
14192 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
14193 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
14194 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
14195 the conditions.
14196 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
14197 for details.
14198 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
14199 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
14200 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
14201 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
14202 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
14203 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
14204 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
14205 @end smallexample
14206
14207 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
14208 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
14209 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
14210 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
14211 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
14212 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
14213
14214 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
14215 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
14216 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
14217
14218 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
14219 @itemize @bullet
14220 @item
14221 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
14222 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
14223
14224 @item
14225 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
14226 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
14227 to detect program completion.
14228 @end itemize
14229
14230 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
14231 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
14232
14233 @node Renesas ICE
14234 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
14235
14236 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
14237 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
14238 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
14239 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
14240
14241 @table @code
14242 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
14243 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
14244 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
14245 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
14246 (for example, @samp{9600}).
14247
14248 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
14249 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
14250 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
14251 @end table
14252
14253 The following special commands are available when debugging with the
14254 Renesas E7000 ICE:
14255
14256 @table @code
14257 @item e7000 @var{command}
14258 @kindex e7000
14259 @cindex send command to E7000 monitor
14260 This sends the specified @var{command} to the E7000 monitor.
14261
14262 @item ftplogin @var{machine} @var{username} @var{password} @var{dir}
14263 @kindex ftplogin@r{, E7000}
14264 This command records information for subsequent interface with the
14265 E7000 monitor via the FTP protocol: @value{GDBN} will log into the
14266 named @var{machine} using specified @var{username} and @var{password},
14267 and then chdir to the named directory @var{dir}.
14268
14269 @item ftpload @var{file}
14270 @kindex ftpload@r{, E7000}
14271 This command uses credentials recorded by @code{ftplogin} to fetch and
14272 load the named @var{file} from the E7000 monitor.
14273
14274 @item drain
14275 @kindex drain@r{, E7000}
14276 This command drains any pending text buffers stored on the E7000.
14277
14278 @item set usehardbreakpoints
14279 @itemx show usehardbreakpoints
14280 @kindex set usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14281 @kindex show usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14282 @cindex hardware breakpoints, and E7000
14283 These commands set and show the use of hardware breakpoints for all
14284 breakpoints. @xref{Set Breaks, hardware-assisted breakpoint}, for
14285 more information about using hardware breakpoints selectively.
14286 @end table
14287
14288 @node Renesas Special
14289 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
14290
14291 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
14292
14293 @table @code
14294
14295 @kindex set machine
14296 @kindex show machine
14297 @item set machine h8300
14298 @itemx set machine h8300h
14299 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
14300 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
14301 to check which variant is currently in effect.
14302
14303 @end table
14304
14305 @node H8/500
14306 @subsection H8/500
14307
14308 @table @code
14309
14310 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
14311 @cindex memory models, H8/500
14312 @item set memory @var{mod}
14313 @itemx show memory
14314 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
14315 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
14316 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
14317 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
14318
14319 @end table
14320
14321 @node M32R/D
14322 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14323
14324 @table @code
14325 @kindex target m32r
14326 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14327 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14328
14329 @kindex target m32rsdi
14330 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14331 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14332 @end table
14333
14334 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14335
14336 @table @code
14337 @item set download-path @var{path}
14338 @kindex set download-path
14339 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14340 Set the default path for finding donwloadable @sc{srec} files.
14341
14342 @item show download-path
14343 @kindex show download-path
14344 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14345
14346 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14347 @kindex set board-address
14348 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14349 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14350
14351 @item show board-address
14352 @kindex show board-address
14353 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14354
14355 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14356 @kindex set server-address
14357 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14358 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14359 host machine.
14360
14361 @item show server-address
14362 @kindex show server-address
14363 Display the IP address of the download server.
14364
14365 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14366 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14367 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14368 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14369 executable file is uploaded.
14370
14371 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14372 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14373 Test the @code{upload} command.
14374 @end table
14375
14376 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14377
14378 @table @code
14379 @item sdireset
14380 @kindex sdireset
14381 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14382 This command resets the SDI connection.
14383
14384 @item sdistatus
14385 @kindex sdistatus
14386 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14387
14388 @item debug_chaos
14389 @kindex debug_chaos
14390 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14391 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14392
14393 @item use_debug_dma
14394 @kindex use_debug_dma
14395 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14396
14397 @item use_mon_code
14398 @kindex use_mon_code
14399 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14400
14401 @item use_ib_break
14402 @kindex use_ib_break
14403 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14404
14405 @item use_dbt_break
14406 @kindex use_dbt_break
14407 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14408 @end table
14409
14410 @node M68K
14411 @subsection M68k
14412
14413 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
14414 target command for the following ROM monitors.
14415
14416 @table @code
14417
14418 @kindex target abug
14419 @item target abug @var{dev}
14420 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
14421
14422 @kindex target cpu32bug
14423 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
14424 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14425
14426 @kindex target dbug
14427 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14428 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14429
14430 @kindex target est
14431 @item target est @var{dev}
14432 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14433
14434 @kindex target rom68k
14435 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
14436 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
14437
14438 @end table
14439
14440 @table @code
14441
14442 @kindex target rombug
14443 @item target rombug @var{dev}
14444 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
14445
14446 @end table
14447
14448 @node MIPS Embedded
14449 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14450
14451 @cindex MIPS boards
14452 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14453 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14454 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14455
14456 @need 1000
14457 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14458
14459 @table @code
14460 @item target mips @var{port}
14461 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14462 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14463 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14464 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14465 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14466 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14467 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14468
14469 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14470 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14471 debugger:
14472
14473 @smallexample
14474 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14475 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14476 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14477 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14478 (@value{GDBP}) run
14479 @end smallexample
14480
14481 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14482 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14483 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14484 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14485 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14486
14487 @item target pmon @var{port}
14488 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14489 PMON ROM monitor.
14490
14491 @item target ddb @var{port}
14492 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14493 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14494
14495 @item target lsi @var{port}
14496 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14497 LSI variant of PMON.
14498
14499 @kindex target r3900
14500 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14501 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14502
14503 @kindex target array
14504 @item target array @var{dev}
14505 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14506
14507 @end table
14508
14509
14510 @noindent
14511 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14512
14513 @table @code
14514 @item set mipsfpu double
14515 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14516 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14517 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14518 @itemx show mipsfpu
14519 @kindex set mipsfpu
14520 @kindex show mipsfpu
14521 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14522 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14523 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14524 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14525 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14526 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14527 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14528 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14529 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14530 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14531 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14532 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14533 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14534
14535 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14536 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14537 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14538
14539 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14540 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14541
14542 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14543 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14544 @itemx show timeout
14545 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14546 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14547 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14548 @kindex set timeout
14549 @kindex show timeout
14550 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14551 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14552 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14553 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14554 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14555 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14556 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14557 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14558 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14559 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14560
14561 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14562 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14563 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14564 to run before stopping.
14565
14566 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14567 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14568 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14569 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14570 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14571 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14572
14573 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14574 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14575 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14576 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14577
14578 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14579 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14580 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14581 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14582 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14583 @table @asis
14584 @item pmon target
14585 @samp{PMON}
14586 @item ddb target
14587 @samp{NEC010}
14588 @item lsi target
14589 @samp{PMON>}
14590 @end table
14591
14592 @item show monitor-prompt
14593 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14594 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14595 remote monitor.
14596
14597 @item set monitor-warnings
14598 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14599 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14600 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14601 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14602 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14603
14604 @item show monitor-warnings
14605 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14606 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14607
14608 @item pmon @var{command}
14609 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14610 @cindex send PMON command
14611 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14612 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14613 @end table
14614
14615 @node OpenRISC 1000
14616 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14617 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14618
14619 @cindex or1k boards
14620 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14621 about platform and commands.
14622
14623 @table @code
14624
14625 @kindex target jtag
14626 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14627
14628 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14629 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14630 connected via parallel port to the board.
14631
14632 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14633
14634 @kindex or1ksim
14635 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14636 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14637 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14638
14639 @kindex info or1k spr
14640 @item info or1k spr
14641 Displays spr groups.
14642
14643 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14644 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14645 Displays register names in selected group.
14646
14647 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14648 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14649 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14650 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14651 Shows information about specified spr register.
14652
14653 @kindex spr
14654 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14655 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14656 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14657 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14658 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14659 @end table
14660
14661 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14662 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14663 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14664 triggers can be set using:
14665 @table @code
14666 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14667 Load effective address/data
14668 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14669 Store effective address/data
14670 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14671 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14672 @item $FETCH
14673 Fetch data
14674 @end table
14675
14676 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14677 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14678
14679 @code{htrace} commands:
14680 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14681 @table @code
14682 @kindex hwatch
14683 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14684 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
14685 or Data. For example:
14686
14687 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14688
14689 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14690
14691 @kindex htrace
14692 @item htrace info
14693 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14694
14695 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14696 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14697
14698 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14699 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14700
14701 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14702 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14703
14704 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14705 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14706 triggered.
14707
14708 @item htrace enable
14709 @itemx htrace disable
14710 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14711
14712 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14713 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14714
14715 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14716 will be written there.
14717
14718 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14719 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14720
14721 @item htrace mode continuous
14722 Set continuous trace mode.
14723
14724 @item htrace mode suspend
14725 Set suspend trace mode.
14726
14727 @end table
14728
14729 @node PowerPC
14730 @subsection PowerPC
14731
14732 @table @code
14733 @kindex target dink32
14734 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
14735 DINK32 ROM monitor.
14736
14737 @kindex target ppcbug
14738 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
14739 @kindex target ppcbug1
14740 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
14741 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
14742
14743 @kindex target sds
14744 @item target sds @var{dev}
14745 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
14746 @end table
14747
14748 @cindex SDS protocol
14749 The following commands specifi to the SDS protocol are supported
14750 by@value{GDBN}:
14751
14752 @table @code
14753 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
14754 @kindex set sdstimeout
14755 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
14756 default is 2 seconds.
14757
14758 @item show sdstimeout
14759 @kindex show sdstimeout
14760 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
14761
14762 @item sds @var{command}
14763 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
14764 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
14765 @end table
14766
14767
14768 @node PA
14769 @subsection HP PA Embedded
14770
14771 @table @code
14772
14773 @kindex target op50n
14774 @item target op50n @var{dev}
14775 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
14776
14777 @kindex target w89k
14778 @item target w89k @var{dev}
14779 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
14780
14781 @end table
14782
14783 @node SH
14784 @subsection Renesas SH
14785
14786 @table @code
14787
14788 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
14789 @item target hms @var{dev}
14790 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
14791 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
14792 the communications speed used.
14793
14794 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
14795 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14796 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
14797
14798 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
14799 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
14800 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14801 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
14802 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14803
14804 @end table
14805
14806 @node Sparclet
14807 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
14808
14809 @cindex Sparclet
14810
14811 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
14812 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
14813 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14814 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
14815 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
14816
14817 @table @code
14818 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
14819 @kindex remotetimeout
14820 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
14821 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14822 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
14823 @end table
14824
14825 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
14826 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
14827 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
14828 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
14829 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
14830
14831 @smallexample
14832 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
14833 @end smallexample
14834
14835 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
14836
14837 @smallexample
14838 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
14839 @end smallexample
14840
14841 @cindex running, on Sparclet
14842 Once you have set
14843 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14844 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
14845 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
14846
14847 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14848
14849 @smallexample
14850 (gdbslet)
14851 @end smallexample
14852
14853 @menu
14854 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
14855 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
14856 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
14857 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
14858 @end menu
14859
14860 @node Sparclet File
14861 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
14862
14863 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
14864
14865 @smallexample
14866 (gdbslet) file prog
14867 @end smallexample
14868
14869 @need 1000
14870 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
14871 @value{GDBN} locates
14872 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
14873 path.
14874 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
14875 files will be searched as well.
14876 @value{GDBN} locates
14877 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
14878 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
14879 If it fails
14880 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
14881
14882 @smallexample
14883 prog: No such file or directory.
14884 @end smallexample
14885
14886 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
14887 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
14888 @code{target} command again.
14889
14890 @node Sparclet Connection
14891 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
14892
14893 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
14894 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
14895
14896 @smallexample
14897 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
14898 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
14899 main () at ../prog.c:3
14900 @end smallexample
14901
14902 @need 750
14903 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14904
14905 @smallexample
14906 Connected to ttya.
14907 @end smallexample
14908
14909 @node Sparclet Download
14910 @subsubsection Sparclet download
14911
14912 @cindex download to Sparclet
14913 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
14914 you can use the @value{GDBN}
14915 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
14916 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
14917 command.
14918 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
14919 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
14920 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
14921 of each of the file's sections.
14922 For instance, if the program
14923 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
14924 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14925
14926 @smallexample
14927 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
14928 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
14929 @end smallexample
14930
14931 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
14932 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
14933 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
14934
14935 @node Sparclet Execution
14936 @subsubsection Running and debugging
14937
14938 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
14939 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
14940 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
14941 manual for the list of commands.
14942
14943 @smallexample
14944 (gdbslet) b main
14945 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
14946 (gdbslet) run
14947 Starting program: prog
14948 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
14949 3 char *symarg = 0;
14950 (gdbslet) step
14951 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
14952 (gdbslet)
14953 @end smallexample
14954
14955 @node Sparclite
14956 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
14957
14958 @table @code
14959
14960 @kindex target sparclite
14961 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
14962 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
14963 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
14964 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
14965 remote protocol.
14966
14967 @end table
14968
14969 @node ST2000
14970 @subsection Tandem ST2000
14971
14972 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
14973 STDBUG protocol.
14974
14975 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
14976 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
14977
14978 @smallexample
14979 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
14980 @end smallexample
14981
14982 @noindent
14983 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
14984 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
14985 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
14986 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
14987 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14988
14989 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
14990 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
14991 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
14992 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
14993 available on your host computer.
14994 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
14995 @c basically hearsay.
14996
14997 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
14998 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
14999 environment:
15000
15001 @table @code
15002 @item st2000 @var{command}
15003 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
15004 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
15005 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
15006 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
15007 manual for available commands.
15008
15009 @item connect
15010 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
15011 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
15012 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
15013 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
15014 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
15015 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
15016 @end table
15017
15018 @node Z8000
15019 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15020
15021 @cindex Z8000
15022 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15023 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15024
15025 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15026 a Z8000 simulator.
15027
15028 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15029 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15030 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15031 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15032
15033 @table @code
15034 @item target sim @var{args}
15035 @kindex sim
15036 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15037 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15038 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15039 @end table
15040
15041 @noindent
15042 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15043 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15044 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15045 to run your program, and so on.
15046
15047 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15048 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15049 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15050
15051 @table @code
15052
15053 @item cycles
15054 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15055
15056 @item insts
15057 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15058
15059 @item time
15060 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15061
15062 @end table
15063
15064 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15065 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15066 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15067 simulated clock ticks.
15068
15069 @node AVR
15070 @subsection Atmel AVR
15071 @cindex AVR
15072
15073 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15074 following AVR-specific commands:
15075
15076 @table @code
15077 @item info io_registers
15078 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15079 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15080 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15081 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15082 @end table
15083
15084 @node CRIS
15085 @subsection CRIS
15086 @cindex CRIS
15087
15088 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15089 following CRIS-specific commands:
15090
15091 @table @code
15092 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15093 @cindex CRIS version
15094 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15095 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15096 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15097
15098 @item show cris-version
15099 Show the current CRIS version.
15100
15101 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15102 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15103 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15104 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15105 @code{R59}.
15106
15107 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15108 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15109
15110 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15111 @cindex CRIS mode
15112 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15113 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15114 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15115
15116 @item show cris-mode
15117 Show the current CRIS mode.
15118 @end table
15119
15120 @node Super-H
15121 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15122 @cindex Super-H
15123
15124 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15125 commands:
15126
15127 @table @code
15128 @item regs
15129 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15130 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15131 @end table
15132
15133 @node WinCE
15134 @subsection Windows CE
15135 @cindex Windows CE
15136
15137 The following commands are available for Windows CE:
15138
15139 @table @code
15140 @item set remotedirectory @var{dir}
15141 @kindex set remotedirectory
15142 Tell @value{GDBN} to upload files from the named directory @var{dir}.
15143 The default is @file{/gdb}, i.e.@: the root directory on the current
15144 drive.
15145
15146 @item show remotedirectory
15147 @kindex show remotedirectory
15148 Show the current value of the upload directory.
15149
15150 @item set remoteupload @var{method}
15151 @kindex set remoteupload
15152 Set the method used to upload files to remote device. Valid values
15153 for @var{method} are @samp{always}, @samp{newer}, and @samp{never}.
15154 The default is @samp{newer}.
15155
15156 @item show remoteupload
15157 @kindex show remoteupload
15158 Show the current setting of the upload method.
15159
15160 @item set remoteaddhost
15161 @kindex set remoteaddhost
15162 Tell @value{GDBN} whether to add this host to the remote stub's
15163 arguments when you debug over a network.
15164
15165 @item show remoteaddhost
15166 @kindex show remoteaddhost
15167 Show whether to add this host to remote stub's arguments when
15168 debugging over a network.
15169 @end table
15170
15171
15172 @node Architectures
15173 @section Architectures
15174
15175 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15176 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15177
15178 @menu
15179 * i386::
15180 * A29K::
15181 * Alpha::
15182 * MIPS::
15183 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15184 @end menu
15185
15186 @node i386
15187 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific issues.
15188
15189 @table @code
15190 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15191 @kindex set struct-convention
15192 @cindex struct return convention
15193 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15194 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15195 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15196 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15197 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15198 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15199 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15200 be returned in a register.
15201
15202 @item show struct-convention
15203 @kindex show struct-convention
15204 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15205 from functions.
15206 @end table
15207
15208 @node A29K
15209 @subsection A29K
15210
15211 @table @code
15212
15213 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15214 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15215 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15216 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15217 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15218 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15219 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15220 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15221 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15222 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15223 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15224 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15225 hexadecimal.
15226
15227 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15228 @item show rstack_high_address
15229 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15230 processors.
15231
15232 @end table
15233
15234 @node Alpha
15235 @subsection Alpha
15236
15237 See the following section.
15238
15239 @node MIPS
15240 @subsection MIPS
15241
15242 @cindex stack on Alpha
15243 @cindex stack on MIPS
15244 @cindex Alpha stack
15245 @cindex MIPS stack
15246 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15247 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15248 find the beginning of a function.
15249
15250 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15251 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15252 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15253 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15254 commands:
15255
15256 @table @code
15257 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15258 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15259 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15260 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15261 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15262 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15263 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15264 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15265
15266 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15267 Display the current limit.
15268 @end table
15269
15270 @noindent
15271 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15272 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15273
15274 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15275 programs:
15276
15277 @table @code
15278 @item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
15279 @kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
15280 @cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
15281 Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
15282 The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
15283
15284 @table @samp
15285 @item 32
15286 32-bit GP registers
15287 @item 64
15288 64-bit GP registers
15289 @item auto
15290 Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
15291 information contained in the executable. This is the default
15292 @end table
15293
15294 @item show mips saved-gpreg-size
15295 @kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
15296 Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
15297
15298 @item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
15299 @kindex set mips stack-arg-size
15300 @cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
15301 Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
15302 The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
15303 (the default).
15304
15305 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15306 @kindex set mips abi
15307 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15308 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15309 values of @var{arg} are:
15310
15311 @table @samp
15312 @item auto
15313 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15314 default).
15315 @item o32
15316 @item o64
15317 @item n32
15318 @item n64
15319 @item eabi32
15320 @item eabi64
15321 @item auto
15322 @end table
15323
15324 @item show mips abi
15325 @kindex show mips abi
15326 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15327
15328 @item set mipsfpu
15329 @itemx show mipsfpu
15330 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15331
15332 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15333 @kindex set mips mask-address
15334 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15335 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15336 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15337 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15338 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15339
15340 @item show mips mask-address
15341 @kindex show mips mask-address
15342 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15343 not.
15344
15345 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15346 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15347 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15348 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15349 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15350 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15351
15352 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15353 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15354 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15355
15356 @item set debug mips
15357 @kindex set debug mips
15358 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15359 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15360
15361 @item show debug mips
15362 @kindex show debug mips
15363 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15364 @end table
15365
15366
15367 @node HPPA
15368 @subsection HPPA
15369 @cindex HPPA support
15370
15371 When @value{GDBN} is debugging te HP PA architecture, it provides the
15372 following special commands:
15373
15374 @table @code
15375 @item set debug hppa
15376 @kindex set debug hppa
15377 THis command determines whether HPPA architecture specific debugging
15378 messages are to be displayed.
15379
15380 @item show debug hppa
15381 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15382
15383 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15384 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15385 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15386 given @var{address}.
15387
15388 @end table
15389
15390
15391 @node Controlling GDB
15392 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15393
15394 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15395 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15396 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
15397 described here.
15398
15399 @menu
15400 * Prompt:: Prompt
15401 * Editing:: Command editing
15402 * Command History:: Command history
15403 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15404 * Numbers:: Numbers
15405 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15406 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15407 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15408 @end menu
15409
15410 @node Prompt
15411 @section Prompt
15412
15413 @cindex prompt
15414
15415 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15416 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15417 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15418 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15419 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15420 which one you are talking to.
15421
15422 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15423 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15424 or a prompt that does not.
15425
15426 @table @code
15427 @kindex set prompt
15428 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15429 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15430
15431 @kindex show prompt
15432 @item show prompt
15433 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15434 @end table
15435
15436 @node Editing
15437 @section Command editing
15438 @cindex readline
15439 @cindex command line editing
15440
15441 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15442 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15443 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15444 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15445 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15446 debugging sessions.
15447
15448 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15449 command @code{set}.
15450
15451 @table @code
15452 @kindex set editing
15453 @cindex editing
15454 @item set editing
15455 @itemx set editing on
15456 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15457
15458 @item set editing off
15459 Disable command line editing.
15460
15461 @kindex show editing
15462 @item show editing
15463 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15464 @end table
15465
15466 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15467 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15468 encouraged to read that chapter.
15469
15470 @node Command History
15471 @section Command history
15472 @cindex command history
15473
15474 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15475 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15476 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15477 history facility.
15478
15479 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15480 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15481 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15482
15483 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15484 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15485 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15486 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15487 pressed on a line by itself.
15488
15489 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15490 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15491 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15492 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15493
15494 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15495 history.
15496
15497 @table @code
15498 @cindex history substitution
15499 @cindex history file
15500 @kindex set history filename
15501 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15502 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15503 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15504 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15505 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15506 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15507 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15508 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15509 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15510 is not set.
15511
15512 @cindex save command history
15513 @kindex set history save
15514 @item set history save
15515 @itemx set history save on
15516 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15517 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15518
15519 @item set history save off
15520 Stop recording command history in a file.
15521
15522 @cindex history size
15523 @kindex set history size
15524 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15525 @item set history size @var{size}
15526 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15527 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15528 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15529 @end table
15530
15531 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15532 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15533
15534 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15535 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15536 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15537 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15538 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15539 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15540 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15541 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15542
15543 The commands to control history expansion are:
15544
15545 @table @code
15546 @item set history expansion on
15547 @itemx set history expansion
15548 @kindex set history expansion
15549 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15550
15551 @item set history expansion off
15552 Disable history expansion.
15553
15554 @c @group
15555 @kindex show history
15556 @item show history
15557 @itemx show history filename
15558 @itemx show history save
15559 @itemx show history size
15560 @itemx show history expansion
15561 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15562 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15563 @c @end group
15564 @end table
15565
15566 @table @code
15567 @kindex show commands
15568 @cindex show last commands
15569 @cindex display command history
15570 @item show commands
15571 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15572
15573 @item show commands @var{n}
15574 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15575
15576 @item show commands +
15577 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15578 @end table
15579
15580 @node Screen Size
15581 @section Screen size
15582 @cindex size of screen
15583 @cindex pauses in output
15584
15585 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15586 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15587 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15588 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15589 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15590 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15591 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15592 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15593
15594 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15595 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15596 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15597 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15598 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15599 width} commands:
15600
15601 @table @code
15602 @kindex set height
15603 @kindex set width
15604 @kindex show width
15605 @kindex show height
15606 @item set height @var{lpp}
15607 @itemx show height
15608 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15609 @itemx show width
15610 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15611 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15612 commands display the current settings.
15613
15614 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15615 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15616 file or to an editor buffer.
15617
15618 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15619 from wrapping its output.
15620
15621 @item set pagination on
15622 @itemx set pagination off
15623 @kindex set pagination
15624 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15625 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15626
15627 @item show pagination
15628 @kindex show pagination
15629 Show the current pagination mode.
15630 @end table
15631
15632 @node Numbers
15633 @section Numbers
15634 @cindex number representation
15635 @cindex entering numbers
15636
15637 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15638 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15639 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15640 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15641 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15642 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15643 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15644 both input and output with the commands described below.
15645
15646 @table @code
15647 @kindex set input-radix
15648 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15649 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15650 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15651 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15652 example, any of
15653
15654 @smallexample
15655 set input-radix 012
15656 set input-radix 10.
15657 set input-radix 0xa
15658 @end smallexample
15659
15660 @noindent
15661 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15662 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15663 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15664 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15665 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15666 change the radix.
15667
15668 @kindex set output-radix
15669 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15670 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15671 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15672 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15673
15674 @kindex show input-radix
15675 @item show input-radix
15676 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15677
15678 @kindex show output-radix
15679 @item show output-radix
15680 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15681
15682 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15683 @itemx show radix
15684 @kindex set radix
15685 @kindex show radix
15686 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15687 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15688 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15689 default value of 10.
15690
15691 @end table
15692
15693 @node ABI
15694 @section Configuring the current ABI
15695
15696 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15697 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15698 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15699 current ABI.
15700
15701 @cindex OS ABI
15702 @kindex set osabi
15703 @kindex show osabi
15704
15705 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15706 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15707 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15708 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15709 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15710 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15711 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15712 platform provides.
15713
15714 @table @code
15715 @item show osabi
15716 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15717
15718 @item set osabi
15719 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15720
15721 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15722 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15723 @end table
15724
15725 @cindex float promotion
15726
15727 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15728 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15729 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15730 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15731 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15732 @code{double} and then passed.
15733
15734 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15735 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15736 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15737
15738 @table @code
15739 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15740 @item set coerce-float-to-double
15741 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15742 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15743 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15744
15745 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
15746 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15747 functions.
15748
15749 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
15750 @item show coerce-float-to-double
15751 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
15752 @end table
15753
15754 @kindex set cp-abi
15755 @kindex show cp-abi
15756 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
15757 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
15758 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
15759 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
15760 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
15761 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
15762 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
15763 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
15764 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
15765 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
15766 ``auto''.
15767
15768 @table @code
15769 @item show cp-abi
15770 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
15771
15772 @item set cp-abi
15773 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
15774
15775 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
15776 @itemx set cp-abi auto
15777 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
15778 @end table
15779
15780 @node Messages/Warnings
15781 @section Optional warnings and messages
15782
15783 @cindex verbose operation
15784 @cindex optional warnings
15785 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
15786 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
15787 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
15788 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
15789
15790 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
15791 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
15792 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
15793
15794 @table @code
15795 @kindex set verbose
15796 @item set verbose on
15797 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15798
15799 @item set verbose off
15800 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15801
15802 @kindex show verbose
15803 @item show verbose
15804 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
15805 @end table
15806
15807 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
15808 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
15809 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
15810 symbol files}).
15811
15812 @table @code
15813
15814 @kindex set complaints
15815 @item set complaints @var{limit}
15816 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
15817 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
15818 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
15819 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
15820
15821 @kindex show complaints
15822 @item show complaints
15823 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
15824
15825 @end table
15826
15827 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
15828 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
15829 you try to run a program which is already running:
15830
15831 @smallexample
15832 (@value{GDBP}) run
15833 The program being debugged has been started already.
15834 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
15835 @end smallexample
15836
15837 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
15838 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
15839
15840 @table @code
15841
15842 @kindex set confirm
15843 @cindex flinching
15844 @cindex confirmation
15845 @cindex stupid questions
15846 @item set confirm off
15847 Disables confirmation requests.
15848
15849 @item set confirm on
15850 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
15851
15852 @kindex show confirm
15853 @item show confirm
15854 Displays state of confirmation requests.
15855
15856 @end table
15857
15858 @node Debugging Output
15859 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
15860 @cindex optional debugging messages
15861
15862 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
15863 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
15864 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
15865 section documents those commands.
15866
15867 @table @code
15868 @kindex set exec-done-display
15869 @item set exec-done-display
15870 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
15871 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
15872 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
15873 @kindex show exec-done-display
15874 @item show exec-done-display
15875 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
15876 notification.
15877 @kindex set debug
15878 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
15879 @cindex architecture debugging info
15880 @item set debug arch
15881 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
15882 @kindex show debug
15883 @item show debug arch
15884 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
15885 @item set debug aix-thread
15886 @cindex AIX threads
15887 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
15888 module.
15889 @item show debug aix-thread
15890 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
15891 @item set debug event
15892 @cindex event debugging info
15893 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
15894 default is off.
15895 @item show debug event
15896 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
15897 info.
15898 @item set debug expression
15899 @cindex expression debugging info
15900 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
15901 expression parsing. The default is off.
15902 @item show debug expression
15903 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
15904 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
15905 @item set debug frame
15906 @cindex frame debugging info
15907 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
15908 default is off.
15909 @item show debug frame
15910 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
15911 info.
15912 @item set debug infrun
15913 @cindex inferior debugging info
15914 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
15915 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
15916 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
15917 @item show debug infrun
15918 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
15919 @item set debug lin-lwp
15920 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
15921 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
15922 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
15923 @item show debug lin-lwp
15924 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
15925 @item set debug observer
15926 @cindex observer debugging info
15927 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
15928 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
15929 @item show debug observer
15930 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
15931 @item set debug overload
15932 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
15933 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
15934 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
15935 is off.
15936 @item show debug overload
15937 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
15938 debugging info.
15939 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
15940 @cindex serial connections, debugging
15941 @item set debug remote
15942 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
15943 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
15944 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
15945 @item show debug remote
15946 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
15947 @item set debug serial
15948 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
15949 default is off.
15950 @item show debug serial
15951 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
15952 info.
15953 @item set debug solib-frv
15954 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
15955 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
15956 @item show debug solib-frv
15957 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
15958 messages.
15959 @item set debug target
15960 @cindex target debugging info
15961 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
15962 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
15963 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
15964 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
15965 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
15966 @item show debug target
15967 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
15968 info.
15969 @item set debugvarobj
15970 @cindex variable object debugging info
15971 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
15972 info. The default is off.
15973 @item show debugvarobj
15974 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
15975 debugging info.
15976 @end table
15977
15978 @node Sequences
15979 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
15980
15981 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
15982 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
15983 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
15984 files.
15985
15986 @menu
15987 * Define:: How to define your own commands
15988 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
15989 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
15990 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
15991 @end menu
15992
15993 @node Define
15994 @section User-defined commands
15995
15996 @cindex user-defined command
15997 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
15998 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
15999 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16000 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16001 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16002 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16003
16004 @smallexample
16005 define adder
16006 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16007 end
16008 @end smallexample
16009
16010 @noindent
16011 To execute the command use:
16012
16013 @smallexample
16014 adder 1 2 3
16015 @end smallexample
16016
16017 @noindent
16018 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16019 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16020 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16021 functions calls.
16022
16023 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16024 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16025 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16026 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16027
16028 @smallexample
16029 define adder
16030 if $argc == 2
16031 print $arg0 + $arg1
16032 end
16033 if $argc == 3
16034 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16035 end
16036 end
16037 @end smallexample
16038
16039 @table @code
16040
16041 @kindex define
16042 @item define @var{commandname}
16043 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16044 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16045
16046 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16047 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16048 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16049
16050 @kindex document
16051 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16052 @item document @var{commandname}
16053 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16054 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16055 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16056 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16057 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16058 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16059
16060 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16061 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16062 does not change the documentation.
16063
16064 @kindex dont-repeat
16065 @cindex don't repeat command
16066 @item dont-repeat
16067 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16068 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16069 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16070
16071 @kindex help user-defined
16072 @item help user-defined
16073 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16074 (if any) for each.
16075
16076 @kindex show user
16077 @item show user
16078 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16079 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16080 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16081 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16082
16083 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16084 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16085 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16086 @item show max-user-call-depth
16087 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16088 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16089 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
16090 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16091 @end table
16092
16093 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16094 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16095
16096 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16097 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16098 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16099
16100 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16101 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16102 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16103 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16104
16105 @node Hooks
16106 @section User-defined command hooks
16107 @cindex command hooks
16108 @cindex hooks, for commands
16109 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16110
16111 @kindex hook
16112 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16113 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16114 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16115 before that command.
16116
16117 @cindex hooks, post-command
16118 @kindex hookpost
16119 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16120 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16121 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16122 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16123 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16124
16125 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16126 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16127
16128 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16129 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16130
16131 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16132 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16133 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16134 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16135 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16136
16137 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16138 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16139 you could define:
16140
16141 @smallexample
16142 define hook-stop
16143 handle SIGALRM nopass
16144 end
16145
16146 define hook-run
16147 handle SIGALRM pass
16148 end
16149
16150 define hook-continue
16151 handle SIGLARM pass
16152 end
16153 @end smallexample
16154
16155 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
16156 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16157 you could define:
16158
16159 @smallexample
16160 define hook-echo
16161 echo <<<---
16162 end
16163
16164 define hookpost-echo
16165 echo --->>>\n
16166 end
16167
16168 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16169 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16170 (@value{GDBP})
16171
16172 @end smallexample
16173
16174 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16175 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16176 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16177 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16178 @c or not?
16179 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16180 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16181 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16182
16183 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16184 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16185
16186 @node Command Files
16187 @section Command files
16188
16189 @cindex command files
16190 @cindex scripting commands
16191 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16192 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16193 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16194 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16195 terminal.
16196
16197 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16198 command:
16199
16200 @table @code
16201 @kindex source
16202 @cindex execute commands from a file
16203 @item source @var{filename}
16204 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16205 @end table
16206
16207 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16208 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16209 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16210 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16211 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16212
16213 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16214 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16215 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16216 when called from command files.
16217
16218 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16219 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16220 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16221 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16222 the next command.
16223
16224 @smallexample
16225 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16226 @end smallexample
16227
16228 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16229 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16230 would be directed to @file{log}.
16231
16232 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16233 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16234 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16235 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16236 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16237 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16238 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16239 conditionally, etc.
16240
16241 @table @code
16242 @kindex if
16243 @kindex else
16244 @item if
16245 @itemx else
16246 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16247 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16248 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16249 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16250 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16251 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16252 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16253
16254 @kindex while
16255 @item while
16256 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16257 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16258 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16259 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16260 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16261 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16262
16263 @kindex loop_break
16264 @item loop_break
16265 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16266 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16267 line.
16268
16269 @kindex loop_continue
16270 @item loop_continue
16271 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16272 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16273 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16274 the controlling expression.
16275
16276 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16277 @item end
16278 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16279 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16280 @end table
16281
16282
16283 @node Output
16284 @section Commands for controlled output
16285
16286 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16287 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16288 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16289 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16290 want.
16291
16292 @table @code
16293 @kindex echo
16294 @item echo @var{text}
16295 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16296 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16297 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16298 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16299 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16300 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16301 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16302 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16303 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16304 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16305 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16306
16307 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16308 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16309
16310 @smallexample
16311 echo This is some text\n\
16312 which is continued\n\
16313 onto several lines.\n
16314 @end smallexample
16315
16316 produces the same output as
16317
16318 @smallexample
16319 echo This is some text\n
16320 echo which is continued\n
16321 echo onto several lines.\n
16322 @end smallexample
16323
16324 @kindex output
16325 @item output @var{expression}
16326 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16327 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16328 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16329 on expressions.
16330
16331 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16332 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16333 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16334 formats}, for more information.
16335
16336 @kindex printf
16337 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16338 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16339 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16340 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16341 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16342 subroutine
16343 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16344 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16345 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16346 @c supported.
16347
16348 @smallexample
16349 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16350 @end smallexample
16351
16352 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16353
16354 @smallexample
16355 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16356 @end smallexample
16357
16358 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16359 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16360 letter.
16361 @end table
16362
16363 @node Interpreters
16364 @chapter Command Interpreters
16365 @cindex command interpreters
16366
16367 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16368 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16369 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16370
16371 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16372 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16373 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16374 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16375
16376 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16377 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16378 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16379 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16380
16381 @table @code
16382 @item console
16383 @cindex console interpreter
16384 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16385 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16386 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16387
16388 @item mi
16389 @cindex mi interpreter
16390 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16391 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16392 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16393 Interface}.
16394
16395 @item mi2
16396 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16397 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16398
16399 @item mi1
16400 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16401 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16402
16403 @end table
16404
16405 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16406 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16407 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16408 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16409 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16410 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16411 the IDE inoperable!
16412
16413 @kindex interpreter-exec
16414 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16415 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16416 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16417 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16418
16419 @smallexample
16420 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16421 @end smallexample
16422
16423 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16424 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16425
16426 @node TUI
16427 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16428 @cindex TUI
16429 @cindex Text User Interface
16430
16431 @menu
16432 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16433 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16434 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16435 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
16436 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16437 @end menu
16438
16439 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16440 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16441 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16442 commands in separate text windows.
16443
16444 The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16445 @pindex gdbtui
16446 @samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16447
16448 @node TUI Overview
16449 @section TUI overview
16450
16451 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16452 @value{GDBN} runs:
16453
16454 @itemize @bullet
16455 @item
16456 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16457 windows on the terminal.
16458
16459 @item
16460 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16461 the TUI.
16462 @end itemize
16463
16464 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16465 on the terminal:
16466
16467 @table @emph
16468 @item command
16469 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16470 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16471 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16472 window is always visible.
16473
16474 @item source
16475 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16476 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16477
16478 @item assembly
16479 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16480
16481 @item register
16482 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16483 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16484 changed are highlighted.
16485
16486 @end table
16487
16488 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16489 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16490 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16491 indicates the breakpoint type:
16492
16493 @table @code
16494 @item B
16495 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16496
16497 @item b
16498 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16499
16500 @item H
16501 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16502
16503 @item h
16504 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16505
16506 @end table
16507
16508 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16509
16510 @table @code
16511 @item +
16512 Breakpoint is enabled.
16513
16514 @item -
16515 Breakpoint is disabled.
16516
16517 @end table
16518
16519 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16520 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16521 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16522 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16523 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16524 The following layouts are available:
16525
16526 @itemize @bullet
16527 @item
16528 source
16529
16530 @item
16531 assembly
16532
16533 @item
16534 source and assembly
16535
16536 @item
16537 source and registers
16538
16539 @item
16540 assembly and registers
16541
16542 @end itemize
16543
16544 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16545 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16546 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16547 are displayed:
16548
16549 @table @emph
16550 @item target
16551 Indicates the current gdb target
16552 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16553
16554 @item process
16555 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16556 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16557
16558 @item function
16559 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16560 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16561 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16562 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16563
16564 @item line
16565 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16566 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16567
16568 @item pc
16569 Indicates the current program counter address.
16570
16571 @end table
16572
16573 @node TUI Keys
16574 @section TUI Key Bindings
16575 @cindex TUI key bindings
16576
16577 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16578 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16579 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16580 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16581 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16582 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16583 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16584
16585 @table @kbd
16586 @kindex C-x C-a
16587 @item C-x C-a
16588 @kindex C-x a
16589 @itemx C-x a
16590 @kindex C-x A
16591 @itemx C-x A
16592 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16593 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16594 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16595 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16596 The screen is then refreshed.
16597
16598 @kindex C-x 1
16599 @item C-x 1
16600 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16601 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16602 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16603
16604 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16605
16606 @kindex C-x 2
16607 @item C-x 2
16608 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16609 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16610 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16611 previous layout and the new one.
16612
16613 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16614
16615 @kindex C-x o
16616 @item C-x o
16617 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16618 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
16619 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16620
16621 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16622
16623 @kindex C-x s
16624 @item C-x s
16625 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
16626 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16627
16628 @end table
16629
16630 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
16631
16632 @table @key
16633 @kindex PgUp
16634 @item PgUp
16635 Scroll the active window one page up.
16636
16637 @kindex PgDn
16638 @item PgDn
16639 Scroll the active window one page down.
16640
16641 @kindex Up
16642 @item Up
16643 Scroll the active window one line up.
16644
16645 @kindex Down
16646 @item Down
16647 Scroll the active window one line down.
16648
16649 @kindex Left
16650 @item Left
16651 Scroll the active window one column left.
16652
16653 @kindex Right
16654 @item Right
16655 Scroll the active window one column right.
16656
16657 @kindex C-L
16658 @item C-L
16659 Refresh the screen.
16660
16661 @end table
16662
16663 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
16664 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
16665 active window is the command window. When the command window
16666 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
16667 key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n}, @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
16668
16669 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16670 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16671 @cindex TUI single key mode
16672
16673 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
16674 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
16675 some gdb commands.
16676
16677 @table @kbd
16678 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16679 @item c
16680 continue
16681
16682 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16683 @item d
16684 down
16685
16686 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16687 @item f
16688 finish
16689
16690 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16691 @item n
16692 next
16693
16694 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16695 @item q
16696 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
16697
16698 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16699 @item r
16700 run
16701
16702 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16703 @item s
16704 step
16705
16706 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16707 @item u
16708 up
16709
16710 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16711 @item v
16712 info locals
16713
16714 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16715 @item w
16716 where
16717
16718 @end table
16719
16720 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
16721 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
16722 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
16723 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
16724 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
16725 this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
16726
16727
16728 @node TUI Commands
16729 @section TUI specific commands
16730 @cindex TUI commands
16731
16732 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
16733 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
16734 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
16735 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
16736 in the TUI mode.
16737
16738 @table @code
16739 @item info win
16740 @kindex info win
16741 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
16742
16743 @item layout next
16744 @kindex layout
16745 Display the next layout.
16746
16747 @item layout prev
16748 Display the previous layout.
16749
16750 @item layout src
16751 Display the source window only.
16752
16753 @item layout asm
16754 Display the assembly window only.
16755
16756 @item layout split
16757 Display the source and assembly window.
16758
16759 @item layout regs
16760 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
16761
16762 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
16763 @kindex focus
16764 Set the focus to the named window.
16765 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
16766 can be affected to another window.
16767
16768 @item refresh
16769 @kindex refresh
16770 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
16771
16772 @item tui reg float
16773 @kindex tui reg
16774 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
16775
16776 @item tui reg general
16777 Show the general registers in the register window.
16778
16779 @item tui reg next
16780 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
16781 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
16782 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
16783 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
16784
16785 @item tui reg system
16786 Show the system registers in the register window.
16787
16788 @item update
16789 @kindex update
16790 Update the source window and the current execution point.
16791
16792 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
16793 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
16794 @kindex winheight
16795 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
16796 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
16797 decrease it.
16798
16799 @item tabset
16800 @kindex tabset @var{nchars}
16801 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
16802
16803 @end table
16804
16805 @node TUI Configuration
16806 @section TUI configuration variables
16807 @cindex TUI configuration variables
16808
16809 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
16810 appearance of windows on the terminal.
16811
16812 @table @code
16813 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
16814 @kindex set tui border-kind
16815 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
16816 The possible values are the following:
16817 @table @code
16818 @item space
16819 Use a space character to draw the border.
16820
16821 @item ascii
16822 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
16823
16824 @item acs
16825 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
16826 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
16827
16828 @end table
16829
16830 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
16831 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
16832 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
16833 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
16834 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
16835
16836 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
16837 @kindex set tui border-mode
16838 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
16839 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
16840 @table @code
16841 @item normal
16842 Use normal attributes to display the border.
16843
16844 @item standout
16845 Use standout mode.
16846
16847 @item reverse
16848 Use reverse video mode.
16849
16850 @item half
16851 Use half bright mode.
16852
16853 @item half-standout
16854 Use half bright and standout mode.
16855
16856 @item bold
16857 Use extra bright or bold mode.
16858
16859 @item bold-standout
16860 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
16861
16862 @end table
16863
16864 @end table
16865
16866 @node Emacs
16867 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
16868
16869 @cindex Emacs
16870 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
16871 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
16872 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
16873 @value{GDBN}.
16874
16875 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
16876 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
16877 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
16878 created Emacs buffer.
16879 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
16880
16881 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
16882 things:
16883
16884 @itemize @bullet
16885 @item
16886 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
16887 @end itemize
16888
16889 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
16890 and output done by the program you are debugging.
16891
16892 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
16893 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
16894 in this way.
16895
16896 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
16897 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
16898 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
16899 stop.
16900
16901 @itemize @bullet
16902 @item
16903 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
16904 @end itemize
16905
16906 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
16907 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
16908 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
16909 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
16910 and the source.
16911
16912 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
16913 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
16914
16915 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
16916 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
16917 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
16918 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
16919 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
16920 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
16921 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
16922 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
16923 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
16924
16925 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
16926 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
16927 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
16928 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
16929
16930 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
16931 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
16932 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
16933 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
16934 one you want.
16935
16936 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
16937 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
16938
16939 @table @kbd
16940 @item C-h m
16941 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
16942
16943 @item C-c C-s
16944 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
16945 update the display window to show the current file and location.
16946
16947 @item C-c C-n
16948 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
16949 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
16950 to show the current file and location.
16951
16952 @item C-c C-i
16953 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
16954 display window accordingly.
16955
16956 @item C-c C-f
16957 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
16958 @code{finish} command.
16959
16960 @item C-c C-r
16961 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
16962 command.
16963
16964 @item C-c <
16965 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
16966 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
16967 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
16968
16969 @item C-c >
16970 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
16971 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
16972 @end table
16973
16974 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gud-break})
16975 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
16976
16977 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
16978 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
16979 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
16980 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
16981 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
16982 current one.
16983
16984 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
16985 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
16986 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
16987 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
16988 frame.
16989
16990 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
16991 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
16992 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
16993 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
16994 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
16995 to correspond properly with the code.
16996
16997 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
16998 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
16999 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
17000
17001 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17002 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17003 @ignore
17004 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17005 @kindex Epoch
17006 @kindex inspect
17007
17008 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17009 called the @code{epoch}
17010 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17011 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17012 each value is printed in its own window.
17013 @end ignore
17014
17015
17016 @node GDB/MI
17017 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17018
17019 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17020
17021 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17022 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17023 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17024 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17025 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17026 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17027
17028 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17029 in the form of a reference manual.
17030
17031 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17032 features described below are incomplete and subject to change.
17033
17034 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17035
17036 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17037 This chapter uses the following notation:
17038
17039 @itemize @bullet
17040 @item
17041 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17042
17043 @item
17044 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17045 it may or may not be given.
17046
17047 @item
17048 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17049 may repeat zero or more times.
17050
17051 @item
17052 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17053 may repeat one or more times.
17054
17055 @item
17056 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17057 @end itemize
17058
17059 @ignore
17060 @heading Dependencies
17061 @end ignore
17062
17063 @heading Acknowledgments
17064
17065 In alphabetic order: Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, Stan Shebs and
17066 Elena Zannoni.
17067
17068 @menu
17069 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17070 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17071 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17072 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17073 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands::
17074 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17075 * GDB/MI Program Control::
17076 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17077 @ignore
17078 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17079 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17080 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17081 @end ignore
17082 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17083 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17084 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17085 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17086 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17087 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17088 @end menu
17089
17090 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17091 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17092 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17093
17094 @menu
17095 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17096 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17097 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17098 @end menu
17099
17100 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17101 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17102
17103 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17104 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17105 @table @code
17106 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17107 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17108
17109 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17110 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17111 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17112
17113 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17114 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17115 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17116
17117 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17118 "any sequence of digits"
17119
17120 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17121 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17122
17123 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17124 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17125
17126 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17127 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17128
17129 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17130 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17131 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17132
17133 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17134 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17135
17136 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17137 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17138 @end table
17139
17140 @noindent
17141 Notes:
17142
17143 @itemize @bullet
17144 @item
17145 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17146 output is described below.
17147
17148 @item
17149 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17150 finishes.
17151
17152 @item
17153 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17154 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17155 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17156 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17157 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17158 @end itemize
17159
17160 Pragmatics:
17161
17162 @itemize @bullet
17163 @item
17164 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17165
17166 @item
17167 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17168 @end itemize
17169
17170 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17171 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17172
17173 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17174 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17175 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17176 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17177 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17178 terminated by @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.
17179
17180 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17181 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17182 @var{token}.
17183
17184 @table @code
17185 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17186 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(@value{GDBP})" @var{nl}}
17187
17188 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17189 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17190
17191 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17192 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17193
17194 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17195 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17196
17197 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17198 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17199
17200 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17201 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17202
17203 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17204 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17205
17206 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17207 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17208
17209 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17210 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17211
17212 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17213 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17214 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17215
17216 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17217 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17218
17219 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17220 @code{ @var{string} }
17221
17222 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17223 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17224
17225 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17226 @code{@var{c-string}}
17227
17228 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17229 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17230
17231 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17232 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17233 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17234
17235 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17236 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17237
17238 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17239 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17240
17241 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17242 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17243
17244 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17245 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17246
17247 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17248 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17249
17250 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17251 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17252 @end table
17253
17254 @noindent
17255 Notes:
17256
17257 @itemize @bullet
17258 @item
17259 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17260
17261 @item
17262 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17263 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17264 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17265 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17266
17267 @item
17268 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17269 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17270 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17271 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17272
17273 @item
17274 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17275 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17276 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17277 @samp{*}.
17278
17279 @item
17280 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17281 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17282 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17283 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17284
17285 @item
17286 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17287 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17288 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17289 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17290
17291 @item
17292 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17293 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17294 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17295
17296 @item
17297 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17298 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17299 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17300 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17301
17302 @item
17303 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17304 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17305 @var{values}.
17306
17307
17308 @end itemize
17309
17310 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17311 details about the various output records.
17312
17313 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17314 @subsection Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17315 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17316
17317 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17318 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17319 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17320 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17321
17322 @subsubheading Target Stop
17323 @c Ummm... There is no "-stop" command. This assumes async, no?
17324 Here's an example of stopping the inferior process:
17325
17326 @smallexample
17327 -> -stop
17328 <- (@value{GDBP})
17329 @end smallexample
17330
17331 @noindent
17332 and later:
17333
17334 @smallexample
17335 <- *stop,reason="stop",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
17336 <- (@value{GDBP})
17337 @end smallexample
17338
17339 @subsubheading Simple CLI Command
17340
17341 Here's an example of a simple CLI command being passed through
17342 @sc{gdb/mi} and on to the CLI.
17343
17344 @smallexample
17345 -> print 1+2
17346 <- &"print 1+2\n"
17347 <- ~"$1 = 3\n"
17348 <- ^done
17349 <- (@value{GDBP})
17350 @end smallexample
17351
17352 @subsubheading Command With Side Effects
17353
17354 @smallexample
17355 -> -symbol-file xyz.exe
17356 <- *breakpoint,nr="3",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
17357 <- (@value{GDBP})
17358 @end smallexample
17359
17360 @subsubheading A Bad Command
17361
17362 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17363
17364 @smallexample
17365 -> -rubbish
17366 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17367 <- (@value{GDBP})
17368 @end smallexample
17369
17370 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17371 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17372 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17373
17374 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17375 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17376 To help users familiar with @value{GDBN}'s existing CLI interface, @sc{gdb/mi}
17377 accepts existing CLI commands. As specified by the syntax, such
17378 commands can be directly entered into the @sc{gdb/mi} interface and @value{GDBN} will
17379 respond.
17380
17381 This mechanism is provided as an aid to developers of @sc{gdb/mi}
17382 clients and not as a reliable interface into the CLI. Since the command
17383 is being interpreteted in an environment that assumes @sc{gdb/mi}
17384 behaviour, the exact output of such commands is likely to end up being
17385 an un-supported hybrid of @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI output.
17386
17387 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17388 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17389 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17390
17391 @menu
17392 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17393 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17394 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17395 @end menu
17396
17397 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17398 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17399
17400 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17401 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17402 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17403 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17404
17405 @table @code
17406 @findex ^done
17407 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17408 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17409 values.
17410
17411 @item "^running"
17412 @findex ^running
17413 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17414 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17415 running.
17416
17417 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17418 @findex ^error
17419 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17420 error message.
17421 @end table
17422
17423 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17424 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17425
17426 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17427 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17428 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17429 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17430 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17431
17432 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17433 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17434 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17435 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17436 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17437
17438 @table @code
17439 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17440 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17441 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17442
17443 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17444 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17445 target.
17446
17447 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17448 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17449 internals.
17450 @end table
17451
17452 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17453 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17454
17455 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17456 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17457 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17458 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17459 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17460 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17461
17462 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17463 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17464
17465 @table @code
17466 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17467 @end table
17468
17469 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17470
17471 @table @code
17472 @item breakpoint-hit
17473 A breakpoint was reached.
17474 @item watchpoint-trigger
17475 A watchpoint was triggered.
17476 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17477 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17478 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17479 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17480 @item function-finished
17481 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17482 @item location-reached
17483 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17484 @item watchpoint-scope
17485 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17486 @item end-stepping-range
17487 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17488 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17489 @item exited-signalled
17490 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17491 @item exited
17492 The inferior exited.
17493 @item exited-normally
17494 The inferior exited normally.
17495 @item signal-received
17496 A signal was received by the inferior.
17497 @end table
17498
17499
17500 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17501 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17502 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17503
17504 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17505 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17506
17507 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17508 readability. They don't appear in the real output.
17509 Also note that the commands with a non-available example (N.A.@:) are
17510 not yet implemented.
17511
17512 @subheading Motivation
17513
17514 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17515
17516 @subheading Introduction
17517
17518 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17519
17520 @subheading Commands
17521
17522 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17523
17524 @subsubheading Synopsis
17525
17526 @smallexample
17527 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17528 @end smallexample
17529
17530 @subsubheading Result
17531
17532 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17533
17534 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17535
17536 @subsubheading Example
17537
17538 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17539 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands
17540 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint table commands
17541
17542 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17543 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17544 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17545 breakpoints.
17546
17547 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17548 @findex -break-after
17549
17550 @subsubheading Synopsis
17551
17552 @smallexample
17553 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17554 @end smallexample
17555
17556 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17557 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17558 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17559 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17560
17561 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17562
17563 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17564
17565 @subsubheading Example
17566
17567 @smallexample
17568 (@value{GDBP})
17569 -break-insert main
17570 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",line="5"@}
17571 (@value{GDBP})
17572 -break-after 1 3
17573 ~
17574 ^done
17575 (@value{GDBP})
17576 -break-list
17577 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17578 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17579 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17580 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17581 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17582 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17583 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17584 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17585 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0",
17586 ignore="3"@}]@}
17587 (@value{GDBP})
17588 @end smallexample
17589
17590 @ignore
17591 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17592 @findex -break-catch
17593
17594 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17595 @findex -break-commands
17596 @end ignore
17597
17598
17599 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17600 @findex -break-condition
17601
17602 @subsubheading Synopsis
17603
17604 @smallexample
17605 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17606 @end smallexample
17607
17608 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17609 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17610 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17611 command below).
17612
17613 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17614
17615 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17616
17617 @subsubheading Example
17618
17619 @smallexample
17620 (@value{GDBP})
17621 -break-condition 1 1
17622 ^done
17623 (@value{GDBP})
17624 -break-list
17625 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17626 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17627 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17628 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17629 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17630 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17631 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17632 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17633 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",cond="1",
17634 times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17635 (@value{GDBP})
17636 @end smallexample
17637
17638 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17639 @findex -break-delete
17640
17641 @subsubheading Synopsis
17642
17643 @smallexample
17644 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17645 @end smallexample
17646
17647 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
17648 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
17649
17650 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17651
17652 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
17653
17654 @subsubheading Example
17655
17656 @smallexample
17657 (@value{GDBP})
17658 -break-delete 1
17659 ^done
17660 (@value{GDBP})
17661 -break-list
17662 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17663 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17664 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17665 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17666 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17667 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17668 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17669 body=[]@}
17670 (@value{GDBP})
17671 @end smallexample
17672
17673 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
17674 @findex -break-disable
17675
17676 @subsubheading Synopsis
17677
17678 @smallexample
17679 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17680 @end smallexample
17681
17682 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
17683 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
17684
17685 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17686
17687 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
17688
17689 @subsubheading Example
17690
17691 @smallexample
17692 (@value{GDBP})
17693 -break-disable 2
17694 ^done
17695 (@value{GDBP})
17696 -break-list
17697 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17698 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17699 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17700 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17701 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17702 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17703 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17704 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
17705 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17706 (@value{GDBP})
17707 @end smallexample
17708
17709 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
17710 @findex -break-enable
17711
17712 @subsubheading Synopsis
17713
17714 @smallexample
17715 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17716 @end smallexample
17717
17718 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
17719
17720 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17721
17722 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
17723
17724 @subsubheading Example
17725
17726 @smallexample
17727 (@value{GDBP})
17728 -break-enable 2
17729 ^done
17730 (@value{GDBP})
17731 -break-list
17732 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17733 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17734 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17735 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17736 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17737 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17738 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17739 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17740 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17741 (@value{GDBP})
17742 @end smallexample
17743
17744 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
17745 @findex -break-info
17746
17747 @subsubheading Synopsis
17748
17749 @smallexample
17750 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
17751 @end smallexample
17752
17753 @c REDUNDANT???
17754 Get information about a single breakpoint.
17755
17756 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17757
17758 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
17759
17760 @subsubheading Example
17761 N.A.
17762
17763 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
17764 @findex -break-insert
17765
17766 @subsubheading Synopsis
17767
17768 @smallexample
17769 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
17770 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
17771 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
17772 @end smallexample
17773
17774 @noindent
17775 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
17776
17777 @itemize @bullet
17778 @item function
17779 @c @item +offset
17780 @c @item -offset
17781 @c @item linenum
17782 @item filename:linenum
17783 @item filename:function
17784 @item *address
17785 @end itemize
17786
17787 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
17788
17789 @table @samp
17790 @item -t
17791 Insert a tempoary breakpoint.
17792 @item -h
17793 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
17794 @item -c @var{condition}
17795 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
17796 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
17797 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
17798 @item -r
17799 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
17800 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
17801 expresson.
17802 @end table
17803
17804 @subsubheading Result
17805
17806 The result is in the form:
17807
17808 @smallexample
17809 ^done,bkptno="@var{number}",func="@var{funcname}",
17810 file="@var{filename}",line="@var{lineno}"
17811 @end smallexample
17812
17813 @noindent
17814 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint, @var{funcname}
17815 is the name of the function where the breakpoint was inserted,
17816 @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains this
17817 function, and @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file.
17818
17819 Note: this format is open to change.
17820 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
17821
17822 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17823
17824 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
17825 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
17826
17827 @subsubheading Example
17828
17829 @smallexample
17830 (@value{GDBP})
17831 -break-insert main
17832 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
17833 (@value{GDBP})
17834 -break-insert -t foo
17835 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
17836 (@value{GDBP})
17837 -break-list
17838 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17839 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17840 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17841 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17842 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17843 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17844 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17845 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17846 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",line="4",times="0"@},
17847 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
17848 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
17849 (@value{GDBP})
17850 -break-insert -r foo.*
17851 ~int foo(int, int);
17852 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
17853 (@value{GDBP})
17854 @end smallexample
17855
17856 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
17857 @findex -break-list
17858
17859 @subsubheading Synopsis
17860
17861 @smallexample
17862 -break-list
17863 @end smallexample
17864
17865 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
17866
17867 @table @samp
17868 @item Number
17869 number of the breakpoint
17870 @item Type
17871 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
17872 @item Disposition
17873 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
17874 or @samp{nokeep}
17875 @item Enabled
17876 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
17877 @item Address
17878 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
17879 @item What
17880 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
17881 name, line number
17882 @item Times
17883 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
17884 @end table
17885
17886 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
17887 @code{body} field is an empty list.
17888
17889 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17890
17891 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
17892
17893 @subsubheading Example
17894
17895 @smallexample
17896 (@value{GDBP})
17897 -break-list
17898 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17899 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17900 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17901 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17902 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17903 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17904 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17905 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17906 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
17907 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17908 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",line="13",times="0"@}]@}
17909 (@value{GDBP})
17910 @end smallexample
17911
17912 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
17913
17914 @smallexample
17915 (@value{GDBP})
17916 -break-list
17917 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17918 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17919 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17920 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17921 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17922 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17923 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17924 body=[]@}
17925 (@value{GDBP})
17926 @end smallexample
17927
17928 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
17929 @findex -break-watch
17930
17931 @subsubheading Synopsis
17932
17933 @smallexample
17934 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
17935 @end smallexample
17936
17937 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
17938 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
17939 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
17940 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
17941 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
17942 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
17943 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
17944 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
17945
17946 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
17947 breakpoints inserted.
17948
17949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17950
17951 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
17952 @samp{rwatch}.
17953
17954 @subsubheading Example
17955
17956 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
17957
17958 @smallexample
17959 (@value{GDBP})
17960 -break-watch x
17961 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
17962 (@value{GDBP})
17963 -exec-continue
17964 ^running
17965 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
17966 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
17967 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
17968 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
17969 (@value{GDBP})
17970 @end smallexample
17971
17972 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
17973 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
17974 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
17975
17976 @smallexample
17977 (@value{GDBP})
17978 -break-watch C
17979 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
17980 (@value{GDBP})
17981 -exec-continue
17982 ^running
17983 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
17984 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
17985 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
17986 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
17987 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
17988 (@value{GDBP})
17989 -exec-continue
17990 ^running
17991 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
17992 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
17993 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
17994 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
17995 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
17996 (@value{GDBP})
17997 @end smallexample
17998
17999 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18000 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18001 deleted.
18002
18003 @smallexample
18004 (@value{GDBP})
18005 -break-watch C
18006 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18007 (@value{GDBP})
18008 -break-list
18009 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18010 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18011 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18012 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18013 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18014 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18015 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18016 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18017 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18018 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18019 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18020 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18021 (@value{GDBP})
18022 -exec-continue
18023 ^running
18024 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18025 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18026 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18027 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18028 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18029 (@value{GDBP})
18030 -break-list
18031 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18032 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18033 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18034 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18035 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18036 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18037 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18038 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18039 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18040 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18041 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18042 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18043 (@value{GDBP})
18044 -exec-continue
18045 ^running
18046 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18047 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18048 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18049 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18050 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18051 (@value{GDBP})
18052 -break-list
18053 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18054 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18055 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18056 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18057 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18058 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18059 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18060 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18061 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18062 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@}]@}
18063 (@value{GDBP})
18064 @end smallexample
18065
18066 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18067 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
18068 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
18069
18070 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
18071 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
18072 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
18073 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
18074
18075 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
18076 @c @subheading -data-assign
18077 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
18078 @c @subsubheading GDB command
18079 @c set variable
18080 @c @subsubheading Example
18081 @c N.A.
18082
18083 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
18084 @findex -data-disassemble
18085
18086 @subsubheading Synopsis
18087
18088 @smallexample
18089 -data-disassemble
18090 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
18091 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
18092 -- @var{mode}
18093 @end smallexample
18094
18095 @noindent
18096 Where:
18097
18098 @table @samp
18099 @item @var{start-addr}
18100 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
18101 @item @var{end-addr}
18102 is the end address
18103 @item @var{filename}
18104 is the name of the file to disassemble
18105 @item @var{linenum}
18106 is the line number to disassemble around
18107 @item @var{lines}
18108 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
18109 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
18110 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
18111 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
18112 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
18113 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
18114 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
18115 are displayed.
18116 @item @var{mode}
18117 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
18118 disassembly).
18119 @end table
18120
18121 @subsubheading Result
18122
18123 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
18124
18125 @itemize @bullet
18126 @item Address
18127 @item Func-name
18128 @item Offset
18129 @item Instruction
18130 @end itemize
18131
18132 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
18133 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
18134
18135 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18136
18137 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
18138
18139 @subsubheading Example
18140
18141 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
18142
18143 @smallexample
18144 (@value{GDBP})
18145 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
18146 ^done,
18147 asm_insns=[
18148 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
18149 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
18150 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
18151 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
18152 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
18153 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
18154 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
18155 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
18156 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
18157 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
18158 (@value{GDBP})
18159 @end smallexample
18160
18161 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
18162 @code{main}.
18163
18164 @smallexample
18165 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
18166 ^done,asm_insns=[
18167 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
18168 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
18169 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
18170 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
18171 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
18172 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
18173 [@dots{}]
18174 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
18175 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
18176 (@value{GDBP})
18177 @end smallexample
18178
18179 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
18180
18181 @smallexample
18182 (@value{GDBP})
18183 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
18184 ^done,asm_insns=[
18185 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
18186 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
18187 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
18188 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
18189 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
18190 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
18191 (@value{GDBP})
18192 @end smallexample
18193
18194 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
18195
18196 @smallexample
18197 (@value{GDBP})
18198 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
18199 ^done,asm_insns=[
18200 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
18201 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
18202 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
18203 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
18204 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
18205 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
18206 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
18207 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
18208 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
18209 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
18210 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
18211 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
18212 (@value{GDBP})
18213 @end smallexample
18214
18215
18216 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
18217 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
18218
18219 @subsubheading Synopsis
18220
18221 @smallexample
18222 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
18223 @end smallexample
18224
18225 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
18226 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
18227 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
18228
18229 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18230
18231 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
18232 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
18233 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
18234
18235 @subsubheading Example
18236
18237 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
18238 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
18239 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
18240 output.
18241
18242 @smallexample
18243 211-data-evaluate-expression A
18244 211^done,value="1"
18245 (@value{GDBP})
18246 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
18247 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
18248 (@value{GDBP})
18249 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
18250 411^done,value="4"
18251 (@value{GDBP})
18252 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
18253 511^done,value="4"
18254 (@value{GDBP})
18255 @end smallexample
18256
18257
18258 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
18259 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
18260
18261 @subsubheading Synopsis
18262
18263 @smallexample
18264 -data-list-changed-registers
18265 @end smallexample
18266
18267 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
18268
18269 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18270
18271 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
18272 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
18273
18274 @subsubheading Example
18275
18276 On a PPC MBX board:
18277
18278 @smallexample
18279 (@value{GDBP})
18280 -exec-continue
18281 ^running
18282
18283 (@value{GDBP})
18284 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
18285 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/try.c",line="5"@}
18286 (@value{GDBP})
18287 -data-list-changed-registers
18288 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
18289 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
18290 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
18291 (@value{GDBP})
18292 @end smallexample
18293
18294
18295 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
18296 @findex -data-list-register-names
18297
18298 @subsubheading Synopsis
18299
18300 @smallexample
18301 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
18302 @end smallexample
18303
18304 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
18305 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
18306 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
18307 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
18308 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
18309 include empty register names.
18310
18311 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18312
18313 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
18314 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
18315 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
18316
18317 @subsubheading Example
18318
18319 For the PPC MBX board:
18320 @smallexample
18321 (@value{GDBP})
18322 -data-list-register-names
18323 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
18324 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
18325 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
18326 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
18327 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
18328 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
18329 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
18330 (@value{GDBP})
18331 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
18332 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
18333 (@value{GDBP})
18334 @end smallexample
18335
18336 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
18337 @findex -data-list-register-values
18338
18339 @subsubheading Synopsis
18340
18341 @smallexample
18342 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
18343 @end smallexample
18344
18345 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
18346 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
18347 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
18348 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
18349
18350 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
18351
18352 @table @code
18353 @item x
18354 Hexadecimal
18355 @item o
18356 Octal
18357 @item t
18358 Binary
18359 @item d
18360 Decimal
18361 @item r
18362 Raw
18363 @item N
18364 Natural
18365 @end table
18366
18367 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18368
18369 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
18370 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
18371
18372 @subsubheading Example
18373
18374 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
18375 don't appear in the actual output):
18376
18377 @smallexample
18378 (@value{GDBP})
18379 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
18380 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
18381 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
18382 (@value{GDBP})
18383 -data-list-register-values x
18384 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
18385 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
18386 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
18387 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
18388 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
18389 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
18390 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
18391 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
18392 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
18393 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
18394 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
18395 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
18396 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
18397 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
18398 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
18399 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
18400 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
18401 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
18402 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
18403 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
18404 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
18405 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
18406 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
18407 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
18408 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
18409 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
18410 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
18411 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
18412 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
18413 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
18414 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
18415 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
18416 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
18417 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
18418 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
18419 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
18420 (@value{GDBP})
18421 @end smallexample
18422
18423
18424 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
18425 @findex -data-read-memory
18426
18427 @subsubheading Synopsis
18428
18429 @smallexample
18430 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
18431 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
18432 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
18433 @end smallexample
18434
18435 @noindent
18436 where:
18437
18438 @table @samp
18439 @item @var{address}
18440 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
18441 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
18442 quoted using the C convention.
18443
18444 @item @var{word-format}
18445 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
18446 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
18447 ,Output formats}).
18448
18449 @item @var{word-size}
18450 The size of each memory word in bytes.
18451
18452 @item @var{nr-rows}
18453 The number of rows in the output table.
18454
18455 @item @var{nr-cols}
18456 The number of columns in the output table.
18457
18458 @item @var{aschar}
18459 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
18460 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
18461 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
18462 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
18463
18464 @item @var{byte-offset}
18465 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
18466 @end table
18467
18468 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
18469 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
18470 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
18471 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
18472 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
18473 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
18474 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
18475 @samp{addr}.
18476
18477 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
18478 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
18479 @samp{prev-page}.
18480
18481 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18482
18483 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
18484 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
18485
18486 @subsubheading Example
18487
18488 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
18489 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
18490 word. Display each word in hex.
18491
18492 @smallexample
18493 (@value{GDBP})
18494 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
18495 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
18496 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
18497 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
18498 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
18499 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
18500 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
18501 (@value{GDBP})
18502 @end smallexample
18503
18504 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
18505 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
18506
18507 @smallexample
18508 (@value{GDBP})
18509 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
18510 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
18511 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
18512 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
18513 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
18514 (@value{GDBP})
18515 @end smallexample
18516
18517 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
18518 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
18519 used as the non-printable character.
18520
18521 @smallexample
18522 (@value{GDBP})
18523 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
18524 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
18525 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
18526 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
18527 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
18528 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
18529 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
18530 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
18531 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
18532 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
18533 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
18534 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
18535 (@value{GDBP})
18536 @end smallexample
18537
18538 @subheading The @code{-display-delete} Command
18539 @findex -display-delete
18540
18541 @subsubheading Synopsis
18542
18543 @smallexample
18544 -display-delete @var{number}
18545 @end smallexample
18546
18547 Delete the display @var{number}.
18548
18549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18550
18551 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete display}.
18552
18553 @subsubheading Example
18554 N.A.
18555
18556
18557 @subheading The @code{-display-disable} Command
18558 @findex -display-disable
18559
18560 @subsubheading Synopsis
18561
18562 @smallexample
18563 -display-disable @var{number}
18564 @end smallexample
18565
18566 Disable display @var{number}.
18567
18568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18569
18570 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable display}.
18571
18572 @subsubheading Example
18573 N.A.
18574
18575
18576 @subheading The @code{-display-enable} Command
18577 @findex -display-enable
18578
18579 @subsubheading Synopsis
18580
18581 @smallexample
18582 -display-enable @var{number}
18583 @end smallexample
18584
18585 Enable display @var{number}.
18586
18587 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18588
18589 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable display}.
18590
18591 @subsubheading Example
18592 N.A.
18593
18594
18595 @subheading The @code{-display-insert} Command
18596 @findex -display-insert
18597
18598 @subsubheading Synopsis
18599
18600 @smallexample
18601 -display-insert @var{expression}
18602 @end smallexample
18603
18604 Display @var{expression} every time the program stops.
18605
18606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18607
18608 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{display}.
18609
18610 @subsubheading Example
18611 N.A.
18612
18613
18614 @subheading The @code{-display-list} Command
18615 @findex -display-list
18616
18617 @subsubheading Synopsis
18618
18619 @smallexample
18620 -display-list
18621 @end smallexample
18622
18623 List the displays. Do not show the current values.
18624
18625 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18626
18627 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info display}.
18628
18629 @subsubheading Example
18630 N.A.
18631
18632
18633 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18634 @findex -environment-cd
18635
18636 @subsubheading Synopsis
18637
18638 @smallexample
18639 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18640 @end smallexample
18641
18642 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18643
18644 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18645
18646 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18647
18648 @subsubheading Example
18649
18650 @smallexample
18651 (@value{GDBP})
18652 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18653 ^done
18654 (@value{GDBP})
18655 @end smallexample
18656
18657
18658 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18659 @findex -environment-directory
18660
18661 @subsubheading Synopsis
18662
18663 @smallexample
18664 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18665 @end smallexample
18666
18667 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18668 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18669 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18670 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18671 occurs as normal.
18672 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18673 multiple directories in a single command
18674 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18675 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18676 If blanks are needed as
18677 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18678 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18679 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18680 character must not be used
18681 in any directory name.
18682 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18683
18684 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18685
18686 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18687
18688 @subsubheading Example
18689
18690 @smallexample
18691 (@value{GDBP})
18692 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18693 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18694 (@value{GDBP})
18695 -environment-directory ""
18696 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18697 (@value{GDBP})
18698 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18699 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18700 (@value{GDBP})
18701 -environment-directory -r
18702 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18703 (@value{GDBP})
18704 @end smallexample
18705
18706
18707 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18708 @findex -environment-path
18709
18710 @subsubheading Synopsis
18711
18712 @smallexample
18713 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18714 @end smallexample
18715
18716 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18717 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18718 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18719 supplied in addition to the
18720 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18721 occurs as normal.
18722 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18723 multiple directories in a single command
18724 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18725 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18726 If blanks are needed as
18727 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18728 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18729 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18730 character must not be used
18731 in any directory name.
18732 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18733
18734
18735 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18736
18737 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18738
18739 @subsubheading Example
18740
18741 @smallexample
18742 (@value{GDBP})
18743 -environment-path
18744 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18745 (@value{GDBP})
18746 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18747 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18748 (@value{GDBP})
18749 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18750 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18751 (@value{GDBP})
18752 @end smallexample
18753
18754
18755 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18756 @findex -environment-pwd
18757
18758 @subsubheading Synopsis
18759
18760 @smallexample
18761 -environment-pwd
18762 @end smallexample
18763
18764 Show the current working directory.
18765
18766 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18767
18768 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18769
18770 @subsubheading Example
18771
18772 @smallexample
18773 (@value{GDBP})
18774 -environment-pwd
18775 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18776 (@value{GDBP})
18777 @end smallexample
18778
18779 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18780 @node GDB/MI Program Control
18781 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program control
18782
18783 @subsubheading Program termination
18784
18785 As a result of execution, the inferior program can run to completion, if
18786 it doesn't encounter any breakpoints. In this case the output will
18787 include an exit code, if the program has exited exceptionally.
18788
18789 @subsubheading Examples
18790
18791 @noindent
18792 Program exited normally:
18793
18794 @smallexample
18795 (@value{GDBP})
18796 -exec-run
18797 ^running
18798 (@value{GDBP})
18799 x = 55
18800 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18801 (@value{GDBP})
18802 @end smallexample
18803
18804 @noindent
18805 Program exited exceptionally:
18806
18807 @smallexample
18808 (@value{GDBP})
18809 -exec-run
18810 ^running
18811 (@value{GDBP})
18812 x = 55
18813 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
18814 (@value{GDBP})
18815 @end smallexample
18816
18817 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
18818 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
18819
18820 @smallexample
18821 (@value{GDBP})
18822 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
18823 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
18824 @end smallexample
18825
18826
18827 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
18828 @findex -exec-abort
18829
18830 @subsubheading Synopsis
18831
18832 @smallexample
18833 -exec-abort
18834 @end smallexample
18835
18836 Kill the inferior running program.
18837
18838 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18839
18840 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
18841
18842 @subsubheading Example
18843 N.A.
18844
18845
18846 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18847 @findex -exec-arguments
18848
18849 @subsubheading Synopsis
18850
18851 @smallexample
18852 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18853 @end smallexample
18854
18855 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18856 @samp{-exec-run}.
18857
18858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18859
18860 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18861
18862 @subsubheading Example
18863
18864 @c FIXME!
18865 Don't have one around.
18866
18867
18868 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18869 @findex -exec-continue
18870
18871 @subsubheading Synopsis
18872
18873 @smallexample
18874 -exec-continue
18875 @end smallexample
18876
18877 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
18878 until a breakpoint is encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18879
18880 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18881
18882 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18883
18884 @subsubheading Example
18885
18886 @smallexample
18887 -exec-continue
18888 ^running
18889 (@value{GDBP})
18890 @@Hello world
18891 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18892 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/hello.c",line="13"@}
18893 (@value{GDBP})
18894 @end smallexample
18895
18896
18897 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18898 @findex -exec-finish
18899
18900 @subsubheading Synopsis
18901
18902 @smallexample
18903 -exec-finish
18904 @end smallexample
18905
18906 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
18907 until the current function is exited. Displays the results returned by
18908 the function.
18909
18910 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18911
18912 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18913
18914 @subsubheading Example
18915
18916 Function returning @code{void}.
18917
18918 @smallexample
18919 -exec-finish
18920 ^running
18921 (@value{GDBP})
18922 @@hello from foo
18923 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18924 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/hello.c",line="7"@}
18925 (@value{GDBP})
18926 @end smallexample
18927
18928 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18929 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18930 value itself.
18931
18932 @smallexample
18933 -exec-finish
18934 ^running
18935 (@value{GDBP})
18936 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18937 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18938 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18939 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18940 (@value{GDBP})
18941 @end smallexample
18942
18943
18944 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18945 @findex -exec-interrupt
18946
18947 @subsubheading Synopsis
18948
18949 @smallexample
18950 -exec-interrupt
18951 @end smallexample
18952
18953 Asynchronous command. Interrupts the background execution of the target.
18954 Note how the token associated with the stop message is the one for the
18955 execution command that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt
18956 itself only appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18957 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18958
18959 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18960
18961 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18962
18963 @subsubheading Example
18964
18965 @smallexample
18966 (@value{GDBP})
18967 111-exec-continue
18968 111^running
18969
18970 (@value{GDBP})
18971 222-exec-interrupt
18972 222^done
18973 (@value{GDBP})
18974 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18975 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18976 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/try.c",line="13"@}
18977 (@value{GDBP})
18978
18979 (@value{GDBP})
18980 -exec-interrupt
18981 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18982 (@value{GDBP})
18983 @end smallexample
18984
18985
18986 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18987 @findex -exec-next
18988
18989 @subsubheading Synopsis
18990
18991 @smallexample
18992 -exec-next
18993 @end smallexample
18994
18995 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
18996 when the beginning of the next source line is reached.
18997
18998 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18999
19000 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19001
19002 @subsubheading Example
19003
19004 @smallexample
19005 -exec-next
19006 ^running
19007 (@value{GDBP})
19008 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19009 (@value{GDBP})
19010 @end smallexample
19011
19012
19013 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19014 @findex -exec-next-instruction
19015
19016 @subsubheading Synopsis
19017
19018 @smallexample
19019 -exec-next-instruction
19020 @end smallexample
19021
19022 Asynchronous command. Executes one machine instruction. If the
19023 instruction is a function call continues until the function returns. If
19024 the program stops at an instruction in the middle of a source line, the
19025 address will be printed as well.
19026
19027 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19028
19029 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19030
19031 @subsubheading Example
19032
19033 @smallexample
19034 (@value{GDBP})
19035 -exec-next-instruction
19036 ^running
19037
19038 (@value{GDBP})
19039 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19040 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19041 (@value{GDBP})
19042 @end smallexample
19043
19044
19045 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19046 @findex -exec-return
19047
19048 @subsubheading Synopsis
19049
19050 @smallexample
19051 -exec-return
19052 @end smallexample
19053
19054 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19055 Displays the new current frame.
19056
19057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19058
19059 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19060
19061 @subsubheading Example
19062
19063 @smallexample
19064 (@value{GDBP})
19065 200-break-insert callee4
19066 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19067 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19068 (@value{GDBP})
19069 000-exec-run
19070 000^running
19071 (@value{GDBP})
19072 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19073 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19074 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19075 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19076 (@value{GDBP})
19077 205-break-delete
19078 205^done
19079 (@value{GDBP})
19080 111-exec-return
19081 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19082 args=[@{name="strarg",
19083 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19084 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19085 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19086 (@value{GDBP})
19087 @end smallexample
19088
19089
19090 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19091 @findex -exec-run
19092
19093 @subsubheading Synopsis
19094
19095 @smallexample
19096 -exec-run
19097 @end smallexample
19098
19099 Asynchronous command. Starts execution of the inferior from the
19100 beginning. The inferior executes until either a breakpoint is
19101 encountered or the program exits.
19102
19103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19104
19105 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19106
19107 @subsubheading Example
19108
19109 @smallexample
19110 (@value{GDBP})
19111 -break-insert main
19112 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19113 (@value{GDBP})
19114 -exec-run
19115 ^running
19116 (@value{GDBP})
19117 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19118 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19119 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19120 (@value{GDBP})
19121 @end smallexample
19122
19123
19124 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
19125 @findex -exec-show-arguments
19126
19127 @subsubheading Synopsis
19128
19129 @smallexample
19130 -exec-show-arguments
19131 @end smallexample
19132
19133 Print the arguments of the program.
19134
19135 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19136
19137 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
19138
19139 @subsubheading Example
19140 N.A.
19141
19142 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19143
19144 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19145 @findex -exec-step
19146
19147 @subsubheading Synopsis
19148
19149 @smallexample
19150 -exec-step
19151 @end smallexample
19152
19153 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
19154 when the beginning of the next source line is reached, if the next
19155 source line is not a function call. If it is, stop at the first
19156 instruction of the called function.
19157
19158 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19159
19160 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19161
19162 @subsubheading Example
19163
19164 Stepping into a function:
19165
19166 @smallexample
19167 -exec-step
19168 ^running
19169 (@value{GDBP})
19170 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19171 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19172 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19173 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19174 (@value{GDBP})
19175 @end smallexample
19176
19177 Regular stepping:
19178
19179 @smallexample
19180 -exec-step
19181 ^running
19182 (@value{GDBP})
19183 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19184 (@value{GDBP})
19185 @end smallexample
19186
19187
19188 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19189 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19190
19191 @subsubheading Synopsis
19192
19193 @smallexample
19194 -exec-step-instruction
19195 @end smallexample
19196
19197 Asynchronous command. Resumes the inferior which executes one machine
19198 instruction. The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
19199 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
19200 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19201 well.
19202
19203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19204
19205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19206
19207 @subsubheading Example
19208
19209 @smallexample
19210 (@value{GDBP})
19211 -exec-step-instruction
19212 ^running
19213
19214 (@value{GDBP})
19215 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19216 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19217 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/try.c",line="10"@}
19218 (@value{GDBP})
19219 -exec-step-instruction
19220 ^running
19221
19222 (@value{GDBP})
19223 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19224 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19225 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/try.c",line="10"@}
19226 (@value{GDBP})
19227 @end smallexample
19228
19229
19230 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19231 @findex -exec-until
19232
19233 @subsubheading Synopsis
19234
19235 @smallexample
19236 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19237 @end smallexample
19238
19239 Asynchronous command. Executes the inferior until the @var{location}
19240 specified in the argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior
19241 executes until a source line greater than the current one is reached.
19242 The reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19243
19244 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19245
19246 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19247
19248 @subsubheading Example
19249
19250 @smallexample
19251 (@value{GDBP})
19252 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19253 ^running
19254 (@value{GDBP})
19255 x = 55
19256 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19257 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19258 (@value{GDBP})
19259 @end smallexample
19260
19261 @ignore
19262 @subheading -file-clear
19263 Is this going away????
19264 @end ignore
19265
19266
19267 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
19268 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
19269
19270 @subsubheading Synopsis
19271
19272 @smallexample
19273 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
19274 @end smallexample
19275
19276 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
19277 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
19278 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
19279 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
19280 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
19281 notification.
19282
19283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19284
19285 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
19286
19287 @subsubheading Example
19288
19289 @smallexample
19290 (@value{GDBP})
19291 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
19292 ^done
19293 (@value{GDBP})
19294 @end smallexample
19295
19296
19297 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
19298 @findex -file-exec-file
19299
19300 @subsubheading Synopsis
19301
19302 @smallexample
19303 -file-exec-file @var{file}
19304 @end smallexample
19305
19306 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
19307 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
19308 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
19309 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
19310 notification.
19311
19312 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19313
19314 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
19315
19316 @subsubheading Example
19317
19318 @smallexample
19319 (@value{GDBP})
19320 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
19321 ^done
19322 (@value{GDBP})
19323 @end smallexample
19324
19325
19326 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
19327 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
19328
19329 @subsubheading Synopsis
19330
19331 @smallexample
19332 -file-list-exec-sections
19333 @end smallexample
19334
19335 List the sections of the current executable file.
19336
19337 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19338
19339 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
19340 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
19341 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
19342
19343 @subsubheading Example
19344 N.A.
19345
19346
19347 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
19348 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
19349
19350 @subsubheading Synopsis
19351
19352 @smallexample
19353 -file-list-exec-source-file
19354 @end smallexample
19355
19356 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
19357 to the current source file for the current executable.
19358
19359 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19360
19361 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
19362
19363 @subsubheading Example
19364
19365 @smallexample
19366 (@value{GDBP})
19367 123-file-list-exec-source-file
19368 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
19369 (@value{GDBP})
19370 @end smallexample
19371
19372
19373 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
19374 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
19375
19376 @subsubheading Synopsis
19377
19378 @smallexample
19379 -file-list-exec-source-files
19380 @end smallexample
19381
19382 List the source files for the current executable.
19383
19384 It will always output the filename, but only when GDB can find the absolute
19385 file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
19386
19387 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19388
19389 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
19390 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
19391
19392 @subsubheading Example
19393 @smallexample
19394 (@value{GDBP})
19395 -file-list-exec-source-files
19396 ^done,files=[
19397 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
19398 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
19399 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
19400 (@value{GDBP})
19401 @end smallexample
19402
19403 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
19404 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
19405
19406 @subsubheading Synopsis
19407
19408 @smallexample
19409 -file-list-shared-libraries
19410 @end smallexample
19411
19412 List the shared libraries in the program.
19413
19414 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19415
19416 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
19417
19418 @subsubheading Example
19419 N.A.
19420
19421
19422 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
19423 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
19424
19425 @subsubheading Synopsis
19426
19427 @smallexample
19428 -file-list-symbol-files
19429 @end smallexample
19430
19431 List symbol files.
19432
19433 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19434
19435 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
19436
19437 @subsubheading Example
19438 N.A.
19439
19440
19441 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
19442 @findex -file-symbol-file
19443
19444 @subsubheading Synopsis
19445
19446 @smallexample
19447 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
19448 @end smallexample
19449
19450 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
19451 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
19452 produced, except for a completion notification.
19453
19454 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19455
19456 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
19457
19458 @subsubheading Example
19459
19460 @smallexample
19461 (@value{GDBP})
19462 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
19463 ^done
19464 (@value{GDBP})
19465 @end smallexample
19466
19467 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19468 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
19469 @section Miscellaneous @value{GDBN} commands in @sc{gdb/mi}
19470
19471 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
19472
19473 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
19474 @findex -gdb-exit
19475
19476 @subsubheading Synopsis
19477
19478 @smallexample
19479 -gdb-exit
19480 @end smallexample
19481
19482 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
19483
19484 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19485
19486 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
19487
19488 @subsubheading Example
19489
19490 @smallexample
19491 (@value{GDBP})
19492 -gdb-exit
19493 @end smallexample
19494
19495 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
19496 @findex -gdb-set
19497
19498 @subsubheading Synopsis
19499
19500 @smallexample
19501 -gdb-set
19502 @end smallexample
19503
19504 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
19505 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
19506
19507 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19508
19509 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
19510
19511 @subsubheading Example
19512
19513 @smallexample
19514 (@value{GDBP})
19515 -gdb-set $foo=3
19516 ^done
19517 (@value{GDBP})
19518 @end smallexample
19519
19520
19521 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
19522 @findex -gdb-show
19523
19524 @subsubheading Synopsis
19525
19526 @smallexample
19527 -gdb-show
19528 @end smallexample
19529
19530 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
19531
19532 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
19533
19534 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
19535
19536 @subsubheading Example
19537
19538 @smallexample
19539 (@value{GDBP})
19540 -gdb-show annotate
19541 ^done,value="0"
19542 (@value{GDBP})
19543 @end smallexample
19544
19545 @c @subheading -gdb-source
19546
19547
19548 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
19549 @findex -gdb-version
19550
19551 @subsubheading Synopsis
19552
19553 @smallexample
19554 -gdb-version
19555 @end smallexample
19556
19557 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
19558
19559 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19560
19561 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @value{GDBN} by default shows this
19562 information when you start an interactive session.
19563
19564 @subsubheading Example
19565
19566 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
19567 @c box in TeX.
19568 @smallexample
19569 (@value{GDBP})
19570 -gdb-version
19571 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
19572 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
19573 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
19574 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
19575 ~ certain conditions.
19576 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
19577 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
19578 ~ details.
19579 ~This GDB was configured as
19580 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
19581 ^done
19582 (@value{GDBP})
19583 @end smallexample
19584
19585 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
19586 @findex -interpreter-exec
19587
19588 @subheading Synopsis
19589
19590 @smallexample
19591 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
19592 @end smallexample
19593
19594 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
19595
19596 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
19597
19598 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
19599
19600 @subheading Example
19601
19602 @smallexample
19603 (@value{GDBP})
19604 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
19605 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
19606 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
19607 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
19608 ^done
19609 (@value{GDBP})
19610 @end smallexample
19611
19612 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
19613 @findex -inferior-tty-set
19614
19615 @subheading Synopsis
19616
19617 @smallexample
19618 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
19619 @end smallexample
19620
19621 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
19622
19623 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
19624
19625 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty /dev/pts/1}.
19626
19627 @subheading Example
19628
19629 @smallexample
19630 (@value{GDBP})
19631 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
19632 ^done
19633 (@value{GDBP})
19634 @end smallexample
19635
19636 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
19637 @findex -inferior-tty-show
19638
19639 @subheading Synopsis
19640
19641 @smallexample
19642 -inferior-tty-show
19643 @end smallexample
19644
19645 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
19646
19647 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
19648
19649 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
19650
19651 @subheading Example
19652
19653 @smallexample
19654 (@value{GDBP})
19655 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
19656 ^done
19657 (@value{GDBP})
19658 -inferior-tty-show
19659 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
19660 (@value{GDBP})
19661 @end smallexample
19662
19663 @ignore
19664 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19665 @node GDB/MI Kod Commands
19666 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Kod Commands
19667
19668 The Kod commands are not implemented.
19669
19670 @c @subheading -kod-info
19671
19672 @c @subheading -kod-list
19673
19674 @c @subheading -kod-list-object-types
19675
19676 @c @subheading -kod-show
19677
19678 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19679 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
19680 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
19681
19682 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
19683
19684 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
19685
19686 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
19687
19688 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
19689
19690 @c @subheading -overlay-map
19691
19692 @c @subheading -overlay-off
19693
19694 @c @subheading -overlay-on
19695
19696 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
19697
19698 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19699 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
19700 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
19701
19702 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
19703
19704 @c @subheading -signal-handle
19705
19706 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
19707
19708 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
19709 @end ignore
19710
19711
19712 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19713 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19714 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19715
19716
19717 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19718 @findex -stack-info-frame
19719
19720 @subsubheading Synopsis
19721
19722 @smallexample
19723 -stack-info-frame
19724 @end smallexample
19725
19726 Get info on the selected frame.
19727
19728 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19729
19730 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19731 (without arguments).
19732
19733 @subsubheading Example
19734
19735 @smallexample
19736 (@value{GDBP})
19737 -stack-info-frame
19738 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19739 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19740 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19741 (@value{GDBP})
19742 @end smallexample
19743
19744 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19745 @findex -stack-info-depth
19746
19747 @subsubheading Synopsis
19748
19749 @smallexample
19750 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19751 @end smallexample
19752
19753 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19754 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19755
19756 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19757
19758 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19759
19760 @subsubheading Example
19761
19762 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19763
19764 @smallexample
19765 (@value{GDBP})
19766 -stack-info-depth
19767 ^done,depth="12"
19768 (@value{GDBP})
19769 -stack-info-depth 4
19770 ^done,depth="4"
19771 (@value{GDBP})
19772 -stack-info-depth 12
19773 ^done,depth="12"
19774 (@value{GDBP})
19775 -stack-info-depth 11
19776 ^done,depth="11"
19777 (@value{GDBP})
19778 -stack-info-depth 13
19779 ^done,depth="12"
19780 (@value{GDBP})
19781 @end smallexample
19782
19783 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19784 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19785
19786 @subsubheading Synopsis
19787
19788 @smallexample
19789 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19790 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19791 @end smallexample
19792
19793 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19794 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19795 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole call
19796 stack.
19797
19798 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19799 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19800 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19801
19802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19803
19804 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19805 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19806 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19807
19808 @subsubheading Example
19809
19810 @smallexample
19811 (@value{GDBP})
19812 -stack-list-frames
19813 ^done,
19814 stack=[
19815 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19816 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19817 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19818 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19819 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19820 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19821 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19822 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19823 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19824 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19825 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19826 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19827 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19828 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19829 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19830 (@value{GDBP})
19831 -stack-list-arguments 0
19832 ^done,
19833 stack-args=[
19834 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19835 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19836 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19837 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19838 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19839 (@value{GDBP})
19840 -stack-list-arguments 1
19841 ^done,
19842 stack-args=[
19843 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19844 frame=@{level="1",
19845 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19846 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19847 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19848 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19849 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19850 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19851 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19852 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19853 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19854 (@value{GDBP})
19855 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19856 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19857 (@value{GDBP})
19858 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19859 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19860 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19861 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19862 (@value{GDBP})
19863 @end smallexample
19864
19865 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19866
19867
19868 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19869 @findex -stack-list-frames
19870
19871 @subsubheading Synopsis
19872
19873 @smallexample
19874 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19875 @end smallexample
19876
19877 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19878 following info:
19879
19880 @table @samp
19881 @item @var{level}
19882 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
19883 @item @var{addr}
19884 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19885 @item @var{func}
19886 Function name.
19887 @item @var{file}
19888 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19889 @item @var{line}
19890 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19891 @end table
19892
19893 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19894 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19895 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19896 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.
19897
19898 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19899
19900 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19901
19902 @subsubheading Example
19903
19904 Full stack backtrace:
19905
19906 @smallexample
19907 (@value{GDBP})
19908 -stack-list-frames
19909 ^done,stack=
19910 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19911 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19912 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19913 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19914 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19915 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19916 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19917 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19918 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19919 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19920 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19921 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19922 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19923 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19924 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19925 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19926 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19927 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19928 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19929 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19930 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19931 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19932 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19933 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19934 (@value{GDBP})
19935 @end smallexample
19936
19937 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19938
19939 @smallexample
19940 (@value{GDBP})
19941 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19942 ^done,stack=
19943 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19944 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19945 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19946 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19947 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19948 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19949 (@value{GDBP})
19950 @end smallexample
19951
19952 Show a single frame:
19953
19954 @smallexample
19955 (@value{GDBP})
19956 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19957 ^done,stack=
19958 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19959 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19960 (@value{GDBP})
19961 @end smallexample
19962
19963
19964 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19965 @findex -stack-list-locals
19966
19967 @subsubheading Synopsis
19968
19969 @smallexample
19970 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19971 @end smallexample
19972
19973 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19974 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19975 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19976 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19977 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19978 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19979 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19980 other data types when the the user wishes to explore their values in
19981 more detail.
19982
19983 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19984
19985 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19986
19987 @subsubheading Example
19988
19989 @smallexample
19990 (@value{GDBP})
19991 -stack-list-locals 0
19992 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19993 (@value{GDBP})
19994 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19995 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19996 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19997 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19998 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19999 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
20000 (@value{GDBP})
20001 @end smallexample
20002
20003
20004 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
20005 @findex -stack-select-frame
20006
20007 @subsubheading Synopsis
20008
20009 @smallexample
20010 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
20011 @end smallexample
20012
20013 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
20014 the stack.
20015
20016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20017
20018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
20019 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
20020
20021 @subsubheading Example
20022
20023 @smallexample
20024 (@value{GDBP})
20025 -stack-select-frame 2
20026 ^done
20027 (@value{GDBP})
20028 @end smallexample
20029
20030 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20031 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20032 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20033
20034
20035 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20036 @findex -symbol-info-address
20037
20038 @subsubheading Synopsis
20039
20040 @smallexample
20041 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20042 @end smallexample
20043
20044 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20045
20046 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20047
20048 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20049
20050 @subsubheading Example
20051 N.A.
20052
20053
20054 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20055 @findex -symbol-info-file
20056
20057 @subsubheading Synopsis
20058
20059 @smallexample
20060 -symbol-info-file
20061 @end smallexample
20062
20063 Show the file for the symbol.
20064
20065 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20066
20067 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20068 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20069
20070 @subsubheading Example
20071 N.A.
20072
20073
20074 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20075 @findex -symbol-info-function
20076
20077 @subsubheading Synopsis
20078
20079 @smallexample
20080 -symbol-info-function
20081 @end smallexample
20082
20083 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20084
20085 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20086
20087 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20088
20089 @subsubheading Example
20090 N.A.
20091
20092
20093 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20094 @findex -symbol-info-line
20095
20096 @subsubheading Synopsis
20097
20098 @smallexample
20099 -symbol-info-line
20100 @end smallexample
20101
20102 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20103
20104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20105
20106 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20107 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20108
20109 @subsubheading Example
20110 N.A.
20111
20112
20113 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20114 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20115
20116 @subsubheading Synopsis
20117
20118 @smallexample
20119 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20120 @end smallexample
20121
20122 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20123
20124 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20125
20126 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20127
20128 @subsubheading Example
20129 N.A.
20130
20131
20132 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20133 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20134
20135 @subsubheading Synopsis
20136
20137 @smallexample
20138 -symbol-list-functions
20139 @end smallexample
20140
20141 List the functions in the executable.
20142
20143 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20144
20145 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20146 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20147
20148 @subsubheading Example
20149 N.A.
20150
20151
20152 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20153 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20154
20155 @subsubheading Synopsis
20156
20157 @smallexample
20158 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20159 @end smallexample
20160
20161 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20162 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20163 ascending PC order.
20164
20165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20166
20167 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20168
20169 @subsubheading Example
20170 @smallexample
20171 (@value{GDBP})
20172 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20173 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20174 (@value{GDBP})
20175 @end smallexample
20176
20177
20178 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20179 @findex -symbol-list-types
20180
20181 @subsubheading Synopsis
20182
20183 @smallexample
20184 -symbol-list-types
20185 @end smallexample
20186
20187 List all the type names.
20188
20189 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20190
20191 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20192 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20193
20194 @subsubheading Example
20195 N.A.
20196
20197
20198 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20199 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20200
20201 @subsubheading Synopsis
20202
20203 @smallexample
20204 -symbol-list-variables
20205 @end smallexample
20206
20207 List all the global and static variable names.
20208
20209 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20210
20211 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20212
20213 @subsubheading Example
20214 N.A.
20215
20216
20217 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20218 @findex -symbol-locate
20219
20220 @subsubheading Synopsis
20221
20222 @smallexample
20223 -symbol-locate
20224 @end smallexample
20225
20226 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20227
20228 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20229
20230 @subsubheading Example
20231 N.A.
20232
20233
20234 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20235 @findex -symbol-type
20236
20237 @subsubheading Synopsis
20238
20239 @smallexample
20240 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20241 @end smallexample
20242
20243 Show type of @var{variable}.
20244
20245 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20246
20247 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20248 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20249
20250 @subsubheading Example
20251 N.A.
20252
20253
20254 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20255 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20256 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20257
20258
20259 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20260 @findex -target-attach
20261
20262 @subsubheading Synopsis
20263
20264 @smallexample
20265 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20266 @end smallexample
20267
20268 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20269
20270 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20271
20272 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20273
20274 @subsubheading Example
20275 N.A.
20276
20277
20278 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20279 @findex -target-compare-sections
20280
20281 @subsubheading Synopsis
20282
20283 @smallexample
20284 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20285 @end smallexample
20286
20287 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20288 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20289
20290 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20291
20292 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20293
20294 @subsubheading Example
20295 N.A.
20296
20297
20298 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
20299 @findex -target-detach
20300
20301 @subsubheading Synopsis
20302
20303 @smallexample
20304 -target-detach
20305 @end smallexample
20306
20307 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
20308
20309 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20310
20311 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
20312
20313 @subsubheading Example
20314
20315 @smallexample
20316 (@value{GDBP})
20317 -target-detach
20318 ^done
20319 (@value{GDBP})
20320 @end smallexample
20321
20322
20323 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
20324 @findex -target-disconnect
20325
20326 @subsubheading Synopsis
20327
20328 @example
20329 -target-disconnect
20330 @end example
20331
20332 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
20333
20334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20335
20336 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20337
20338 @subsubheading Example
20339
20340 @smallexample
20341 (@value{GDBP})
20342 -target-disconnect
20343 ^done
20344 (@value{GDBP})
20345 @end smallexample
20346
20347
20348 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
20349 @findex -target-download
20350
20351 @subsubheading Synopsis
20352
20353 @smallexample
20354 -target-download
20355 @end smallexample
20356
20357 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
20358 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
20359
20360 @table @samp
20361 @item section
20362 The name of the section.
20363 @item section-sent
20364 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
20365 @item section-size
20366 The size of the section.
20367 @item total-sent
20368 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
20369 @item total-size
20370 The size of the overall executable to download.
20371 @end table
20372
20373 @noindent
20374 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
20375 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
20376
20377 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
20378 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
20379
20380 @table @samp
20381 @item section
20382 The name of the section.
20383 @item section-size
20384 The size of the section.
20385 @item total-size
20386 The size of the overall executable to download.
20387 @end table
20388
20389 @noindent
20390 At the end, a summary is printed.
20391
20392 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20393
20394 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
20395
20396 @subsubheading Example
20397
20398 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
20399 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
20400
20401 @smallexample
20402 (@value{GDBP})
20403 -target-download
20404 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
20405 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
20406 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
20407 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
20408 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
20409 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
20410 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
20411 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
20412 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
20413 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
20414 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
20415 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
20416 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
20417 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
20418 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
20419 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
20420 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
20421 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
20422 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
20423 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
20424 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
20425 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
20426 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
20427 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
20428 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
20429 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
20430 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
20431 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20432 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20433 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
20434 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
20435 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
20436 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
20437 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
20438 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
20439 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
20440 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
20441 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
20442 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
20443 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
20444 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
20445 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
20446 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
20447 write-rate="429"
20448 (@value{GDBP})
20449 @end smallexample
20450
20451
20452 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
20453 @findex -target-exec-status
20454
20455 @subsubheading Synopsis
20456
20457 @smallexample
20458 -target-exec-status
20459 @end smallexample
20460
20461 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
20462 not, for instance).
20463
20464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20465
20466 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
20467
20468 @subsubheading Example
20469 N.A.
20470
20471
20472 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
20473 @findex -target-list-available-targets
20474
20475 @subsubheading Synopsis
20476
20477 @smallexample
20478 -target-list-available-targets
20479 @end smallexample
20480
20481 List the possible targets to connect to.
20482
20483 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20484
20485 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
20486
20487 @subsubheading Example
20488 N.A.
20489
20490
20491 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
20492 @findex -target-list-current-targets
20493
20494 @subsubheading Synopsis
20495
20496 @smallexample
20497 -target-list-current-targets
20498 @end smallexample
20499
20500 Describe the current target.
20501
20502 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20503
20504 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
20505 other things).
20506
20507 @subsubheading Example
20508 N.A.
20509
20510
20511 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
20512 @findex -target-list-parameters
20513
20514 @subsubheading Synopsis
20515
20516 @smallexample
20517 -target-list-parameters
20518 @end smallexample
20519
20520 @c ????
20521
20522 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20523
20524 No equivalent.
20525
20526 @subsubheading Example
20527 N.A.
20528
20529
20530 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
20531 @findex -target-select
20532
20533 @subsubheading Synopsis
20534
20535 @smallexample
20536 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
20537 @end smallexample
20538
20539 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
20540
20541 @table @samp
20542 @item @var{type}
20543 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
20544 @item @var{parameters}
20545 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
20546 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
20547 @end table
20548
20549 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
20550 which the target program is, in the following form:
20551
20552 @smallexample
20553 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
20554 args=[@var{arg list}]
20555 @end smallexample
20556
20557 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20558
20559 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
20560
20561 @subsubheading Example
20562
20563 @smallexample
20564 (@value{GDBP})
20565 -target-select async /dev/ttya
20566 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
20567 (@value{GDBP})
20568 @end smallexample
20569
20570 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20571 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
20572 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
20573
20574
20575 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
20576 @findex -thread-info
20577
20578 @subsubheading Synopsis
20579
20580 @smallexample
20581 -thread-info
20582 @end smallexample
20583
20584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20585
20586 No equivalent.
20587
20588 @subsubheading Example
20589 N.A.
20590
20591
20592 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
20593 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
20594
20595 @subsubheading Synopsis
20596
20597 @smallexample
20598 -thread-list-all-threads
20599 @end smallexample
20600
20601 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20602
20603 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
20604
20605 @subsubheading Example
20606 N.A.
20607
20608
20609 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
20610 @findex -thread-list-ids
20611
20612 @subsubheading Synopsis
20613
20614 @smallexample
20615 -thread-list-ids
20616 @end smallexample
20617
20618 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
20619 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
20620
20621 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20622
20623 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
20624
20625 @subsubheading Example
20626
20627 No threads present, besides the main process:
20628
20629 @smallexample
20630 (@value{GDBP})
20631 -thread-list-ids
20632 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
20633 (@value{GDBP})
20634 @end smallexample
20635
20636
20637 Several threads:
20638
20639 @smallexample
20640 (@value{GDBP})
20641 -thread-list-ids
20642 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
20643 number-of-threads="3"
20644 (@value{GDBP})
20645 @end smallexample
20646
20647
20648 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
20649 @findex -thread-select
20650
20651 @subsubheading Synopsis
20652
20653 @smallexample
20654 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
20655 @end smallexample
20656
20657 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
20658 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
20659
20660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20661
20662 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
20663
20664 @subsubheading Example
20665
20666 @smallexample
20667 (@value{GDBP})
20668 -exec-next
20669 ^running
20670 (@value{GDBP})
20671 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
20672 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
20673 (@value{GDBP})
20674 -thread-list-ids
20675 ^done,
20676 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
20677 number-of-threads="3"
20678 (@value{GDBP})
20679 -thread-select 3
20680 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
20681 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
20682 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
20683 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
20684 (@value{GDBP})
20685 @end smallexample
20686
20687 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20688 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20689 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20690
20691 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20692
20693 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20694
20695 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20696
20697 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20698
20699 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20700
20701 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20702
20703 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20704
20705 @c @subheading -trace-find
20706
20707 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20708
20709 @c @subheading -trace-info
20710
20711 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20712
20713 @c @subheading -trace-list
20714
20715 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20716
20717 @c @subheading -trace-save
20718
20719 @c @subheading -trace-start
20720
20721 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20722
20723
20724 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20725 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
20726 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
20727
20728
20729 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20730
20731 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
20732 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
20733 used by @code{Insight}.
20734
20735 The two main reasons for that are:
20736
20737 @enumerate 1
20738 @item
20739 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
20740
20741 @item
20742 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
20743 now).
20744 @end enumerate
20745
20746 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
20747 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
20748 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
20749 hints about their use.
20750
20751 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
20752 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
20753 least, the following operations:
20754
20755 @itemize @bullet
20756 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
20757 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
20758 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
20759 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
20760 @end itemize
20761
20762 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20763
20764 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20765 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
20766 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
20767 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
20768 examining or changing its properties.
20769
20770 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
20771 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
20772 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
20773 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
20774 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
20775
20776 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
20777 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
20778 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
20779 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
20780 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
20781 for pointers, etc.).
20782
20783 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
20784 access this functionality:
20785
20786 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
20787 @item @strong{Operation}
20788 @tab @strong{Description}
20789
20790 @item @code{-var-create}
20791 @tab create a variable object
20792 @item @code{-var-delete}
20793 @tab delete the variable object and its children
20794 @item @code{-var-set-format}
20795 @tab set the display format of this variable
20796 @item @code{-var-show-format}
20797 @tab show the display format of this variable
20798 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
20799 @tab tells how many children this object has
20800 @item @code{-var-list-children}
20801 @tab return a list of the object's children
20802 @item @code{-var-info-type}
20803 @tab show the type of this variable object
20804 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
20805 @tab print what this variable object represents
20806 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
20807 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
20808 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
20809 @tab get the value of this variable
20810 @item @code{-var-assign}
20811 @tab set the value of this variable
20812 @item @code{-var-update}
20813 @tab update the variable and its children
20814 @end multitable
20815
20816 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
20817 how it can be used.
20818
20819 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
20820
20821 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
20822 @findex -var-create
20823
20824 @subsubheading Synopsis
20825
20826 @smallexample
20827 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
20828 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
20829 @end smallexample
20830
20831 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
20832 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
20833 register.
20834
20835 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
20836 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
20837 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
20838 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
20839 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
20840
20841 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
20842 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
20843 frame should be used.
20844
20845 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
20846 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
20847
20848 @itemize @bullet
20849 @item
20850 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
20851
20852 @item
20853 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
20854
20855 @item
20856 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
20857 @end itemize
20858
20859 @subsubheading Result
20860
20861 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
20862 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
20863 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
20864
20865 @smallexample
20866 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
20867 @end smallexample
20868
20869
20870 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
20871 @findex -var-delete
20872
20873 @subsubheading Synopsis
20874
20875 @smallexample
20876 -var-delete @var{name}
20877 @end smallexample
20878
20879 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
20880
20881 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
20882
20883
20884 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
20885 @findex -var-set-format
20886
20887 @subsubheading Synopsis
20888
20889 @smallexample
20890 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
20891 @end smallexample
20892
20893 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
20894 @var{format-spec}.
20895
20896 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
20897
20898 @smallexample
20899 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
20900 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
20901 @end smallexample
20902
20903
20904 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
20905 @findex -var-show-format
20906
20907 @subsubheading Synopsis
20908
20909 @smallexample
20910 -var-show-format @var{name}
20911 @end smallexample
20912
20913 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
20914
20915 @smallexample
20916 @var{format} @expansion{}
20917 @var{format-spec}
20918 @end smallexample
20919
20920
20921 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
20922 @findex -var-info-num-children
20923
20924 @subsubheading Synopsis
20925
20926 @smallexample
20927 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
20928 @end smallexample
20929
20930 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
20931
20932 @smallexample
20933 numchild=@var{n}
20934 @end smallexample
20935
20936
20937 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
20938 @findex -var-list-children
20939
20940 @subsubheading Synopsis
20941
20942 @smallexample
20943 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
20944 @end smallexample
20945 @anchor{-var-list-children}
20946
20947 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
20948 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
20949 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
20950 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20951 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20952 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20953 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20954 and unions.
20955
20956 @subsubheading Example
20957
20958 @smallexample
20959 (@value{GDBP})
20960 -var-list-children n
20961 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20962 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20963 (@value{GDBP})
20964 -var-list-children --all-values n
20965 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20966 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20967 @end smallexample
20968
20969
20970 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20971 @findex -var-info-type
20972
20973 @subsubheading Synopsis
20974
20975 @smallexample
20976 -var-info-type @var{name}
20977 @end smallexample
20978
20979 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20980 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20981 @value{GDBN} CLI:
20982
20983 @smallexample
20984 type=@var{typename}
20985 @end smallexample
20986
20987
20988 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
20989 @findex -var-info-expression
20990
20991 @subsubheading Synopsis
20992
20993 @smallexample
20994 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20995 @end smallexample
20996
20997 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
20998
20999 @smallexample
21000 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
21001 @end smallexample
21002
21003 @noindent
21004 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
21005
21006 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
21007 @findex -var-show-attributes
21008
21009 @subsubheading Synopsis
21010
21011 @smallexample
21012 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
21013 @end smallexample
21014
21015 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
21016
21017 @smallexample
21018 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
21019 @end smallexample
21020
21021 @noindent
21022 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
21023
21024 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
21025 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
21026
21027 @subsubheading Synopsis
21028
21029 @smallexample
21030 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
21031 @end smallexample
21032
21033 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
21034 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
21035 for the object:
21036
21037 @smallexample
21038 value=@var{value}
21039 @end smallexample
21040
21041 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
21042 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
21043
21044 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
21045 @findex -var-assign
21046
21047 @subsubheading Synopsis
21048
21049 @smallexample
21050 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
21051 @end smallexample
21052
21053 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
21054 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
21055 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
21056 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
21057
21058 @subsubheading Example
21059
21060 @smallexample
21061 (@value{GDBP})
21062 -var-assign var1 3
21063 ^done,value="3"
21064 (@value{GDBP})
21065 -var-update *
21066 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
21067 (@value{GDBP})
21068 @end smallexample
21069
21070 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
21071 @findex -var-update
21072
21073 @subsubheading Synopsis
21074
21075 @smallexample
21076 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
21077 @end smallexample
21078
21079 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
21080 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
21081 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated. The
21082 option @var{print-values} determines whether names both and values, or
21083 just names are printed in the manner described for
21084 @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}).
21085
21086 @subsubheading Example
21087
21088 @smallexample
21089 (@value{GDBP})
21090 -var-assign var1 3
21091 ^done,value="3"
21092 (@value{GDBP})
21093 -var-update --all-values var1
21094 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
21095 type_changed="false"@}]
21096 (@value{GDBP})
21097 @end smallexample
21098
21099 @node Annotations
21100 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21101
21102 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21103 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21104 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21105 relatively high level.
21106
21107 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21108 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21109
21110 @ignore
21111 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21112 @end ignore
21113
21114 @menu
21115 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21116 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21117 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21118 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21119 * Annotations for Running::
21120 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21121 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21122 @end menu
21123
21124 @node Annotations Overview
21125 @section What is an Annotation?
21126 @cindex annotations
21127
21128 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21129 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21130 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21131 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21132 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21133 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21134 cannot contain newline characters.
21135
21136 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21137 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21138 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21139 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21140 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21141 means those three characters as output.
21142
21143 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21144 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21145 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21146 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21147 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21148 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21149 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21150 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21151 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21152
21153 @table @code
21154 @kindex set annotate
21155 @item set annotate @var{level}
21156 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21157 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21158
21159 @item show annotate
21160 @kindex show annotate
21161 Show the current annotation level.
21162 @end table
21163
21164 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21165
21166 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21167
21168 @smallexample
21169 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21170 GNU gdb 6.0
21171 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21172 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21173 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21174 under certain conditions.
21175 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21176 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21177 for details.
21178 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21179
21180 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21181 (@value{GDBP})
21182 ^Z^Zprompt
21183 @kbd{quit}
21184
21185 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21186 $
21187 @end smallexample
21188
21189 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21190 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21191 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21192 output from @value{GDBN}.
21193
21194 @node Prompting
21195 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21196
21197 @cindex annotations for prompts
21198 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21199 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21200 over, etc.
21201
21202 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21203 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21204 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21205 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21206 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21207 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21208 features the following annotations:
21209
21210 @smallexample
21211 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21212 ^Z^Zprompt
21213 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21214 @end smallexample
21215
21216 The input types are
21217
21218 @table @code
21219 @findex pre-prompt
21220 @findex prompt
21221 @findex post-prompt
21222 @item prompt
21223 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21224
21225 @findex pre-commands
21226 @findex commands
21227 @findex post-commands
21228 @item commands
21229 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21230 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21231
21232 @findex pre-overload-choice
21233 @findex overload-choice
21234 @findex post-overload-choice
21235 @item overload-choice
21236 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21237
21238 @findex pre-query
21239 @findex query
21240 @findex post-query
21241 @item query
21242 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21243
21244 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue
21245 @findex prompt-for-continue
21246 @findex post-prompt-for-continue
21247 @item prompt-for-continue
21248 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21249 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21250 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21251 presence of annotations.
21252 @end table
21253
21254 @node Errors
21255 @section Errors
21256 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21257
21258 @findex quit
21259 @smallexample
21260 ^Z^Zquit
21261 @end smallexample
21262
21263 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21264
21265 @findex error
21266 @smallexample
21267 ^Z^Zerror
21268 @end smallexample
21269
21270 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21271
21272 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21273 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21274 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21275 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21276 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21277 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21278 to the top level.
21279
21280 @findex error-begin
21281 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21282
21283 @smallexample
21284 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21285 @end smallexample
21286
21287 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21288 message.
21289
21290 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21291 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21292 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21293
21294 @node Invalidation
21295 @section Invalidation Notices
21296
21297 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21298 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21299 changed.
21300
21301 @table @code
21302 @findex frames-invalid
21303 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21304
21305 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21306 have changed.
21307
21308 @findex breakpoints-invalid
21309 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21310
21311 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21312 deleted a breakpoint.
21313 @end table
21314
21315 @node Annotations for Running
21316 @section Running the Program
21317 @cindex annotations for running programs
21318
21319 @findex starting
21320 @findex stopping
21321 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21322 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21323
21324 @smallexample
21325 ^Z^Zstarting
21326 @end smallexample
21327
21328 is output. When the program stops,
21329
21330 @smallexample
21331 ^Z^Zstopped
21332 @end smallexample
21333
21334 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21335 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21336
21337 @table @code
21338 @findex exited
21339 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21340 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21341 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21342
21343 @findex signalled
21344 @findex signal-name
21345 @findex signal-name-end
21346 @findex signal-string
21347 @findex signal-string-end
21348 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21349 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21350 annotation continues:
21351
21352 @smallexample
21353 @var{intro-text}
21354 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21355 @var{name}
21356 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21357 @var{middle-text}
21358 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21359 @var{string}
21360 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21361 @var{end-text}
21362 @end smallexample
21363
21364 @noindent
21365 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21366 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21367 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21368 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21369 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21370
21371 @findex signal
21372 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21373 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21374 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21375 terminated with it.
21376
21377 @findex breakpoint
21378 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21379 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21380
21381 @findex watchpoint
21382 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21383 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21384 @end table
21385
21386 @node Source Annotations
21387 @section Displaying Source
21388 @cindex annotations for source display
21389
21390 @findex source
21391 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21392
21393 @smallexample
21394 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21395 @end smallexample
21396
21397 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21398 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21399 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21400 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21401 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21402 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21403 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21404 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21405 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21406 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21407 depend on the language).
21408
21409 @node GDB Bugs
21410 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21411 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21412 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21413
21414 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21415
21416 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21417 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21418 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21419 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21420
21421 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21422 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21423
21424 @menu
21425 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21426 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21427 @end menu
21428
21429 @node Bug Criteria
21430 @section Have you found a bug?
21431 @cindex bug criteria
21432
21433 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21434
21435 @itemize @bullet
21436 @cindex fatal signal
21437 @cindex debugger crash
21438 @cindex crash of debugger
21439 @item
21440 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21441 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21442
21443 @cindex error on valid input
21444 @item
21445 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21446 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21447 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21448
21449 @cindex invalid input
21450 @item
21451 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21452 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21453 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21454 for traditional practice''.
21455
21456 @item
21457 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21458 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21459 @end itemize
21460
21461 @node Bug Reporting
21462 @section How to report bugs
21463 @cindex bug reports
21464 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21465
21466 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21467 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21468 contact that organization first.
21469
21470 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21471 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21472 distribution.
21473 @c should add a web page ref...
21474
21475 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21476 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
21477 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21478 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21479 be used.
21480
21481 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21482 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21483 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21484 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21485
21486 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21487 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21488 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21489 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21490 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21491 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21492 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21493 bug reports to the mailing list.
21494
21495 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21496 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21497 fact or leave it out, state it!
21498
21499 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21500 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21501 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21502 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21503 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21504 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21505 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21506 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21507 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21508
21509 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21510 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21511 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21512 self-contained.
21513
21514 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21515 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21516 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21517 bugs properly.
21518
21519 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21520
21521 @itemize @bullet
21522 @item
21523 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21524 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21525 version}.
21526
21527 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21528 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21529
21530 @item
21531 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21532 version number.
21533
21534 @item
21535 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21536 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21537
21538 @item
21539 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21540 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21541 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
21542 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
21543 compilers.
21544
21545 @item
21546 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21547 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21548 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21549 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21550
21551 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21552 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21553
21554 @item
21555 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21556 reproduce the bug.
21557
21558 @item
21559 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21560 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21561
21562 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21563 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21564 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21565 a chance to make a mistake.
21566
21567 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21568 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21569 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21570 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21571 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21572 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21573 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21574 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21575
21576 @pindex script
21577 @cindex recording a session script
21578 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21579 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21580 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21581 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21582
21583 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21584 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21585
21586 @item
21587 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21588 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21589 it by context, not by line number.
21590
21591 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21592 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21593
21594 @end itemize
21595
21596 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21597
21598 @itemize @bullet
21599 @item
21600 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21601
21602 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21603 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21604 changes will not affect it.
21605
21606 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21607 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21608 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21609 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21610
21611 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21612 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21613 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21614 less time, and so on.
21615
21616 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21617 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21618
21619 @item
21620 A patch for the bug.
21621
21622 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21623 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21624 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21625 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21626
21627 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21628 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21629 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21630 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21631
21632 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21633 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21634 help us to understand.
21635
21636 @item
21637 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21638
21639 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21640 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21641 @end itemize
21642
21643 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21644 @c and consists of the two following files:
21645 @c rluser.texinfo
21646 @c inc-hist.texinfo
21647 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21648 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21649 @include rluser.texinfo
21650 @include inc-hist.texinfo
21651
21652
21653 @node Formatting Documentation
21654 @appendix Formatting Documentation
21655
21656 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21657 @cindex reference card
21658 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
21659 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
21660 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
21661 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
21662 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
21663 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
21664
21665 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
21666 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
21667
21668 @smallexample
21669 make refcard.dvi
21670 @end smallexample
21671
21672 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
21673 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
21674 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
21675 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
21676 your @sc{dvi} output program.
21677
21678 @cindex documentation
21679
21680 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
21681 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
21682 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
21683 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
21684 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
21685 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
21686
21687 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
21688 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
21689 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
21690 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
21691 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
21692 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
21693 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
21694 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
21695
21696 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
21697 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
21698 @code{makeinfo}.
21699
21700 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
21701 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
21702 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
21703
21704 @smallexample
21705 cd gdb
21706 make gdb.info
21707 @end smallexample
21708
21709 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
21710 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
21711 Texinfo definitions file.
21712
21713 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
21714 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
21715 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
21716 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
21717 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
21718 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
21719 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
21720
21721 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
21722 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
21723 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
21724 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
21725 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
21726 directory.
21727
21728 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
21729 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
21730 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
21731 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
21732
21733 @smallexample
21734 make gdb.dvi
21735 @end smallexample
21736
21737 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
21738
21739 @node Installing GDB
21740 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
21741 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
21742 @cindex installation
21743 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
21744
21745 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
21746 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
21747 build the @code{gdb} program.
21748 @iftex
21749 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
21750 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
21751 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
21752 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
21753 @end iftex
21754
21755 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
21756 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
21757 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
21758
21759 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
21760 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
21761
21762 @table @code
21763 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
21764 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
21765
21766 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
21767 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
21768
21769 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
21770 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
21771
21772 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
21773 @sc{gnu} include files
21774
21775 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
21776 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
21777
21778 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
21779 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
21780
21781 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
21782 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
21783
21784 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
21785 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
21786
21787 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
21788 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
21789 @end table
21790
21791 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
21792 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
21793 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
21794
21795 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
21796 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
21797 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
21798 argument.
21799
21800 For example:
21801
21802 @smallexample
21803 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
21804 ./configure @var{host}
21805 make
21806 @end smallexample
21807
21808 @noindent
21809 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
21810 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
21811 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
21812 correct value by examining your system.)
21813
21814 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
21815 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
21816 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
21817 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
21818
21819 @need 750
21820 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
21821 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
21822 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
21823
21824 @smallexample
21825 sh configure @var{host}
21826 @end smallexample
21827
21828 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
21829 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
21830 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
21831 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
21832 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
21833
21834 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
21835 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
21836 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
21837 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
21838 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
21839 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
21840 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
21841 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
21842 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
21843
21844 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
21845 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
21846 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
21847 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
21848 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
21849
21850 @menu
21851 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
21852 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
21853 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
21854 @end menu
21855
21856 @node Separate Objdir
21857 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
21858
21859 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
21860 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
21861 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
21862 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
21863 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
21864 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
21865 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
21866 program specified there.
21867
21868 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
21869 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
21870 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
21871 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
21872 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
21873 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
21874
21875 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
21876 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
21877
21878 @smallexample
21879 @group
21880 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
21881 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
21882 cd ../gdb-sun4
21883 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
21884 make
21885 @end group
21886 @end smallexample
21887
21888 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
21889 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
21890 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
21891 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
21892 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
21893 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
21894
21895 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
21896 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
21897 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
21898 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
21899 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
21900
21901 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
21902 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
21903 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
21904 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
21905 You specify a cross-debugging target by
21906 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
21907
21908 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
21909 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
21910 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
21911
21912 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
21913 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
21914 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
21915 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
21916 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
21917
21918 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
21919 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
21920 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
21921 with each other.
21922
21923 @node Config Names
21924 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
21925
21926 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
21927 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
21928 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
21929 of information in the following pattern:
21930
21931 @smallexample
21932 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
21933 @end smallexample
21934
21935 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
21936 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
21937 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
21938
21939 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
21940 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
21941 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
21942 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
21943 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
21944 abbreviations---for example:
21945
21946 @smallexample
21947 % sh config.sub i386-linux
21948 i386-pc-linux-gnu
21949 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
21950 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
21951 % sh config.sub hp9k700
21952 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
21953 % sh config.sub sun4
21954 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
21955 % sh config.sub sun3
21956 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
21957 % sh config.sub i986v
21958 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
21959 @end smallexample
21960
21961 @noindent
21962 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
21963 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
21964
21965 @node Configure Options
21966 @section @code{configure} options
21967
21968 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
21969 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
21970 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
21971 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
21972
21973 @smallexample
21974 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
21975 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
21976 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
21977 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
21978 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
21979 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
21980 @var{host}
21981 @end smallexample
21982
21983 @noindent
21984 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
21985 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
21986 @samp{--}.
21987
21988 @table @code
21989 @item --help
21990 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
21991
21992 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
21993 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
21994 @file{@var{dir}}.
21995
21996 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
21997 Configure the source to install programs under directory
21998 @file{@var{dir}}.
21999
22000 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22001 @need 2000
22002 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22003 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22004 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22005 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22006 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22007 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22008 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
22009 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22010 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
22011 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22012 @var{dirname}.
22013
22014 @item --norecursion
22015 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
22016 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22017
22018 @item --target=@var{target}
22019 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22020 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22021 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22022
22023 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22024
22025 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22026 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22027
22028 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22029 @end table
22030
22031 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22032 needed for special purposes only.
22033
22034 @node Maintenance Commands
22035 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22036 @cindex maintenance commands
22037 @cindex internal commands
22038
22039 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22040 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22041 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22042 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22043 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22044
22045 @table @code
22046 @kindex maint agent
22047 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22048 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22049 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22050 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22051
22052 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22053 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22054 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22055 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22056 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22057 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22058 is shown:
22059
22060 @table @code
22061 @item breakpoint
22062 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22063
22064 @item watchpoint
22065 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22066
22067 @item longjmp
22068 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22069 @code{longjmp} calls.
22070
22071 @item longjmp resume
22072 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22073
22074 @item until
22075 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22076
22077 @item finish
22078 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22079
22080 @item shlib events
22081 Shared library events.
22082
22083 @end table
22084
22085 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22086 @item maint check-symtabs
22087 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22088
22089 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22090 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22091 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22092
22093 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22094 @item maint cplus namespace
22095 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22096
22097 @kindex maint demangle
22098 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22099 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C manled @var{name}.
22100
22101 @kindex maint deprecate
22102 @kindex maint undeprecate
22103 @cindex deprecated commands
22104 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22105 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22106 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22107 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22108 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22109 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22110 the replacement as part of the warning.
22111
22112 @kindex maint dump-me
22113 @item maint dump-me
22114 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22115 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22116 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22117 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22118
22119 @kindex maint internal-error
22120 @kindex maint internal-warning
22121 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22122 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22123 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22124 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22125 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22126 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22127 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22128 @value{GDBN} session.
22129
22130 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22131 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22132
22133 Here's an example of using @code{indernal-error}:
22134
22135 @smallexample
22136 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22137 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22138 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22139 debugging may prove unreliable.
22140 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22141 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22142 (@value{GDBP})
22143 @end smallexample
22144
22145 @kindex maint packet
22146 @item maint packet @var{text}
22147 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22148 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22149 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22150 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22151 checksum.
22152
22153 @kindex maint print architecture
22154 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22155 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22156 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22157
22158 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22159 @item maint print dummy-frames
22160 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22161
22162 @smallexample
22163 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22164 @dots{}
22165 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22166 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22167 58 return (a + b);
22168 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22169 @dots{}
22170 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22171 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22172 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22173 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22174 (@value{GDBP})
22175 @end smallexample
22176
22177 Takes an optional file parameter.
22178
22179 @kindex maint print registers
22180 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22181 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22182 @kindex maint print register-groups
22183 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22184 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22185 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22186 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22187 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22188
22189 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22190 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22191 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22192 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22193 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22194 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22195
22196 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22197 write the information.
22198
22199 @kindex maint print reggroups
22200 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22201 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22202 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22203 information.
22204
22205 The register groups info looks like this:
22206
22207 @smallexample
22208 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22209 Group Type
22210 general user
22211 float user
22212 all user
22213 vector user
22214 system user
22215 save internal
22216 restore internal
22217 @end smallexample
22218
22219 @kindex flushregs
22220 @item flushregs
22221 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22222
22223 @kindex maint print objfiles
22224 @cindex info for known object files
22225 @item maint print objfiles
22226 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22227 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22228 and symtabs.
22229
22230 @kindex maint print statistics
22231 @cindex bcache statistics
22232 @item maint print statistics
22233 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22234 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22235 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22236 of minimal, partical, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22237 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22238 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22239 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22240 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22241 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22242 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22243 lengths.
22244
22245 @kindex maint print type
22246 @cindex type chain of a data type
22247 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22248 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22249 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22250 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22251 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22252 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22253
22254 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22255 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22256 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22257 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22258 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22259
22260 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22261 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22262 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22263 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22264 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22265 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22266 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22267 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22268 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22269
22270 @kindex maint set profile
22271 @kindex maint show profile
22272 @cindex profiling GDB
22273 @item maint set profile
22274 @itemx maint show profile
22275 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22276
22277 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22278 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22279 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22280 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22281 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22282 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22283 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22284
22285 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22286 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22287
22288 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22289 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22290 @item maint show-debug-regs
22291 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22292 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22293 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when GDB inserts or
22294 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22295 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22296
22297 @kindex maint space
22298 @cindex memory used by commands
22299 @item maint space
22300 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22301 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22302 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22303 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22304 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22305
22306 @kindex maint time
22307 @cindex time of command execution
22308 @item maint time
22309 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22310 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22311 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22312 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22313 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22314
22315 @kindex maint translate-address
22316 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22317 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22318 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22319 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22320 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22321 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22322 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22323
22324 @end table
22325
22326 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22327 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22328
22329 @table @code
22330 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22331 @kindex set watchdog
22332 @cindex watchdog timer
22333 @cindex timeout for commands
22334 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22335 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22336 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22337
22338 @item show watchdog
22339 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22340 @end table
22341
22342 @node Remote Protocol
22343 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22344
22345 @menu
22346 * Overview::
22347 * Packets::
22348 * Stop Reply Packets::
22349 * General Query Packets::
22350 * Register Packet Format::
22351 * Tracepoint Packets::
22352 * Interrupts::
22353 * Examples::
22354 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
22355 @end menu
22356
22357 @node Overview
22358 @section Overview
22359
22360 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22361 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22362 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22363 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22364
22365 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22366 transmitted and received data respectfully.
22367
22368 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22369 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22370 @cindex remote serial protocol
22371 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22372 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22373 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22374 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22375
22376 @smallexample
22377 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22378 @end smallexample
22379 @noindent
22380
22381 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22382 @noindent
22383 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22384 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22385 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22386
22387 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22388 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22389
22390 @smallexample
22391 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22392 @end smallexample
22393
22394 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22395 @noindent
22396 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22397 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22398 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22399
22400 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22401 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22402 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22403 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22404 retransmission):
22405
22406 @smallexample
22407 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22408 <- @code{+}
22409 @end smallexample
22410 @noindent
22411
22412 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22413 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22414 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22415 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22416
22417 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22418 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22419 exceptions).
22420
22421 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22422 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22423 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22424 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22425
22426 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22427 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22428 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22429
22430 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22431 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22432 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22433 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22434 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22435 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22436 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22437
22438 So:
22439 @smallexample
22440 "@code{0* }"
22441 @end smallexample
22442 @noindent
22443 means the same as "0000".
22444
22445 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22446 error number. That number is not well defined.
22447
22448 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22449 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22450 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22451 on that response.
22452
22453 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22454 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22455 optional.
22456
22457 @node Packets
22458 @section Packets
22459
22460 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22461 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22462 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for details about the File
22463 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22464
22465 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22466 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22467 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22468 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22469 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22470 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22471 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22472 @var{baz}. GDB does not transmit a space character between the
22473 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22474 @var{baz}.
22475
22476 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22477 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22478
22479 Here are the packet descriptions.
22480
22481 @table @samp
22482
22483 @item !
22484 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22485 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22486 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22487 debugged.
22488
22489 Reply:
22490 @table @samp
22491 @item OK
22492 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22493 @end table
22494
22495 @item ?
22496 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22497 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22498 step and continue.
22499
22500 Reply:
22501 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22502
22503 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22504 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22505 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22506 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22507 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22508
22509 Reply:
22510 @table @samp
22511 @item OK
22512 The arguments were set.
22513 @item E @var{NN}
22514 An error occurred.
22515 @end table
22516
22517 @item b @var{baud}
22518 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22519 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22520 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22521
22522 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22523 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22524 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22525
22526 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22527 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22528 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22529 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22530 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22531
22532 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22533 @cindex @samp{B} packet
22534 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22535 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22536
22537 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22538 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22539
22540 @item c @var{addr}
22541 @cindex @samp{c} packet
22542 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22543 resume at current address.
22544
22545 Reply:
22546 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22547
22548 @item C @var{sig};@var{addr}
22549 @cindex @samp{C} packet
22550 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22551 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22552
22553 Reply:
22554 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22555
22556 @item d
22557 @cindex @samp{d} packet
22558 Toggle debug flag.
22559
22560 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
22561 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
22562
22563 @item D
22564 @cindex @samp{D} packet
22565 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22566 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22567
22568 Reply:
22569 @table @samp
22570 @item OK
22571 for success
22572 @item E @var{NN}
22573 for an error
22574 @end table
22575
22576 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
22577 @cindex @samp{F} packet
22578 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
22579 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
22580 remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
22581
22582 @item g
22583 @anchor{read registers packet}
22584 @cindex @samp{g} packet
22585 Read general registers.
22586
22587 Reply:
22588 @table @samp
22589 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22590 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22591 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22592 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
22593 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
22594 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
22595 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
22596 @item E @var{NN}
22597 for an error.
22598 @end table
22599
22600 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
22601 @cindex @samp{G} packet
22602 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
22603 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
22604
22605 Reply:
22606 @table @samp
22607 @item OK
22608 for success
22609 @item E @var{NN}
22610 for an error
22611 @end table
22612
22613 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
22614 @cindex @samp{H} packet
22615 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
22616 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
22617 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
22618 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
22619 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
22620
22621 Reply:
22622 @table @samp
22623 @item OK
22624 for success
22625 @item E @var{NN}
22626 for an error
22627 @end table
22628
22629 @c FIXME: JTC:
22630 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
22631 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
22632 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
22633 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
22634 @c described. For example:
22635 @c
22636 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22637 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
22638 @c otherwise returns current registers.
22639 @c
22640 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22641 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
22642 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
22643
22644 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
22645 @anchor{cycle step packet}
22646 @cindex @samp{i} packet
22647 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
22648 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
22649 step starting at that address.
22650
22651 @item I
22652 @cindex @samp{I} packet
22653 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
22654 step packet}.
22655
22656 @item k
22657 @cindex @samp{k} packet
22658 Kill request.
22659
22660 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
22661 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
22662 thread?)}.
22663
22664 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
22665 @cindex @samp{m} packet
22666 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22667 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
22668
22669 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
22670 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
22671 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
22672 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
22673 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
22674 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
22675 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
22676 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
22677
22678 Reply:
22679 @table @samp
22680 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22681 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexidecimal
22682 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
22683 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
22684 @item E @var{NN}
22685 @var{NN} is errno
22686 @end table
22687
22688 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
22689 @cindex @samp{M} packet
22690 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22691 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
22692 hexidecimal number.
22693
22694 Reply:
22695 @table @samp
22696 @item OK
22697 for success
22698 @item E @var{NN}
22699 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
22700 written).
22701 @end table
22702
22703 @item p @var{n}
22704 @cindex @samp{p} packet
22705 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
22706 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
22707 register value is encoded.
22708
22709 Reply:
22710 @table @samp
22711 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22712 the register's value
22713 @item E @var{NN}
22714 for an error
22715 @item
22716 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
22717 @end table
22718
22719 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
22720 @anchor{write register packet}
22721 @cindex @samp{P} packet
22722 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
22723 number @var{n} is in hexidecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
22724 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
22725
22726 Reply:
22727 @table @samp
22728 @item OK
22729 for success
22730 @item E @var{NN}
22731 for an error
22732 @end table
22733
22734 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
22735 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
22736 @cindex @samp{q} packet
22737 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
22738 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
22739 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
22740
22741 @item r
22742 @cindex @samp{r} packet
22743 Reset the entire system.
22744
22745 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
22746
22747 @item R @var{XX}
22748 @cindex @samp{R} packet
22749 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
22750 This packet is only available in extended mode.
22751
22752 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
22753
22754 @item s @var{addr}
22755 @cindex @samp{s} packet
22756 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
22757 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
22758
22759 Reply:
22760 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22761
22762 @item S @var{sig};@var{addr}
22763 @anchor{step with signal packet}
22764 @cindex @samp{S} packet
22765 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
22766 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
22767
22768 Reply:
22769 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22770
22771 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
22772 @cindex @samp{t} packet
22773 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
22774 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
22775 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
22776
22777 @item T @var{XX}
22778 @cindex @samp{T} packet
22779 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
22780
22781 Reply:
22782 @table @samp
22783 @item OK
22784 thread is still alive
22785 @item E @var{NN}
22786 thread is dead
22787 @end table
22788
22789 @item v
22790 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
22791 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
22792
22793 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
22794 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
22795 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
22796 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
22797 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
22798 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
22799 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
22800 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
22801
22802 @table @samp
22803 @item c
22804 Continue.
22805 @item C @var{sig}
22806 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
22807 @item s
22808 Step.
22809 @item S @var{sig}
22810 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
22811 @end table
22812
22813 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
22814 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
22815
22816 Reply:
22817 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22818
22819 @item vCont?
22820 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
22821 Request a list of actions supporetd by the @samp{vCont} packet.
22822
22823 Reply:
22824 @table @samp
22825 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
22826 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
22827 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
22828 @item
22829 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
22830 @end table
22831
22832 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
22833 @anchor{X packet}
22834 @cindex @samp{X} packet
22835 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
22836 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
22837 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data. The bytes @code{0x23}
22838 (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}), @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and
22839 @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}}) are escaped using @code{0x7d}
22840 (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}}), and then XORed with @code{0x20}. For example,
22841 the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two bytes @code{0x7d
22842 0x5d}.
22843
22844 Reply:
22845 @table @samp
22846 @item OK
22847 for success
22848 @item E @var{NN}
22849 for an error
22850 @end table
22851
22852 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
22853 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
22854 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
22855 @cindex @samp{z} packet
22856 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
22857 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
22858 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
22859 @var{length} bytes.
22860
22861 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
22862 separately.
22863
22864 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
22865 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
22866 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
22867 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
22868 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
22869 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
22870
22871 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
22872 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
22873 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
22874 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
22875 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
22876 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
22877
22878 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
22879 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
22880 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
22881 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
22882 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
22883
22884 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
22885 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
22886 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
22887 target, is not defined.}
22888
22889 Reply:
22890 @table @samp
22891 @item OK
22892 success
22893 @item
22894 not supported
22895 @item E @var{NN}
22896 for an error
22897 @end table
22898
22899 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
22900 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
22901 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
22902 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
22903 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
22904 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
22905
22906 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
22907 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
22908
22909 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
22910 movement.}
22911
22912 Reply:
22913 @table @samp
22914 @item OK
22915 success
22916 @item
22917 not supported
22918 @item E @var{NN}
22919 for an error
22920 @end table
22921
22922 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
22923 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
22924 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
22925 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
22926 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
22927
22928 Reply:
22929 @table @samp
22930 @item OK
22931 success
22932 @item
22933 not supported
22934 @item E @var{NN}
22935 for an error
22936 @end table
22937
22938 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
22939 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
22940 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
22941 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
22942 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
22943
22944 Reply:
22945 @table @samp
22946 @item OK
22947 success
22948 @item
22949 not supported
22950 @item E @var{NN}
22951 for an error
22952 @end table
22953
22954 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
22955 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
22956 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
22957 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
22958 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
22959
22960 Reply:
22961 @table @samp
22962 @item OK
22963 success
22964 @item
22965 not supported
22966 @item E @var{NN}
22967 for an error
22968 @end table
22969
22970 @end table
22971
22972 @node Stop Reply Packets
22973 @section Stop Reply Packets
22974 @cindex stop reply packets
22975
22976 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
22977 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
22978 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
22979 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
22980 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal
22981 numbering conventions is used.
22982
22983 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
22984 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
22985 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
22986 components.
22987
22988 @table @samp
22989
22990 @item S @var{AA}
22991 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexidecimal
22992 number).
22993
22994 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
22995 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
22996 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexidecimal
22997 number). Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported this way. The
22998 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs give the values of important registers or
22999 other information:
23000 @enumerate
23001 @item
23002 If @var{n} is a hexidecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23003 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23004 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23005 two-digit hex number.
23006 @item
23007 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23008 hex.
23009 @item
23010 If @var{n} is @samp{watch}, @samp{rwatch}, or @samp{awatch}, then the
23011 packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23012 hex.
23013 @item
23014 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23015 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23016 future.
23017 @end enumerate
23018
23019 @item W @var{AA}
23020 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23021 applicable to certain targets.
23022
23023 @item X @var{AA}
23024 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23025
23026 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23027 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23028 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23029 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23030 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23031
23032 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23033 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23034 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23035 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23036 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
23037 system calls.
23038
23039 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23040 this very system call.
23041
23042 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23043 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23044 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23045 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23046 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O remote
23047 protocol extension}, for more details.
23048
23049 @end table
23050
23051 @node General Query Packets
23052 @section General Query Packets
23053 @cindex remote query requests
23054
23055 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23056 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23057 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23058 sending information to and from the stub.
23059
23060 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23061 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23062 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23063 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23064 conventions:
23065
23066 @itemize @bullet
23067 @item
23068 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23069 @item
23070 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23071 letter.
23072 @item
23073 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23074 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23075 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23076 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23077 @end itemize
23078
23079 A query or set packet may optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or
23080 @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must be careful to match the full
23081 packet name, in case packet names have common prefixes.
23082
23083 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23084 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23085 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23086 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23087 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23088
23089 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23090
23091 @table @samp
23092
23093 @item qC
23094 @cindex current thread, remote request
23095 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23096 Return the current thread id.
23097
23098 Reply:
23099 @table @samp
23100 @item QC @var{pid}
23101 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexidecimal process id.
23102 @item @r{(anything else)}
23103 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23104 @end table
23105
23106 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23107 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23108 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23109 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23110 Reply:
23111 @table @samp
23112 @item E @var{NN}
23113 An error (such as memory fault)
23114 @item C @var{crc32}
23115 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23116 @end table
23117
23118 @item qfThreadInfo
23119 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23120 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23121 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23122 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23123 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23124 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23125 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23126 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23127 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23128 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23129
23130 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23131
23132 Reply:
23133 @table @samp
23134 @item m @var{id}
23135 A single thread id
23136 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23137 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23138 @item l
23139 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23140 @end table
23141
23142 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23143 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23144 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23145 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23146 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23147
23148 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23149 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23150 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23151 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23152 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23153
23154 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23155 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23156
23157 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23158 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23159 information associated with the variable.)
23160
23161 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI specific encoding of the
23162 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23163 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23164 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23165 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23166 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23167
23168 Reply:
23169 @table @samp
23170 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23171 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23172 local storage requested.
23173
23174 @item E @var{nn}
23175 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23176
23177 @item
23178 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23179 @end table
23180
23181 Use of this request packet is controlled by the @code{set remote
23182 get-thread-local-storage-address} command (@pxref{Remote
23183 configuration, set remote get-thread-local-storage-address}).
23184
23185 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23186 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23187 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23188 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23189 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23190 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23191 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23192
23193 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23194
23195 Reply:
23196 @table @samp
23197 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23198 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23199 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23200 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23201 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23202 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23203 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23204 @end table
23205
23206 @item qOffsets
23207 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23208 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23209 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
23210 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
23211 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
23212 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
23213
23214 Reply:
23215 @table @samp
23216 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy};Bss=@var{zzz}
23217 @end table
23218
23219 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23220 @cindex thread information, remote request
23221 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23222 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23223 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23224
23225 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23226
23227 @item qPart:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23228 @cindex read special object, remote request
23229 @cindex @samp{qPart} packet
23230 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
23231 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
23232 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
23233 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object; it can supply
23234 additional details about what data to access.
23235
23236 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
23237 @samp{qPart:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
23238 formats, listed below.
23239
23240 @table @samp
23241 @item qPart:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23242 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
23243 auxiliary vector}, and see @ref{Remote configuration,
23244 read-aux-vector-packet}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
23245 @end table
23246
23247 Reply:
23248 @table @samp
23249 @item OK
23250 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
23251 There is no more data to be read.
23252
23253 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23254 Hex encoded data bytes read.
23255 This may be fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
23256
23257 @item E00
23258 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23259
23260 @item E @var{nn}
23261 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
23262 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23263
23264 @item
23265 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} or @var{annex} string was not
23266 recognized by the stub.
23267 @end table
23268
23269 @item qPart:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
23270 @cindex write data into object, remote request
23271 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
23272 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
23273 into the data. @samp{@var{data}@dots{}} is the hex-encoded data to be
23274 written. The content and encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the
23275 object; it can supply additional details about what data to access.
23276
23277 No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
23278 serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
23279 specific request specifications ought to use.
23280
23281 Reply:
23282 @table @samp
23283 @item @var{nn}
23284 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
23285 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
23286
23287 @item E00
23288 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23289
23290 @item E @var{nn}
23291 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
23292 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23293
23294 @item
23295 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} or @var{annex} string was not
23296 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
23297 @end table
23298
23299 @item qPart:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
23300 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
23301 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
23302 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
23303 must respond with an empty packet.
23304
23305 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23306 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23307 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23308 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23309 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23310 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23311 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23312 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23313 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23314
23315 Reply:
23316 @table @samp
23317 @item OK
23318 A command response with no output.
23319 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23320 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23321 @item E @var{NN}
23322 Indicate a badly formed request.
23323 @item
23324 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23325 @end table
23326
23327 @item qSymbol::
23328 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
23329 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
23330 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
23331 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
23332
23333 Reply:
23334 @table @samp
23335 @item OK
23336 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23337 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23338 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
23339 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
23340 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
23341 below.
23342 @end table
23343
23344 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23345 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23346
23347 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23348 target has previously requested.
23349
23350 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23351 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23352 will be empty.
23353
23354 Reply:
23355 @table @samp
23356 @item OK
23357 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23358 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23359 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23360 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23361 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23362 @end table
23363
23364 @item QTDP
23365 @itemx QTFrame
23366 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23367
23368 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23369 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23370 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23371 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23372 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23373 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23374 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23375 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23376 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
23377 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
23378
23379 Reply:
23380 @table @samp
23381 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23382 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
23383 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
23384 the thread's attributes.
23385 @end table
23386
23387 @item QTStart
23388 @itemx QTStop
23389 @itemx QTinit
23390 @itemx QTro
23391 @itemx qTStatus
23392 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23393
23394 @end table
23395
23396 @node Register Packet Format
23397 @section Register Packet Format
23398
23399 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
23400 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
23401 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
23402 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
23403 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
23404 most-significant - least-significant.
23405
23406 @table @r
23407
23408 @item MIPS32
23409
23410 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
23411 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
23412 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
23413
23414 @item MIPS64
23415
23416 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
23417 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
23418 as @code{MIPS32}.
23419
23420 @end table
23421
23422 @node Tracepoint Packets
23423 @section Tracepoint Packets
23424 @cindex tracepoint packets
23425 @cindex packets, tracepoint
23426
23427 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
23428 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
23429
23430 @table @samp
23431
23432 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
23433 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
23434 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
23435 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
23436 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
23437 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
23438 tracepoint's actions.
23439
23440 Replies:
23441 @table @samp
23442 @item OK
23443 The packet was understood and carried out.
23444 @item
23445 The packet was not recognized.
23446 @end table
23447
23448 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
23449 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
23450 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
23451 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
23452 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
23453 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
23454 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
23455
23456 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
23457 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
23458 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
23459 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
23460 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
23461 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
23462 tracepoint actions.
23463
23464 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
23465 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
23466 following forms:
23467
23468 @table @samp
23469
23470 @item R @var{mask}
23471 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
23472 a hexidecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
23473 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
23474 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
23475 not fit in a 32-bit word.
23476
23477 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
23478 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
23479 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
23480 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
23481 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
23482 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexidecimal
23483 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
23484
23485 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
23486 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
23487 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
23488 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
23489 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
23490 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
23491 packet).
23492
23493 @end table
23494
23495 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
23496 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
23497 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
23498 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
23499 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
23500 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
23501 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
23502 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
23503
23504 Replies:
23505 @table @samp
23506 @item OK
23507 The packet was understood and carried out.
23508 @item
23509 The packet was not recognized.
23510 @end table
23511
23512 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
23513 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
23514 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
23515 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
23516
23517 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
23518 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
23519 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
23520 one of the following forms:
23521
23522 @table @samp
23523 @item F @var{f}
23524 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
23525 @var{f} is a hexidecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
23526 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
23527
23528 @item T @var{t}
23529 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
23530 @var{t} is a hexidecimal number.
23531
23532 @end table
23533
23534 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
23535 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
23536 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
23537 @var{addr} is a hexidecimal number.
23538
23539 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
23540 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
23541 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
23542 is a hexidecimal number.
23543
23544 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
23545 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
23546 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
23547 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexidecimal
23548 numbers.
23549
23550 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
23551 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
23552 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
23553
23554 @item QTStart
23555 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
23556 hits in the trace frame buffer.
23557
23558 @item QTStop
23559 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
23560
23561 @item QTinit
23562 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
23563
23564 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
23565 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
23566 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
23567 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
23568
23569 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
23570 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
23571 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
23572 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
23573
23574 @item qTStatus
23575 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
23576
23577 Replies:
23578 @table @samp
23579 @item T0
23580 There is no trace experiment running.
23581 @item T1
23582 There is a trace experiment running.
23583 @end table
23584
23585 @end table
23586
23587
23588 @node Interrupts
23589 @section Interrupts
23590 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
23591
23592 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
23593 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
23594 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
23595 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
23596
23597 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
23598 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
23599 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
23600 interfaces.
23601
23602 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
23603 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
23604 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
23605 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
23606 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
23607 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
23608 (@pxref{X packet}, used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
23609 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
23610
23611 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
23612 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
23613 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
23614 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
23615 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
23616 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
23617 program is stopped will be discarded.
23618
23619 @node Examples
23620 @section Examples
23621
23622 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
23623 does not get any direct output:
23624
23625 @smallexample
23626 -> @code{R00}
23627 <- @code{+}
23628 @emph{target restarts}
23629 -> @code{?}
23630 <- @code{+}
23631 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
23632 -> @code{+}
23633 @end smallexample
23634
23635 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
23636
23637 @smallexample
23638 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
23639 <- @code{+}
23640 -> @code{s}
23641 <- @code{+}
23642 @emph{time passes}
23643 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
23644 -> @code{+}
23645 -> @code{g}
23646 <- @code{+}
23647 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
23648 -> @code{+}
23649 @end smallexample
23650
23651 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
23652 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
23653 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
23654
23655 @menu
23656 * File-I/O Overview::
23657 * Protocol basics::
23658 * The F request packet::
23659 * The F reply packet::
23660 * Memory transfer::
23661 * The Ctrl-C message::
23662 * Console I/O::
23663 * The isatty call::
23664 * The system call::
23665 * List of supported calls::
23666 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
23667 * Constants::
23668 * File-I/O Examples::
23669 @end menu
23670
23671 @node File-I/O Overview
23672 @subsection File-I/O Overview
23673 @cindex file-i/o overview
23674
23675 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
23676 target to use the host's file system and console I/O when calling various
23677 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
23678 remote protocol packet to the host system which then performs the needed
23679 actions and returns with an adequate response packet to the target system.
23680 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
23681
23682 The protocol is defined host- and target-system independent. It uses
23683 its own independent representation of datatypes and values. Both,
23684 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
23685 translating the system dependent values into the unified protocol values
23686 when data is transmitted.
23687
23688 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only
23689 when GDB is waiting for the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s}
23690 packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
23691 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
23692 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interuptible by target signals. It
23693 is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt (Ctrl-C), though.
23694
23695 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
23696 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
23697 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
23698 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
23699 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
23700
23701 @smallexample
23702 (@value{GDBP}) continue
23703 <- target requests 'system call X'
23704 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
23705 -> GDB returns result
23706 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
23707 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
23708 @end smallexample
23709
23710 The protocol is only used for files on the host file system and
23711 for I/O on the console. Character or block special devices, pipes,
23712 named pipes or sockets or any other communication method on the host
23713 system are not supported by this protocol.
23714
23715 @node Protocol basics
23716 @subsection Protocol basics
23717 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
23718
23719 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet, as request as well
23720 as as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
23721 @value{GDBN} is waiting for the continuing or stepping target, the
23722 File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
23723 of a former @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
23724 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
23725 to call the appropriate host system call:
23726
23727 @itemize @bullet
23728 @item
23729 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
23730
23731 @item
23732 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
23733 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
23734 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
23735 Numerical control values are given in a protocol specific representation.
23736
23737 @end itemize
23738
23739 At that point @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
23740
23741 @itemize @bullet
23742 @item
23743 If parameter pointer values are given, which point to data needed as input
23744 to a system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
23745 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
23746 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
23747 packet.
23748
23749 @item
23750 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
23751 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
23752
23753 @item
23754 @value{GDBN} calls the system call
23755
23756 @item
23757 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
23758
23759 @item
23760 If pointer parameters in the request packet point to buffer space in which
23761 a system call is expected to copy data to, the data is transmitted to the
23762 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
23763 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
23764 packet.
23765
23766 @end itemize
23767
23768 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
23769 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
23770
23771 @itemize @bullet
23772 @item
23773 Return value.
23774
23775 @item
23776 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
23777
23778 @item
23779 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
23780
23781 @end itemize
23782
23783 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
23784 the latest continue or step action.
23785
23786 @node The F request packet
23787 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
23788 @cindex file-i/o request packet
23789 @cindex @code{F} request packet
23790
23791 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
23792
23793 @table @samp
23794
23795 @smallexample
23796 @code{F}@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
23797 @end smallexample
23798
23799 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
23800 This is just the name of the function.
23801
23802 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
23803
23804 @end table
23805
23806 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the real values in case
23807 of scalar datatypes, as pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
23808 datatypes and unspecified memory areas or as pointer/length pairs in case
23809 of string parameters. These are appended to the call-id, each separated
23810 from its predecessor by a comma. All values are transmitted in ASCII
23811 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
23812
23813 @node The F reply packet
23814 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
23815 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
23816 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
23817
23818 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
23819
23820 @table @samp
23821
23822 @smallexample
23823 @code{F}@var{retcode}@code{,}@var{errno}@code{,}@var{Ctrl-C flag}@code{;}@var{call specific attachment}
23824 @end smallexample
23825
23826 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
23827
23828 @var{errno} is the errno set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
23829 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
23830
23831 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only send if the user requested a break. In this
23832 case, @var{errno} must be send as well, even if the call was successful.
23833 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character 'C':
23834
23835 @smallexample
23836 F0,0,C
23837 @end smallexample
23838
23839 @noindent
23840 or, if the call was interupted before the host call has been performed:
23841
23842 @smallexample
23843 F-1,4,C
23844 @end smallexample
23845
23846 @noindent
23847 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
23848
23849 @end table
23850
23851 @node Memory transfer
23852 @subsection Memory transfer
23853 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
23854
23855 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write as e.g.@:
23856 a @code{struct stat} is expected to be in a protocol specific format with
23857 all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. This should be done by
23858 the target before the @code{F} packet is sent resp.@: by @value{GDBN} before
23859 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
23860 data should point to the already coerced data at any time.
23861
23862 @node The Ctrl-C message
23863 @subsection The Ctrl-C message
23864 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
23865
23866 A special case is, if the @var{Ctrl-C flag} is set in the @value{GDBN}
23867 reply packet. In this case the target should behave, as if it had
23868 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
23869 interupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
23870 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
23871 packet. In this case, it's important for the target to know, in which
23872 state the system call was interrupted. Since this action is by design
23873 not an atomic operation, we have to differ between two cases:
23874
23875 @itemize @bullet
23876 @item
23877 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
23878
23879 @item
23880 The system call on the host has been finished.
23881
23882 @end itemize
23883
23884 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
23885 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
23886 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
23887 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
23888 system call has been finished --- successful or not --- and should behave
23889 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
23890
23891 @value{GDBN} must behave reliable. If the system call has not been called
23892 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
23893 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
23894 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finshed by
23895 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as they fit.
23896 The @code{F} packet may only be send when either nothing has happened
23897 or the full action has been completed.
23898
23899 @node Console I/O
23900 @subsection Console I/O
23901 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
23902
23903 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
23904 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
23905 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
23906 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
23907 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
23908 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
23909 conditions is met:
23910
23911 @itemize @bullet
23912 @item
23913 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-C}. The behaviour is as explained above, the
23914 @code{read}
23915 system call is treated as finished.
23916
23917 @item
23918 The user presses @kbd{Enter}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
23919 line feed.
23920
23921 @item
23922 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-D}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
23923 character, especially no Ctrl-D is appended to the input.
23924
23925 @end itemize
23926
23927 If the user has typed more characters as fit in the buffer given to
23928 the read call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
23929 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target or debugging
23930 is stopped on users request.
23931
23932 @node The isatty call
23933 @subsection The @samp{isatty} function call
23934 @cindex isatty call, file-i/o protocol
23935
23936 A special case in this protocol is the library call @code{isatty} which
23937 is implemented as its own call inside of this protocol. It returns
23938 1 to the target if the file descriptor given as parameter is attached
23939 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
23940 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
23941 needed.
23942
23943 @node The system call
23944 @subsection The @samp{system} function call
23945 @cindex system call, file-i/o protocol
23946
23947 The other special case in this protocol is the @code{system} call which
23948 is implemented as its own call, too. @value{GDBN} is taking over the full
23949 task of calling the necessary host calls to perform the @code{system}
23950 call. The return value of @code{system} is simplified before it's returned
23951 to the target. Basically, the only signal transmitted back is @code{EINTR}
23952 in case the user pressed @kbd{Ctrl-C}. Otherwise the return value consists
23953 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
23954
23955 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
23956 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
23957 @kbd{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
23958
23959 @table @code
23960 @item set remote system-call-allowed
23961 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
23962 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
23963 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
23964
23965 @item show remote system-call-allowed
23966 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
23967 Show the current setting of system calls for the remote File I/O
23968 protocol.
23969 @end table
23970
23971 @node List of supported calls
23972 @subsection List of supported calls
23973 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
23974
23975 @menu
23976 * open::
23977 * close::
23978 * read::
23979 * write::
23980 * lseek::
23981 * rename::
23982 * unlink::
23983 * stat/fstat::
23984 * gettimeofday::
23985 * isatty::
23986 * system::
23987 @end menu
23988
23989 @node open
23990 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
23991 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
23992
23993 @smallexample
23994 @exdent Synopsis:
23995 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
23996 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
23997
23998 @exdent Request:
23999 Fopen,pathptr/len,flags,mode
24000 @end smallexample
24001
24002 @noindent
24003 @code{flags} is the bitwise or of the following values:
24004
24005 @table @code
24006 @item O_CREAT
24007 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24008 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24009 are concerned.
24010
24011 @item O_EXCL
24012 When used with O_CREAT, if the file already exists it is
24013 an error and open() fails.
24014
24015 @item O_TRUNC
24016 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24017 writing (O_RDWR or O_WRONLY is given) it will be
24018 truncated to length 0.
24019
24020 @item O_APPEND
24021 The file is opened in append mode.
24022
24023 @item O_RDONLY
24024 The file is opened for reading only.
24025
24026 @item O_WRONLY
24027 The file is opened for writing only.
24028
24029 @item O_RDWR
24030 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24031
24032 @noindent
24033 Each other bit is silently ignored.
24034
24035 @end table
24036
24037 @noindent
24038 @code{mode} is the bitwise or of the following values:
24039
24040 @table @code
24041 @item S_IRUSR
24042 User has read permission.
24043
24044 @item S_IWUSR
24045 User has write permission.
24046
24047 @item S_IRGRP
24048 Group has read permission.
24049
24050 @item S_IWGRP
24051 Group has write permission.
24052
24053 @item S_IROTH
24054 Others have read permission.
24055
24056 @item S_IWOTH
24057 Others have write permission.
24058
24059 @noindent
24060 Each other bit is silently ignored.
24061
24062 @end table
24063
24064 @smallexample
24065 @exdent Return value:
24066 open returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24067 occured.
24068
24069 @exdent Errors:
24070 @end smallexample
24071
24072 @table @code
24073 @item EEXIST
24074 pathname already exists and O_CREAT and O_EXCL were used.
24075
24076 @item EISDIR
24077 pathname refers to a directory.
24078
24079 @item EACCES
24080 The requested access is not allowed.
24081
24082 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24083 pathname was too long.
24084
24085 @item ENOENT
24086 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
24087
24088 @item ENODEV
24089 pathname refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24090
24091 @item EROFS
24092 pathname refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24093 write access was requested.
24094
24095 @item EFAULT
24096 pathname is an invalid pointer value.
24097
24098 @item ENOSPC
24099 No space on device to create the file.
24100
24101 @item EMFILE
24102 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24103
24104 @item ENFILE
24105 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24106 has been reached.
24107
24108 @item EINTR
24109 The call was interrupted by the user.
24110 @end table
24111
24112 @node close
24113 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24114 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24115
24116 @smallexample
24117 @exdent Synopsis:
24118 int close(int fd);
24119
24120 @exdent Request:
24121 Fclose,fd
24122
24123 @exdent Return value:
24124 close returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24125
24126 @exdent Errors:
24127 @end smallexample
24128
24129 @table @code
24130 @item EBADF
24131 fd isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24132
24133 @item EINTR
24134 The call was interrupted by the user.
24135 @end table
24136
24137 @node read
24138 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24139 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24140
24141 @smallexample
24142 @exdent Synopsis:
24143 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24144
24145 @exdent Request:
24146 Fread,fd,bufptr,count
24147
24148 @exdent Return value:
24149 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24150 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24151 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24152
24153 @exdent Errors:
24154 @end smallexample
24155
24156 @table @code
24157 @item EBADF
24158 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24159 reading.
24160
24161 @item EFAULT
24162 buf is an invalid pointer value.
24163
24164 @item EINTR
24165 The call was interrupted by the user.
24166 @end table
24167
24168 @node write
24169 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24170 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24171
24172 @smallexample
24173 @exdent Synopsis:
24174 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24175
24176 @exdent Request:
24177 Fwrite,fd,bufptr,count
24178
24179 @exdent Return value:
24180 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24181 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24182 is returned.
24183
24184 @exdent Errors:
24185 @end smallexample
24186
24187 @table @code
24188 @item EBADF
24189 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24190 writing.
24191
24192 @item EFAULT
24193 buf is an invalid pointer value.
24194
24195 @item EFBIG
24196 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
24197 host specific maximum file size allowed.
24198
24199 @item ENOSPC
24200 No space on device to write the data.
24201
24202 @item EINTR
24203 The call was interrupted by the user.
24204 @end table
24205
24206 @node lseek
24207 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
24208 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
24209
24210 @smallexample
24211 @exdent Synopsis:
24212 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
24213
24214 @exdent Request:
24215 Flseek,fd,offset,flag
24216 @end smallexample
24217
24218 @code{flag} is one of:
24219
24220 @table @code
24221 @item SEEK_SET
24222 The offset is set to offset bytes.
24223
24224 @item SEEK_CUR
24225 The offset is set to its current location plus offset
24226 bytes.
24227
24228 @item SEEK_END
24229 The offset is set to the size of the file plus offset
24230 bytes.
24231 @end table
24232
24233 @smallexample
24234 @exdent Return value:
24235 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
24236 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
24237 value of -1 is returned.
24238
24239 @exdent Errors:
24240 @end smallexample
24241
24242 @table @code
24243 @item EBADF
24244 fd is not a valid open file descriptor.
24245
24246 @item ESPIPE
24247 fd is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
24248
24249 @item EINVAL
24250 flag is not a proper value.
24251
24252 @item EINTR
24253 The call was interrupted by the user.
24254 @end table
24255
24256 @node rename
24257 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
24258 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
24259
24260 @smallexample
24261 @exdent Synopsis:
24262 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
24263
24264 @exdent Request:
24265 Frename,oldpathptr/len,newpathptr/len
24266
24267 @exdent Return value:
24268 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24269
24270 @exdent Errors:
24271 @end smallexample
24272
24273 @table @code
24274 @item EISDIR
24275 newpath is an existing directory, but oldpath is not a
24276 directory.
24277
24278 @item EEXIST
24279 newpath is a non-empty directory.
24280
24281 @item EBUSY
24282 oldpath or newpath is a directory that is in use by some
24283 process.
24284
24285 @item EINVAL
24286 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
24287 of itself.
24288
24289 @item ENOTDIR
24290 A component used as a directory in oldpath or new
24291 path is not a directory. Or oldpath is a directory
24292 and newpath exists but is not a directory.
24293
24294 @item EFAULT
24295 oldpathptr or newpathptr are invalid pointer values.
24296
24297 @item EACCES
24298 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24299
24300 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24301
24302 oldpath or newpath was too long.
24303
24304 @item ENOENT
24305 A directory component in oldpath or newpath does not exist.
24306
24307 @item EROFS
24308 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24309
24310 @item ENOSPC
24311 The device containing the file has no room for the new
24312 directory entry.
24313
24314 @item EINTR
24315 The call was interrupted by the user.
24316 @end table
24317
24318 @node unlink
24319 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
24320 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
24321
24322 @smallexample
24323 @exdent Synopsis:
24324 int unlink(const char *pathname);
24325
24326 @exdent Request:
24327 Funlink,pathnameptr/len
24328
24329 @exdent Return value:
24330 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24331
24332 @exdent Errors:
24333 @end smallexample
24334
24335 @table @code
24336 @item EACCES
24337 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24338
24339 @item EPERM
24340 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
24341
24342 @item EBUSY
24343 The file pathname cannot be unlinked because it's
24344 being used by another process.
24345
24346 @item EFAULT
24347 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
24348
24349 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24350 pathname was too long.
24351
24352 @item ENOENT
24353 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
24354
24355 @item ENOTDIR
24356 A component of the path is not a directory.
24357
24358 @item EROFS
24359 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24360
24361 @item EINTR
24362 The call was interrupted by the user.
24363 @end table
24364
24365 @node stat/fstat
24366 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
24367 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
24368 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
24369
24370 @smallexample
24371 @exdent Synopsis:
24372 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
24373 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
24374
24375 @exdent Request:
24376 Fstat,pathnameptr/len,bufptr
24377 Ffstat,fd,bufptr
24378
24379 @exdent Return value:
24380 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24381
24382 @exdent Errors:
24383 @end smallexample
24384
24385 @table @code
24386 @item EBADF
24387 fd is not a valid open file.
24388
24389 @item ENOENT
24390 A directory component in pathname does not exist or the
24391 path is an empty string.
24392
24393 @item ENOTDIR
24394 A component of the path is not a directory.
24395
24396 @item EFAULT
24397 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
24398
24399 @item EACCES
24400 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24401
24402 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24403 pathname was too long.
24404
24405 @item EINTR
24406 The call was interrupted by the user.
24407 @end table
24408
24409 @node gettimeofday
24410 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
24411 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
24412
24413 @smallexample
24414 @exdent Synopsis:
24415 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
24416
24417 @exdent Request:
24418 Fgettimeofday,tvptr,tzptr
24419
24420 @exdent Return value:
24421 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
24422
24423 @exdent Errors:
24424 @end smallexample
24425
24426 @table @code
24427 @item EINVAL
24428 tz is a non-NULL pointer.
24429
24430 @item EFAULT
24431 tvptr and/or tzptr is an invalid pointer value.
24432 @end table
24433
24434 @node isatty
24435 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
24436 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
24437
24438 @smallexample
24439 @exdent Synopsis:
24440 int isatty(int fd);
24441
24442 @exdent Request:
24443 Fisatty,fd
24444
24445 @exdent Return value:
24446 Returns 1 if fd refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
24447
24448 @exdent Errors:
24449 @end smallexample
24450
24451 @table @code
24452 @item EINTR
24453 The call was interrupted by the user.
24454 @end table
24455
24456 @node system
24457 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
24458 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
24459
24460 @smallexample
24461 @exdent Synopsis:
24462 int system(const char *command);
24463
24464 @exdent Request:
24465 Fsystem,commandptr/len
24466
24467 @exdent Return value:
24468 The value returned is -1 on error and the return status
24469 of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
24470 command is returned, which is extracted from the hosts
24471 system return value by calling WEXITSTATUS(retval).
24472 In case /bin/sh could not be executed, 127 is returned.
24473
24474 @exdent Errors:
24475 @end smallexample
24476
24477 @table @code
24478 @item EINTR
24479 The call was interrupted by the user.
24480 @end table
24481
24482 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
24483 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
24484 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
24485
24486 @menu
24487 * Integral datatypes::
24488 * Pointer values::
24489 * struct stat::
24490 * struct timeval::
24491 @end menu
24492
24493 @node Integral datatypes
24494 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
24495 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
24496
24497 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are
24498
24499 @smallexample
24500 int@r{,} unsigned int@r{,} long@r{,} unsigned long@r{,} mode_t @r{and} time_t
24501 @end smallexample
24502
24503 @code{Int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
24504 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
24505
24506 @code{Long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
24507
24508 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
24509 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
24510
24511 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
24512
24513 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
24514 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
24515 byte order.
24516
24517 @node Pointer values
24518 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
24519 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
24520
24521 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
24522 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
24523 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
24524 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
24525
24526 @smallexample
24527 @code{1aaf/12}
24528 @end smallexample
24529
24530 @noindent
24531 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
24532 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
24533 the trailing null byte. Example:
24534
24535 @smallexample
24536 ``hello, world'' at address 0x123456
24537 @end smallexample
24538
24539 @noindent
24540 is transmitted as
24541
24542 @smallexample
24543 @code{123456/d}
24544 @end smallexample
24545
24546 @node struct stat
24547 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
24548 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
24549
24550 The buffer of type struct stat used by the target and @value{GDBN} is defined
24551 as follows:
24552
24553 @smallexample
24554 struct stat @{
24555 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
24556 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
24557 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
24558 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
24559 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
24560 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
24561 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
24562 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
24563 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
24564 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
24565 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
24566 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
24567 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
24568 @};
24569 @end smallexample
24570
24571 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
24572 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
24573 structure is of size 64 bytes.
24574
24575 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
24576 range of values.
24577
24578 @smallexample
24579 st_dev: 0 file
24580 1 console
24581
24582 st_ino: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24583
24584 st_mode: Valid mode bits are described in Appendix C. Any other
24585 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
24586
24587 st_uid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24588
24589 st_gid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24590
24591 st_rdev: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24592
24593 st_atime, st_mtime, st_ctime:
24594 These values have a host and file system dependent
24595 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts the file systems
24596 don't support exact timing values.
24597 @end smallexample
24598
24599 The target gets a struct stat of the above representation and is
24600 responsible to coerce it to the target representation before
24601 continuing.
24602
24603 Note that due to size differences between the host and target
24604 representation of stat members, these members could eventually
24605 get truncated on the target.
24606
24607 @node struct timeval
24608 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
24609 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
24610
24611 The buffer of type struct timeval used by the target and @value{GDBN}
24612 is defined as follows:
24613
24614 @smallexample
24615 struct timeval @{
24616 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
24617 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
24618 @};
24619 @end smallexample
24620
24621 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
24622 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
24623 structure is of size 8 bytes.
24624
24625 @node Constants
24626 @subsection Constants
24627 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
24628
24629 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
24630 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are resposible to translate these
24631 values before and after the call as needed.
24632
24633 @menu
24634 * Open flags::
24635 * mode_t values::
24636 * Errno values::
24637 * Lseek flags::
24638 * Limits::
24639 @end menu
24640
24641 @node Open flags
24642 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
24643 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
24644
24645 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
24646
24647 @smallexample
24648 O_RDONLY 0x0
24649 O_WRONLY 0x1
24650 O_RDWR 0x2
24651 O_APPEND 0x8
24652 O_CREAT 0x200
24653 O_TRUNC 0x400
24654 O_EXCL 0x800
24655 @end smallexample
24656
24657 @node mode_t values
24658 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
24659 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
24660
24661 All values are given in octal representation.
24662
24663 @smallexample
24664 S_IFREG 0100000
24665 S_IFDIR 040000
24666 S_IRUSR 0400
24667 S_IWUSR 0200
24668 S_IXUSR 0100
24669 S_IRGRP 040
24670 S_IWGRP 020
24671 S_IXGRP 010
24672 S_IROTH 04
24673 S_IWOTH 02
24674 S_IXOTH 01
24675 @end smallexample
24676
24677 @node Errno values
24678 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
24679 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
24680
24681 All values are given in decimal representation.
24682
24683 @smallexample
24684 EPERM 1
24685 ENOENT 2
24686 EINTR 4
24687 EBADF 9
24688 EACCES 13
24689 EFAULT 14
24690 EBUSY 16
24691 EEXIST 17
24692 ENODEV 19
24693 ENOTDIR 20
24694 EISDIR 21
24695 EINVAL 22
24696 ENFILE 23
24697 EMFILE 24
24698 EFBIG 27
24699 ENOSPC 28
24700 ESPIPE 29
24701 EROFS 30
24702 ENAMETOOLONG 91
24703 EUNKNOWN 9999
24704 @end smallexample
24705
24706 EUNKNOWN is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
24707 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
24708
24709 @node Lseek flags
24710 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
24711 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
24712
24713 @smallexample
24714 SEEK_SET 0
24715 SEEK_CUR 1
24716 SEEK_END 2
24717 @end smallexample
24718
24719 @node Limits
24720 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
24721 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
24722
24723 All values are given in decimal representation.
24724
24725 @smallexample
24726 INT_MIN -2147483648
24727 INT_MAX 2147483647
24728 UINT_MAX 4294967295
24729 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
24730 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
24731 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
24732 @end smallexample
24733
24734 @node File-I/O Examples
24735 @subsection File-I/O Examples
24736 @cindex file-i/o examples
24737
24738 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
24739 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
24740
24741 @smallexample
24742 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
24743 @emph{request memory read from target}
24744 -> @code{m1234,6}
24745 <- XXXXXX
24746 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
24747 -> @code{F6}
24748 @end smallexample
24749
24750 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
24751 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
24752
24753 @smallexample
24754 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
24755 @emph{request memory write to target}
24756 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
24757 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
24758 -> @code{F6}
24759 @end smallexample
24760
24761 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
24762 file descriptor (EBADF):
24763
24764 @smallexample
24765 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
24766 -> @code{F-1,9}
24767 @end smallexample
24768
24769 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C before syscall on
24770 host is called:
24771
24772 @smallexample
24773 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
24774 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
24775 <- @code{T02}
24776 @end smallexample
24777
24778 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C after syscall on
24779 host is called:
24780
24781 @smallexample
24782 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
24783 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
24784 <- @code{T02}
24785 @end smallexample
24786
24787 @include agentexpr.texi
24788
24789 @include gpl.texi
24790
24791 @raisesections
24792 @include fdl.texi
24793 @lowersections
24794
24795 @node Index
24796 @unnumbered Index
24797
24798 @printindex cp
24799
24800 @tex
24801 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
24802 % meantime:
24803 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
24804 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
24805 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
24806 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
24807 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
24808 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
24809 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
24810 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
24811 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
24812 \page\colophon
24813 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
24814 @end tex
24815
24816 @bye
This page took 0.614283 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.